Form 424(b)(3)
Table of Contents

FILED PURSUANT TO RULE 424(B)(3)

File Number 333-197772

SUNGARD DATA SYSTEMS INC.

SUPPLEMENT NO. 2 TO

MARKET-MAKING PROSPECTUS DATED SEPTEMBER 5, 2014

THE DATE OF THIS SUPPLEMENT IS MARCH 26, 2015

ON MARCH 25, 2015, SUNGARD DATA SYSTEMS INC. FILED THE ATTACHED

ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 10-K FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2014


Table of Contents

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

Form 10-K

 

 

(Mark One)

x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014

or

 

¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

for the transition period from                      to                     

Commission File Numbers:

 

 

SunGard Capital Corp. 000-53653

SunGard Capital Corp. II 000-53654

SunGard Data Systems Inc. 001-12989

 

 

SunGard® Capital Corp.

SunGard® Capital Corp. II

SunGard® Data Systems Inc.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

 

 

Delaware   20-3059890
Delaware   20-3060101
Delaware   51-0267091
(State of incorporation)   (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)

680 East Swedesford Road, Wayne, Pennsylvania 19087

(Address of principal executive offices, including zip code)

484-582-2000

(Telephone number, including area code)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

None

 

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

Restricted Stock Units Granting Conditional Rights to Units Consisting of:

Class A Common Stock of SunGard Capital Corp., par value $0.001 per share,

Class L Common Stock of SunGard Capital Corp., par value $0.001 per share, and

Preferred Stock of SunGard Capital Corp. II, par value $0.001 per share

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.

 

SunGard Capital Corp.

       Yes  ¨    No  x

SunGard Capital Corp. II

       Yes  ¨    No  x

SunGard Data Systems Inc.

       Yes  ¨    No  x


Table of Contents

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.

 

SunGard Capital Corp.

    Yes  ¨    No  x

SunGard Capital Corp. II

    Yes  ¨    No  x

SunGard Data Systems Inc.

    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.

 

SunGard Capital Corp.

    Yes  x    No  ¨

SunGard Capital Corp. II

    Yes  x    No  ¨

SunGard Data Systems Inc.

    Yes  ¨    No  x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).

 

SunGard Capital Corp.

    Yes  x    No  ¨

SunGard Capital Corp. II

    Yes  x    No  ¨

SunGard Data Systems Inc.

    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of the registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference into Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.

 

SunGard Capital Corp.  x

SunGard Capital Corp. II  x SunGard Data Systems Inc.  x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

SunGard Capital Corp.

Large accelerated filer  ¨. Accelerated filer  ¨. Non-accelerated filer  x. Smaller reporting company  ¨.

SunGard Capital Corp.II

Large accelerated filer  ¨. Accelerated filer  ¨. Non-accelerated filer  x. Smaller reporting company  ¨.

SunGard Data Systems Inc.

Large accelerated filer  ¨. Accelerated filer  ¨. Non-accelerated filer  x. Smaller reporting company  ¨.

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).

 

SunGard Capital Corp.

    Yes  ¨    No  x

SunGard Capital Corp. II

    Yes  ¨    No  x

SunGard Data Systems Inc.

    Yes  ¨    No  x

The aggregate market value of the registrants’ voting stock held by nonaffiliates is zero. The registrants are privately held corporations.

The number of shares of the registrants’ common stock outstanding as of March 1, 2015:

 

SunGard Capital Corp.:

257,737,736 shares of Class A common stock and 28,637,524 shares of Class L common stock

SunGard Capital Corp. II:

100 shares of common stock

SunGard Data Systems Inc.:

100 shares of common stock

 

 

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

None.

 

 

 


Table of Contents

Table of Contents

 

     Page  

Explanatory Note

     2   

Forward-Looking Statements

     2   
  PART I   

Item1.

  Business      3   
 

Segment Overview

     4   
 

Financial Systems

     4   
 

Public Sector & Education

     5   
 

Product Development and Maintenance

     5   
 

Sales and Marketing

     6   
 

Brand and Intellectual Property

     6   
 

Competition

     7   
 

Employees

     7   

Item 1A.

  Risk Factors      7   

Item 1B.

  Unresolved Staff Comments      18   

Item 2.

  Properties      18   

Item 3.

  Legal Proceedings      18   

Item 4.

  Mine Safety Disclosures      18   
  PART II   

Item 5.

  Market for Registrants’ Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities      19   

Item 6.

  Selected Financial Data      19   

Item 7.

  Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations      21   

Item 7A.

  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk      48   

Item 8.

  Financial Statements and Supplementary Data      49   

Item 9.

  Changes In and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure      118   

Item 9A.

  Controls and Procedures      118   

Item 9B.

  Other Information      118   
  PART III   

Item 10.

  Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance      119   

Item 11.

  Executive Compensation      122   

Item 12.

  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters      149   

Item 13.

  Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence      154   

Item 14.

  Principal Accountant Fees and Services      156   
  PART IV   

Item 15.

  Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules      157   

Signatures

     158   

List of Exhibits

     159   


Table of Contents

Explanatory Note

This Annual Report on Form 10-K (“Report”) is a combined report being filed separately by three registrants: SunGard Capital Corp. (“SCC”), SunGard Capital Corp. II (“SCCII”) and SunGard Data Systems Inc. (“SunGard”). SCC and SCCII are collectively referred to as the “Parent Companies.” Unless the context indicates otherwise, any reference in this Report to the “Company,” “we,” “us” and “our” refer to the Parent Companies together with their direct and indirect subsidiaries, including SunGard. Each registrant hereto is filing on its own behalf all of the information contained in this Report that relates to such registrant. Each registrant hereto is not filing any information that does not relate to such registrant, and therefore makes no representation as to any such information.

Forward-Looking Statements

Certain of the matters we discuss in this Report may constitute forward-looking statements. You can identify forward-looking statements because they contain words such as “believes,” “expects,” “may,” “will,” “should,” “seeks,” “approximately,” “intends,” “plans,” “estimates” or “anticipates,” or similar expressions which concern our strategy, plans or intentions. These forward-looking statements are subject to risks and uncertainties that may change at any time, and, therefore, our actual results may differ materially from those we expected. We describe some of the factors that we believe could affect our results in ITEM 1A—RISK FACTORS. We assume no obligation to update any written or oral forward-looking statements made by us or on our behalf as a result of new information, future events or other factors.

 

2


Table of Contents

PART I

 

ITEM 1. BUSINESS

General

SunGard is a global software company serving the financial services and the public sector and education industries. We offer a wide range of innovative software solutions, delivered as traditional software offerings or via software as a service (“SaaS”) and the cloud, and surround them with an extensive suite of services. These world-class systems, combined with our deep domain expertise and our steadfast attention to our customers’ needs, position us well to compete successfully and to benefit from the growth trends in the markets we serve. Considering the breadth of our product portfolio and the depth of our capabilities, we are uniquely capable of supporting virtually every type of financial institution, including the largest and most complex financial customers in the world.

In 2014, we generated over $2.8 billion of revenue, employing approximately 13,000 people, and serving over 15,000 customers. We are a leader in the industry and are consistently ranked in the top 10 companies in the “FinTech 100” ranking of financial technology companies.

Our customers’ business environment is dynamic and increasingly more complicated. Across the industries that we serve, sophisticated risk management requirements and compliance with ever-changing regulations are adding cost and complexity to our customers’ operations. At the same time, their shareholders are demanding improved efficiency and increased transparency. In this environment, our customers demand exceptional solutions and, with spending and resources under pressure, they are turning to a small number of trusted global technology companies to help make them successful. This plays to our strength, as our applications can lower cost, improve control and speed decision making—all of which helps improve our customers’ profitability.

We are also expanding the reach of our products beyond our traditional software offerings to SaaS and the cloud. Our well-established SaaS offerings and global cloud delivery centers host and support our applications. In some instances, we also perform business processing as a service (“BPaaS”), centered on our key technology, for our customers either individually or in a utility model.

Our professional services organization offers technology consulting, product implementation and optimization to address customers’ needs. These highly skilled resources are capable of integrating and extending our products into a customer’s computing infrastructure, speeding deployment and optimizing the software in the customer’s environment.

We were acquired in August 2005 in a leveraged buy-out (the “LBO”) by a consortium of private equity investment funds associated with Bain Capital Partners, The Blackstone Group, Goldman, Sachs & Co., Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co., Providence Equity Partners, Silver Lake and TPG (collectively, the “Sponsors”). As a result of the LBO, we are highly leveraged and our equity is not publicly traded.

Our Sponsors continually evaluate various strategic alternatives with respect to the Company. There can be no assurance that we will ultimately pursue any strategic alternatives with respect to any business, or, if we do, what the structure or timing for any such transaction would be.

On March 31, 2014, SunGard completed the split-off of its Availability Services (“AS”) business to its existing stockholders, including its Sponsors, on a tax-free and pro-rata basis (the “AS Split-Off”).

We operate our business in two segments: Financial Systems (“FS”) and Public Sector & Education (“PS&E”).

Our FS business provides software and services to the breadth of the financial marketplace including capital markets (sell side) and asset management (buy side) customers. In addition, we provide specific offerings to

 

3


Table of Contents

address the needs of a broad range of customers, including insurance companies, corporate treasurers, wealth managers and leasing companies. Increasingly our core technology is being applied across the firms in the industry, providing greater consistency for our customers and improved operating leverage for SunGard.

PS&E provides mission critical software and technology services to domestic governments at all levels, nonprofits and utilities and to kindergarten through 12th grade (“K-12”) educational institutions.

We provide a large portfolio of products to customers who are diversified both geographically and by industry. Our base of over 15,000 customers includes an extensive list of financial services firms, including most of the world’s largest financial institutions. In addition, we serve corporate and government treasury departments, energy companies, school districts, local governments and nonprofit organizations. During each of the past three fiscal years, no single customer has accounted for more than 3% of total revenue. In many cases, our products and services are offered under multi-year contracts, providing good visibility to revenue trends and allowing us to manage spending proactively.

To the extent required by Item 1 of Form 10-K, financial information regarding our segments is included in Note 14 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in this Report.

Segment Overview

Financial Systems

FS provides mission critical software and technology services to financial services institutions, corporate and government treasury departments and energy companies. Our solutions automate the many complex business processes associated with trading, managing investment portfolios and accounting for investment assets, and also address the processing requirements of a broad range of users within the financial services sector. In addition, we provide technology services that focus on application implementation and integration of these solutions, custom software development and application management. We continue to invest in our solutions to add new features, process new types of financial instruments, meet new regulatory requirements, incorporate new technologies and meet evolving customer needs on a global basis.

Our core technologies are delivered as software licenses or via SaaS and the cloud from our data centers, providing our customers with a secure and reliable environment operated by qualified SunGard personnel. These offerings allow customers to take advantage of our deep domain expertise without the upfront cost of licensing and IT infrastructure.

Our professional services offerings allow customers to install, optimize and integrate our software into their computing environment. We are currently investing to improve our global delivery capacity, further improving customers’ adoption of our core technologies. Our BPaaS offerings typically provide back-office processing services to our customers where the process is deeply related to a SunGard application. The combination of SunGard’s industry and application knowledge, coupled with our customers’ desire to focus on their core competencies, is resulting in continued growth in these BPaaS offerings.

Our FS business offers software and technology services to a broad range of users, including asset managers, chief financial officers, compliance officers, custodians, fund administrators, insurers and reinsurers, market makers, plan administrators, registered investment advisors, treasurers, traders and wealth managers. FS is grouped into complementary solutions as follows:

Asset Management: We offer solutions that help institutional investors, hedge funds, private equity firms, fund administrators and securities transfer agents improve both investment decision-making and operational efficiency, while managing risk and increasing transparency. Our solutions support every stage of the investment process, from research and portfolio management, to valuation, risk management, compliance, investment accounting, transfer agency and client reporting.

 

4


Table of Contents

Brokerage: Our brokerage solutions provide trade execution and network solutions to financial institutions, corporations and municipalities in North America, Europe and other global markets. Our trade execution and network solutions help both buy- and sell-side firms improve execution quality, decrease overall execution costs and address today’s trade connectivity challenges.

Capital Markets: Our capital markets offerings help financial institutions to increase the efficiency, transparency and control of their trading operations, post-trade settlement, risk management, securities lending, tax processing, and regulatory compliance. The breadth of our offerings also facilitate advanced business intelligence and market data distribution based on our extensive market data access.

Corporate Liquidity: Our corporate liquidity solutions help chief financial officers and treasurers derive maximum value from working capital by increasing visibility to cash, reducing risk and improving communication and response time between a company’s buyers, suppliers, banks and other stakeholders. Our end-to-end collaborative financial management framework helps bring together receivables, treasury and payments for a single view of cash and risk, and to optimize business processes for enhanced liquidity management.

Energy and Commodities. Our energy and commodities solutions help energy companies, hedge funds and financial services firms to compete efficiently in global energy and commodities markets by streamlining and integrating the trading, risk management and operations of physical commodities and their associated financial instruments.

Insurance: Our insurance offerings provide solutions for a variety of insurance lines, including life and health, annuities and pensions, property and casualty, reinsurance and asset management. Our software and services help support front office and back office functions including customer service, policy administration, actuarial calculations, and financial and investment accounting and reporting.

Wealth Management: We provide wealth management solutions that help banks, trust companies, brokerage firms, insurance firms, benefit administrators and independent advisors acquire, service and grow their client relationships. We provide solutions for client acquisition, transaction management, trust accounting and recordkeeping that can be deployed as stand-alone products or as part of an integrated wealth management platform.

Public Sector & Education

Public Sector & Education provides mission critical software and technology services to domestic governments at all levels and K-12 learning institutions.

Public Sector: Our public sector offerings are designed to meet the specialized needs of local, state and federal governments, public safety and justice agencies, utilities and public sector institutions, as well as nonprofits. These offerings include software and technology services supporting a range of specialized enterprise resource planning and administrative processes for functions such as accounting, human resources, payroll, utility billing, land management and managed IT services. Public safety and justice agencies use our solutions to manage emergency dispatch operations, citizen and incident records, mobile computing in the field, and the operation of courts and jails. Our e-Government solutions help local governments to leverage the Internet and wireless technologies to serve their constituents.

K-12 Education: We provide software solutions and related implementation and support services for K-12 school districts and private schools throughout the United States. Our software and technology services help school districts improve the efficiency of their operations and use Web-based technologies to serve their constituents. We offer a fully integrated suite of products for student information, learning management, special education, financial management and human resource activities.

Product Development and Maintenance

Our global technology staff continually develops new products and enhances existing products to address the changing needs of our customers. We employ over 4,000 developers in a network of international

 

5


Table of Contents

development sites. Our ability to attract, motivate and retain these development resources is a key differentiator for us and ultimately a source of our organic growth. We are constantly rebalancing our development resources to develop the technologies that are most important to our customers, including such things as:

 

    advanced user interfaces, increasingly based on HTML5 technology for browsers, tablets and mobile devices,

 

    business intelligence and data analytics, leveraging the large volume of data available to us and providing our customers with the tools to improve their business, speed decision making and gain competitive advantage,

 

    advanced proprietary risk and compliance engines, and

 

    integration of cloud-based architectures into our products.

We are increasing our investment in these technologies in response to customer demand, and these investments further drive growth both domestically and internationally. We spend over $400 million dollars annually in development and have been increasing our capitalization of this software as more new products reach technological feasibility and as development spending on our SaaS offerings increase. In 2014, 2013 and 2012, we spent approximately $438, $433 million and $444 million, respectively, on software development and maintenance, of which we capitalized $62 million, $41 million and $22 million, respectively. Total software development and maintenance, net of capitalized software, was 13%, 14% and 15% of total revenue in 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

Sales and Marketing

We operate a global sales and distribution network, largely through a direct sales approach. Our sales team is comprised of direct quota-carrying sales professionals who are teamed with pre- and post-sales support to help ensure that our customers receive the best possible solutions for their business needs.

Our FS solutions are generally sold on a global basis with certain products adapted to specific geographic markets. The majority of our FS revenue is sourced from North America and Western Europe, where revenue from new and existing customers has been offset by customer attrition, often from decisions made during the financial crisis of 2008. Our world-class solutions coupled with our global sales team is generating strong and consistent growth in the emerging markets. The emerging markets include China, India, Southeast Asia, Middle East, Africa, Latin America and Eastern Europe.

Our PS&E solutions are marketed in North America to municipalities and school districts, primarily in the United States.

Brand and Intellectual Property

To protect our proprietary services and software, we rely upon a combination of copyright, patent, trademark and trade secret law, confidentiality restrictions in contracts with employees, customers and others, software security measures, and registered copyrights and patents. We also have established policies requiring our personnel and representatives to maintain the confidentiality of our proprietary property. We have a number of patents and patent applications pending as well as a few registrations of our copyrights. We will continue to apply for software and business method patents on a case-by-case basis and will monitor ongoing developments in the evolving software and business method patent field. See “Risk Factors.”

We own registered trademarks for the SunGard name and own or have applied for trademark registrations for many of our services and software products. Following the AS Split-Off, AS has the right to use the Sungard Availability Services name, which does not include the right to use the SunGard name or its derivatives.

 

6


Table of Contents

Competition

Because of the breadth and highly technical nature of our solutions, most of the areas in which we compete have a relatively small number of significant competitors. In our FS business, we compete with numerous software and services companies who generally provide point solutions to address specific customer needs. While many of these companies can compete in a particular sector of the financial services industry, we believe that none of them have the ability to compete against the entire spectrum of SunGard’s solutions in the various sectors that we serve. In addition, few companies have the global reach that SunGard provides. To some degree, we also face competition from the internal IT resources of our customers and prospects. However, increased regulation is driving customers to use industry proven solutions such as those offered by SunGard. We believe that we compete effectively through our innovative solutions, dedicated resources, quality of service and breadth of offerings. In addition, we believe that our leadership, reputation and experience are important competitive advantages.

In our PS&E business, we compete with a variety of vendors depending upon customer characteristics. For example, different competitors serve educational institutions and government agencies of different sizes or types and in different states or geographic regions. Competitors in these businesses range from larger providers of generic enterprise resource planning systems to smaller providers of specialized applications and also include outsourcers and systems integrators as well as the internal IT resources of our customers and prospects. The key competitive factors in marketing public sector and K-12 systems are the accuracy and timeliness of processed information, features and adaptability of the software, level and quality of customer support, degree of responsiveness, level of software development expertise and overall net cost. We believe that we compete effectively on each of these factors and that our leadership, reputation and experience in these businesses are important competitive advantages.

Employees

As of December 31, 2014, we had approximately 13,000 employees. Our success depends partly on our continuing ability to retain and attract skilled technical, sales and management personnel. While skilled personnel are in high demand and competition exists for their talents, we have been able to retain and attract highly qualified personnel (see ITEM 1A—RISK FACTORS).

 

ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS

Certain of the matters we discuss in this Report may constitute forward-looking statements. You can identify forward-looking statements because they contain words such as “believes,” “expects,” “may,” “will,” “should,” “seeks,” “approximately,” “intends,” “plans,” “estimates” or “anticipates,” or similar expressions which concern our strategy, plans or intentions. All statements we make relating to estimated and projected earnings, margins, costs, expenditures, cash flows, growth rates and financial results are forward-looking statements. In addition, we, through our senior management, from time to time make forward-looking public statements concerning our expected future operations and performance and other developments. All of these forward-looking statements are subject to risks and uncertainties that may change at any time, and, therefore, our actual results may differ materially from those we expected. We derive most of our forward-looking statements from our operating budgets and forecasts, which are based upon many detailed assumptions. While we believe that our assumptions are reasonable, we caution that it is very difficult to predict the impact of known factors, and, of course, it is impossible for us to anticipate all factors that could affect our actual results. Some of the factors that we believe could affect our results include:

 

    global economic and market conditions;

 

    the condition of the financial services industry, including the effect of any further consolidation among financial services firms;

 

    our high degree of debt-related leverage;

 

7


Table of Contents
    the effect of war, terrorism, natural disasters or other catastrophic events;

 

    the effect of disruptions to our systems and infrastructure;

 

    the timing and magnitude of software sales;

 

    the timing and scope of technological advances;

 

    the market and credit risks associated with broker/dealer operations;

 

    the ability to retain and attract customers and key personnel;

 

    risks relating to the foreign countries where we transact business;

 

    the integration and performance of acquired businesses;

 

    the ability to obtain patent protection and avoid patent-related liabilities in the context of a rapidly developing legal framework for software and business-method patents;

 

    a material weakness in our internal controls;

 

    unanticipated changes in our income tax provision or the enactment of new tax legislation, issuance of regulations or relevant judicial decisions; and

 

    the AS Split-Off failing to qualify as a tax free transaction.

The factors described in this paragraph and other factors that may affect our business or future financial results, as and when applicable, are discussed in our filings with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”), including this Report. We assume no obligation to update any written or oral forward-looking statements made by us or on our behalf as a result of new information, future events or other factors.

Risks Related to Our Indebtedness

Our substantial leverage could adversely affect our ability to raise additional capital to fund our operations, limit our ability to react to changes in the economy or our industry, expose us to interest rate risk to the extent of our variable rate debt and prevent us from meeting our debt obligations.

As a result of being acquired on August 11, 2005 by a consortium of private equity investment funds, we are highly leveraged and our debt service requirements are significant.

Our high degree of debt-related leverage could have important consequences, including:

 

    making it more difficult for us to make payments on our debt obligations;

 

    increasing our vulnerability to general economic and industry conditions;

 

    requiring a substantial portion of cash flow from operations to be dedicated to the payment of principal and interest on our indebtedness, therefore reducing our ability to use our cash flow to fund our operations, capital expenditures and future business opportunities;

 

    exposing us to the risk of increased interest rates as certain of our borrowings, including borrowings under our senior secured credit facilities, are at variable rates of interest;

 

    restricting us from making acquisitions or causing us to make non-strategic divestitures;

 

    limiting our ability to obtain additional financing for working capital, capital expenditures, product development, debt service requirements, acquisitions and general corporate or other purposes; and

 

    limiting our ability to adjust to changing market conditions and placing us at a competitive disadvantage compared to our competitors who are less highly leveraged.

 

8


Table of Contents

We and our subsidiaries may be able to incur substantial additional indebtedness in the future, subject to the restrictions contained in our senior secured credit agreement and the indentures relating to our senior notes due 2018 and 2020 and senior subordinated notes due 2019. If new indebtedness is added to our current debt levels, the related risks that we now face could intensify.

Our debt agreements contain restrictions that limit our flexibility in operating our business.

Our senior secured credit agreement and the indentures governing our senior notes due 2018 and 2020 and senior subordinated notes due 2019 contain various covenants that limit our ability to engage in specified types of transactions. These covenants limit our ability to, among other things:

 

    incur additional indebtedness or issue certain preferred shares;

 

    pay dividends on, repurchase or make distributions in respect of our capital stock or make other restricted payments;

 

    make certain investments;

 

    sell certain assets;

 

    create liens;

 

    consolidate, merge, sell or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of our assets; and

 

    enter into certain transactions with our affiliates.

In addition, under the senior secured credit agreement, under certain circumstances, we are required to satisfy and maintain a specified financial ratio and other financial condition tests. Our ability to meet the financial ratio and tests can be affected by events beyond our control, and we may not be able to meet the ratio and tests. A breach of any of these covenants could result in a default under the senior secured credit agreement. Upon an event of default under the senior secured credit agreement, the lenders could elect to declare all amounts outstanding to be immediately due and payable and terminate all commitments to extend further credit.

If we were unable to repay those amounts, the lenders under the senior secured credit agreement could proceed against the collateral granted to them to secure that indebtedness. We have pledged a significant portion of our assets as collateral under the senior secured credit agreement. If the lenders under the senior secured credit agreement accelerate the repayment of borrowings, we may not have sufficient assets to repay the senior secured credit facilities and our unsecured indebtedness.

Risks Related to Our Business

Our business depends largely on the economy and financial markets, and a slowdown or downturn in the economy or financial markets could adversely affect our business and results of operations.

When there is a slowdown or downturn in the economy, a drop in stock market levels or trading volumes, or an event that disrupts the financial markets, our business and financial results may suffer for a number of reasons. Customers may react to worsening conditions by reducing their capital expenditures in general or by specifically reducing their IT spending. In addition, customers may curtail or discontinue trading operations, delay or cancel IT projects, or seek to lower their costs by renegotiating vendor contracts. Moreover, competitors may respond to market conditions by lowering prices and attempting to lure away our customers to lower cost solutions. If any of these circumstances remain in effect for an extended period of time, there could be a material adverse effect on our financial results. Because our financial performance tends to lag behind fluctuations in the economy, our recovery from any particular downturn in the economy may not occur until after economic conditions have generally improved.

 

9


Table of Contents

Our business depends to a significant degree on the financial services industry, and a weakening of, or further consolidation in, or new regulations affecting, the financial services industry could adversely affect our business and results of operations.

Because our customer base is concentrated in the financial services industry, our business is largely dependent on the health of that industry. When there is a general downturn in the financial services industry, or if our customers in that industry experience financial or business problems, including bankruptcies, our business and financial results may suffer. If financial services firms continue to consolidate, there could be a material adverse effect on our business and financial results. When a customer merges with a firm using its own solution or another vendor’s solution, it could decide to consolidate on a non-SunGard system, which could have an adverse effect on our financial results.

To the extent newly adopted regulations negatively impact the business, operations or financial condition of our customers, our business and financial results could be adversely affected. We could be required to invest a significant amount of time and resources to comply with additional regulations or to modify the manner in which we provide products and services to our customers; and such regulations could limit how much we can charge for our services. We may not be able to update our existing products and services, or develop new ones at all or in a timely manner, to satisfy our customers’ needs. Any of these events, if realized, could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.

Catastrophic events may disrupt or otherwise adversely affect the markets in which we operate, our business and our profitability.

Our business may be adversely affected by a war, terrorist attack, natural disaster or other catastrophe. A catastrophic event could have a direct negative impact on us or an indirect impact on us by, for example, affecting our customers, the financial markets or the overall economy. The potential for a direct impact is due primarily to our significant investment in our infrastructure. Although we maintain redundant facilities and have contingency plans in place to protect against both man-made and natural threats, it is impossible to fully anticipate and protect against all potential catastrophes. Despite our preparations, a security breach, criminal act, military action, power or communication failure, flood, severe storm or the like could lead to service interruptions and data losses for customers, disruptions to our operations, or damage to our important facilities. If any of these events happen, we may be exposed to unexpected liability, our customers may leave, our reputation may be tarnished, and there could be a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.

Our information systems’ processing environments may be subject to disruptions that could adversely affect our reputation and our business.

Our information systems’ processing environments maintain and process confidential data on behalf of our customers, some of which is critical to their business operations. For example, our capital markets systems maintain account and trading information for our customers and their clients, and our wealth management and insurance systems maintain investor account information for retirement plans, insurance policies and mutual funds. There is no guarantee that the systems and procedures that we maintain to protect against unauthorized access to such information are adequate to protect against all security breaches or cyber security threats. If our processing environments are disrupted or fail for any reason, or if our systems or facilities are infiltrated or damaged by unauthorized persons, our customers could experience data loss, financial loss, harm to reputation and significant business interruption. If that happens, we may be exposed to unexpected liability, our customers may leave, our reputation may be tarnished, and there could be a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.

Because the sales cycle for our software is typically lengthy and unpredictable, our results may fluctuate from period to period.

Our operating results may fluctuate from period to period and be difficult to predict in a particular period due to the timing and magnitude of software sales. We offer a number of our software solutions on a license

 

10


Table of Contents

basis, which means that the customer has the right to run the software on its own computers. The customer usually makes a significant up-front payment to license software, which we generally recognize as revenue when the license contract is signed and the software is delivered. The size of the up-front payment often depends on a number of factors that are different for each customer, such as the number of customer locations, users or accounts. As a result, the sales cycle for a software license may be lengthy and take unexpected turns. Further, our customers’ business models are shifting away from paying upfront license fees to paying periodic rental fees for services. Thus, it is difficult to predict when software sales will occur or how much revenue they will generate. Since there are few incremental costs associated with software sales, our operating results may fluctuate from quarter to quarter and year to year due to the timing and magnitude of software sales.

Rapid changes in technology and our customers’ businesses could adversely affect our business and financial results.

Our business may suffer if we do not successfully adapt our products and services to changes in technology and changes in our customers’ businesses. These changes can occur rapidly and at unpredictable intervals and we may not be able to respond adequately. If we do not successfully update and integrate our products and services, including our SaaS and cloud offerings, to adapt to these changes, or if we do not successfully develop new products and services needed by our customers to keep pace with these changes, then our business and financial results may suffer. Our ability to keep up with technology and business changes is subject to a number of risks and we may find it difficult or costly to, among other things:

 

    update our products and services and to develop new products fast enough to meet our customers’ needs;

 

    make some features of our products and services work effectively and securely over the Internet;

 

    integrate more of our FS solutions;

 

    update our products and services to keep pace with business, regulatory and other developments in the financial services industry, where many of our customers operate; and

 

    update our services to keep pace with advancements in hardware, software and telecommunications technology.

Some technological changes may render some of our products and services less valuable or eventually obsolete. In addition, because of ongoing, rapid technological changes, the useful lives of some technology assets have become shorter and customers are therefore replacing these assets more often. As a result, our customers are increasingly expressing a preference for contracts with shorter terms, which could make our revenue less predictable in the future. In addition, rapid changes in our upfront license sales model could result in a prolonged downward trend in our high margin software license revenue.

Our securities brokerage operations are highly regulated and subject to risks that are not encountered in our other businesses.

Domestic and foreign regulatory and self-regulatory organizations, such as the SEC, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, and the (U.K.) Financial Services Authority can, among other things, fine, censure, issue cease-and-desist orders against, and suspend or expel a broker-dealer or its officers or employees for failure to comply with the many laws and regulations that govern brokerage activities. Such sanctions may arise out of currently-conducted activities or those conducted in prior periods. Our ability to comply with these laws and regulations is largely dependent on our establishment, maintenance, and enforcement of an effective brokerage compliance program. Failure to establish, maintain, and enforce proper brokerage compliance procedures, even if unintentional, could subject us to significant losses, lead to disciplinary or other actions, and tarnish our reputation. Regulations affecting the brokerage industry may change, which could adversely affect our financial results.

 

11


Table of Contents

We are exposed to certain risks relating to the execution services provided by our brokerage operations to our customers and counterparties, which include other broker-dealers, active traders, hedge funds, asset managers, and other institutional and non-institutional clients. These risks include, but are not limited to, customers or counterparties failing to pay for or deliver securities, trading errors, the inability or failure to settle trades, and trade execution system failures. In our other businesses, we generally can disclaim liability for trading losses that may be caused by our software, but in our brokerage operations, we may not be able to limit our liability for trading losses or failed trades even when we are not at fault. As a result, we may suffer losses that are disproportionately large compared to the relatively modest profit contributions of our brokerage operations.

If we fail to comply with government regulations in connection with our business or by providing technology services to certain financial institutions, our business and results of operations may be adversely affected.

Because we act as a third-party service provider to financial institutions and provide mission-critical applications for many financial institutions that are regulated by one or more member agencies of the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council (“FFIEC”), we are subject to examination by the member agencies of the FFIEC. More specifically, we are a Multi-Regional Data Processing Servicer of the FFIEC because we provide mission critical applications for financial institutions from several data centers located in different geographic regions. As a result, the FFIEC conducts periodic reviews of certain of our operations in order to identify existing or potential risks associated with our operations that could adversely affect the financial institutions to whom we provide services, evaluate our risk management systems and controls, and determine our compliance with applicable laws that affect the services we provide to financial institutions. In addition to examining areas such as our management of technology, data integrity, information confidentiality and service availability, the reviews also assess our financial stability. Our incurrence of significant debt in connection with the LBO increases the risk of an FFIEC agency review determining that our financial stability has been weakened. A sufficiently unfavorable review from the FFIEC could result in our financial institution customers not being allowed to use our technology services, which could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial condition.

If we fail to comply with any regulations applicable to our business, we may be exposed to unexpected liability and/or governmental proceedings, our customers may leave, our reputation may be tarnished, and there could be a material adverse effect on our business and financial results. In addition, the future enactment of more restrictive laws or rules on the federal or state level, or, with respect to our international operations, in foreign jurisdictions on the national, provincial, state or other level, could have an adverse impact on business and financial results.

If we are unable to retain or attract customers, our business and financial results will be adversely affected.

If we are unable to keep existing customers satisfied, sell additional products and services to existing customers or attract new customers, then our business and financial results may suffer. A variety of factors could affect our ability to successfully retain and attract customers, including the level of demand for our products and services, the level of customer spending for information technology, the level of competition from customers that develop their own solutions internally and from other vendors, the quality of our customer service, our ability to update our products and develop new products and services needed by customers, and our ability to integrate and manage acquired businesses. Further, the markets in which we operate are highly competitive and we may not be able to compete effectively. Our services revenue, which has been largely recurring in nature, comes from the sale of our products and services under fixed-term contracts. We do not have a unilateral right to extend these contracts when they expire. Revenue from our broker/dealer businesses is not subject to minimum or ongoing contractual commitments on the part of brokerage customers. If customers cancel or refuse to renew their contracts, or if customers reduce the usage levels or asset values under their contracts, there could be a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.

 

12


Table of Contents

If we fail to retain key employees, our business may be harmed.

Our success depends on the skill, experience and dedication of our employees. If we are unable to retain and attract sufficiently experienced and capable personnel, especially in product development, sales and management, our business and financial results may suffer. For example, if we are unable to retain and attract a sufficient number of skilled technical personnel, our ability to develop high quality products and provide high quality customer service may be impaired. Experienced and capable personnel in the technology industry remain in high demand, and there is continual competition for their talents. When talented employees leave, we may have difficulty replacing them, and our business may suffer. There can be no assurance that we will be able to successfully retain and attract the personnel that we need.

We are subject to the risks of doing business internationally.

A portion of our revenue is generated outside the United States, primarily from customers located in Europe. Over the past few years we have expanded our operations in certain emerging markets in Asia, Africa, Europe, the Middle East and South America. Because we sell our services outside the United States, our business is subject to risks associated with doing business internationally. Accordingly, our business and financial results could be adversely affected due to a variety of factors, including:

 

    changes in a specific country’s or region’s political and cultural climate or economic condition;

 

    unexpected or unfavorable changes in foreign laws and regulatory requirements;

 

    difficulty of effective enforcement of contractual provisions in local jurisdictions;

 

    inadequate intellectual property protection in foreign countries;

 

    trade-protection measures, import or export licensing requirements such as Export Administration Regulations promulgated by the U.S. Department of Commerce and fines, penalties or suspension or revocation of export privileges;

 

    the effects of applicable and potentially adverse foreign tax law changes;

 

    significant adverse changes in foreign currency exchange rates;

 

    longer accounts receivable cycles;

 

    managing a geographically dispersed workforce; and

 

    difficulties associated with repatriating cash in a tax-efficient manner.

In foreign countries, particularly in those with developing economies, certain business practices may exist that are prohibited by laws and regulations applicable to us, such as the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and other anti-corruption laws. Although our policies and procedures require compliance with these laws and are designed to facilitate compliance with these laws, our employees, contractors and agents may take actions in violation of applicable laws or our policies. Any such violation, even if prohibited by our policies, could have a material adverse effect on our business and reputation.

Our acquisitions may not be successful and we may not be able to successfully integrate and manage acquired businesses.

Generally, we seek to acquire businesses that broaden our existing product lines and service offerings and expand our geographic reach. There can be no assurance that our acquisitions will be successful or that we will be able to identify suitable acquisition candidates and successfully complete acquisitions. In addition, we may finance any future acquisition with debt, which would increase our overall levels of indebtedness and related interest costs. If we are unable to successfully integrate and manage acquired businesses, then our business and financial results may suffer. It is possible that the businesses we have acquired and businesses that we acquire in

 

13


Table of Contents

the future may perform worse than expected, be subject to an adverse litigation outcome or prove to be more difficult to integrate and manage than expected. If that happens, there may be a material adverse effect on our business and financial results for a number of reasons, including:

 

    we may have to devote unanticipated financial and management resources to the acquired businesses;

 

    we may not be able to realize expected operating efficiencies or product integration benefits from our acquisitions;

 

    we may have to write-off goodwill or other intangible assets; and

 

    we may incur unforeseen obligations or liabilities (including assumed liabilities not fully indemnified by the seller) in connection with acquisitions.

We could lose revenue due to “fiscal funding” or “termination for convenience” clauses in certain customer contracts, especially in our PS and K-12 businesses.

Certain of our customer contracts, particularly those with governments and school districts, may be partly or completely terminated by the customer due to budget cuts or sometimes for any reason at all. These types of clauses are often called “fiscal funding” or “termination for convenience” clauses. If a customer exercises one of these clauses, the customer would be obligated to pay for the services we performed up to the date of exercise, but would not have to pay for any further services. In addition, governments and school districts may require contract terms that differ from our standard terms. While we have not been materially affected by exercises of these clauses or other unusual terms in the past, we may be in the future. If customers that collectively represent a substantial portion of our revenue were to invoke the fiscal funding or termination for convenience clauses of their contracts, our future business and results of operations could be adversely affected.

The private equity firms that acquired the Company (“Sponsors”) control us and may have conflicts of interest with us.

Investment funds associated with or designated by the Sponsors indirectly own, through their ownership in the Parent Companies, a substantial portion of our capital stock. As a result, the Sponsors have control over our decisions to enter into any corporate transaction regardless of whether our bondholders believe that any such transaction is in their own best interests. For example, the Sponsors could cause us to make acquisitions or pay dividends that increase the amount of indebtedness that is secured or that is senior to our senior subordinated notes, or to sell assets.

Additionally, the Sponsors are in the business of making investments in companies and may from time to time acquire and hold interests in businesses that compete directly or indirectly with us. One or more of the Sponsors may also pursue acquisition opportunities that may be complementary to our business and, as a result, those acquisition opportunities may not be available to us. So long as investment funds associated with or designated by the Sponsors continue to indirectly own a significant amount of the outstanding shares of our common stock, even if such amount is less than 50%, the Sponsors will continue to be able to strongly influence or effectively control our decisions.

If we are unable to protect our proprietary technologies and defend infringement claims, we could lose one of our competitive advantages and our business could be adversely affected.

Our success depends in part on our ability to protect our proprietary products and services and to defend against infringement claims. If we are unable to do so, our business and financial results may suffer. To protect our proprietary technology, we rely upon a combination of copyright, patent, trademark and trade secret law, confidentiality restrictions in contracts with employees, customers and others, software security measures, and registered copyrights and patents. Despite our efforts to protect the proprietary technology, unauthorized persons may be able to copy, reverse engineer or otherwise use some of our technology. It also is possible that others will

 

14


Table of Contents

develop and market similar or better technology to compete with us. Furthermore, existing patent, copyright and trade secret laws may afford only limited protection, and the laws of certain countries do not protect proprietary technology as well as United States law. For these reasons, we may have difficulty protecting our proprietary technology against unauthorized copying or use. If any of these events happens, there could be a material adverse effect on the value of our proprietary technology and on our business and financial results. In addition, litigation may be necessary to protect our proprietary technology. This type of litigation is often costly and time-consuming, with no assurance of success.

We may be sued for violating the intellectual property rights of others.

The software industry is characterized by the existence of a large number of trade secrets, copyrights and the growing number of issued patents, as well as frequent litigation based on allegations of infringement or other violations of intellectual property rights. We may unknowingly violate the intellectual property rights of others. Some of our competitors or other third parties may have been more aggressive than us in applying for or obtaining patent rights for innovative proprietary technologies both in the United States and internationally. In addition, we use a limited amount of open source software in our products and may use more open source software in the future. Because open source software is developed by numerous independent parties over whom we exercise no supervision or control, allegations of infringement for using open source software are possible. Although we monitor our use and our suppliers’ use of open source software to avoid subjecting our products to conditions we do not intend, the terms of many open source licenses have not been interpreted by United States or other courts, and there is a risk that these licenses could be construed in a manner that could impose unanticipated conditions or restrictions on our ability to commercialize our products.

As a result of all of these factors, there can be no assurance that in the future third parties will not assert infringement claims against us and preclude us from using a technology in our products or require us to enter into royalty and licensing arrangements on terms that are not favorable to us, or force us to engage in costly infringement litigation, which could result in us paying monetary damages or being forced to redesign our products to avoid infringement. Additionally, our licenses and service agreements with our customers generally provide that we will defend and indemnify them for claims against them relating to our alleged infringement of the intellectual property rights of third parties with respect to our products or services. We might have to defend or indemnify our customers to the extent they are subject to these types of claims. Any of these claims may be difficult and costly to defend and may lead to unfavorable judgments or settlements, which could have a material adverse effect on our reputation, business and financial results. For these reasons, we may find it difficult or costly to add or retain important features in our products and services.

While we do not believe we have a potential liability for damages or royalties from any known current legal proceedings or claims related to the infringement of patent or other intellectual property rights that would individually or in the aggregate materially adversely affect our financial condition and operating results, the results of such legal proceedings cannot be predicted with certainty. Should we fail to prevail in any of the matters related to infringement of patent or other intellectual property rights of others or should several of these matters be resolved against us in the same reporting period, it could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.

Defects, design errors or security flaws in our products could harm our reputation and expose us to potential liability.

Most of our products are very complex software systems that are regularly updated. No matter how careful the design and development, complex software often contains errors and defects when first introduced and when major new updates or enhancements are released. If errors or defects are discovered in our current or future products, we may not be able to correct them in a timely manner, if at all. In our development of updates and enhancements to our products, we may make a major design error that makes the product operate incorrectly or less efficiently.

 

15


Table of Contents

In addition, certain of our products include security features that are intended to protect the privacy and integrity of customer data. Despite these security features, our products and systems, and our customers’ systems may be vulnerable to break-ins and similar problems caused by third parties, such as hackers bypassing firewalls and misappropriating confidential information. Such break-ins or other disruptions could jeopardize the security of information stored in and transmitted through our computer systems and those of our customers, subject us to liability and tarnish our reputation. We may need to expend significant capital resources in order to eliminate or work around errors, defects, design errors or security problems. Any one of these problems in our products may result in the loss of or a delay in market acceptance of our products, the diversion of development resources, a lower rate of license renewals or upgrades and damage to our reputation, and in turn may increase service and warranty costs.

A material weakness in our internal controls could have a material adverse effect on us.

Effective internal controls are necessary for us to provide reasonable assurance with respect to our financial reports and to effectively prevent fraud. If we cannot provide reasonable assurance with respect to our financial reports and effectively prevent fraud, our reputation and operating results could be harmed. Internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements because of its inherent limitations, including the possibility of human error, the circumvention or overriding of controls, or fraud. Further, the complexities of our quarter- and year-end closing processes increase the risk that a weakness in internal control over financial reporting may go undetected. Therefore, even effective internal controls can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to the preparation and fair presentation of financial statements. In addition, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting to future periods are subject to the risk that the control may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

A material weakness is a deficiency, or combination of deficiencies, in internal control over financial reporting, such that there is a reasonable possibility that a material misstatement of the Company’s annual or interim financial statements will not be prevented or detected on a timely basis. A material weakness in our internal control over financial reporting could adversely impact our ability to provide timely and accurate financial information. If we are unable to report financial information timely and accurately or to maintain effective disclosure controls and procedures, we could be subject to, among other things, regulatory or enforcement actions by the SEC, any one of which could adversely affect our business prospects.

Unanticipated changes in our income tax provision or the enactment of new tax legislation, issuance of regulations or relevant judicial decisions could affect our profitability or cash flow.

We are subject to income taxes in the United States and many foreign jurisdictions. Significant judgment is required in determining our worldwide provision for income taxes. We regularly are under examination by tax authorities. Although we believe our income tax provision is reasonable, the final determination of our tax liability could be materially different from our historical income tax provisions, which could have a material effect on our financial position, results of operations or cash flows. In addition, tax-law amendments in the United States and other jurisdictions could significantly impact how United States multinational corporations are taxed. Although we cannot predict whether or in what form such legislation will pass, if enacted it could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.

Risks Related to the AS Split-Off

There could be significant liability for us if all or part of the AS Split-Off were determined to be taxable for U.S. federal or state income tax purposes.

We received opinions from outside tax counsel to the effect that the AS Split-Off should qualify for tax-free treatment as transactions described in Section 355 and related provisions of the Internal Revenue Code (the “Code”) as well as relevant state income tax authority. Notwithstanding this, the tax-free treatment is not free

 

16


Table of Contents

from doubt, and there is a risk that cannot be dismissed that the Internal Revenue Service (the “Service”), a state taxing authority or a court could conclude to the contrary that the separation of the Availability Services business from the Company, through internal spin-offs, certain related transactions and the exchange of a portion of shares of SunGard Capital Corp. II Preferred Stock for all of the shares of Sungard Availability Services Capital, Inc. (“SpinCo”) may not qualify as tax-free transactions. An opinion of tax counsel is not binding on the Service, state taxing authorities or any court and as a result there can be no assurance that a tax authority will not challenge the tax-free treatment of all or part of the AS Split-Off or that, if litigated, a court would not agree with the Service or a state taxing authority. Further, these tax opinions rely on certain facts, assumptions, representations, warranties and covenants from the Company, SpinCo and from some of our stockholders regarding the past and future conduct of the companies’ respective businesses, share ownership and other matters. If any of the facts, assumptions, representations, warranties and covenants on which the opinions rely is inaccurate or incomplete or not satisfied, the opinions may no longer be valid. Moreover, the Service or state taxing authority could determine on audit that the AS Split-Off is taxable if it determines that any of these facts, assumptions, representations, warranties or covenants are not correct or have been violated or if it disagrees with one or more conclusions in the opinions or for other reasons.

In addition, actions taken following the AS Split-Off, including certain 50 percent or greater changes by vote or value of our stock ownership or that of SpinCo, may cause the AS Split-Off to be taxable to the Company. If the AS Split-Off is determined to be taxable, the Company and possibly its stockholders could incur significant income tax liabilities. These tax liabilities could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Actions taken by SpinCo or its stockholders could cause the AS Split-Off to fail to qualify as a tax-free transaction, and SpinCo may be unable to fully indemnify us for the resulting significant tax liabilities.

Pursuant to the Tax Sharing and Disaffiliation Agreement that we entered into with SpinCo (“Tax Sharing Agreement”), SpinCo is required to indemnify us for certain taxes relating to the AS Split-Off that result from (i) any breach of the representations or the covenants made by SpinCo regarding the preservation of the intended tax-free treatment of the AS Split-Off, (ii) any action or omission that is inconsistent with the representations, statements, warranties and covenants provided to tax counsel in connection with their delivery of tax opinions to us with respect to the AS Split-Off, and (iii) any other action or omission that was likely to give rise to such taxes when taken, in each case, by SpinCo or any of its subsidiaries. Conversely, if any such taxes are the result of such a breach or certain other actions or omissions by the Company, we would be wholly responsible for such taxes. In addition, if any part of the AS Split-Off fails to qualify for the intended tax-free treatment for reasons other than those for which we or SpinCo would be wholly responsible pursuant to the provisions described above, SpinCo will be obligated to indemnify us for 23% of the liability for taxes imposed in respect of the AS Separation and we would bear the remainder of such taxes. If SpinCo is required to indemnify us for any of the foregoing reasons, SpinCo’s indemnification liabilities could potentially exceed its net asset value and SpinCo may be unable to fully reimburse or indemnify us for our significant tax liabilities arising from the AS Split-Off as provided by the Tax Sharing Agreement.

We might not be able to engage in certain strategic transactions because we have agreed to certain restrictions to comply with U.S. federal income tax requirements for a tax-free split-off.

To preserve the intended tax-free treatment of the AS Split-Off , we must comply with restrictions under current U.S. federal income tax laws for split-offs such as (i) refraining from engaging in certain transactions that would result in a 50 percent or greater change by vote or by value in our stock ownership, (ii) continuing to own and manage our historic businesses and (iii) limiting sales or redemptions of our common stock. If these restrictions and certain others are not followed, the AS Split-Off could be taxable to SunGard and possibly SunGard’s stockholders. These tax liabilities could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

 

17


Table of Contents

In the Tax Sharing Agreement, we (i) represent that we have no plan or intention to take or fail to take any action that would be inconsistent with the representations, statements, warranties and covenants provided to tax counsel in connection with their delivery of opinions to us with respect to the AS Split-Off and related transactions and (ii) covenant that during the two-year period following the AS Split-Off , we will not, except in certain specified transactions, (a) sell, issue or redeem our equity securities (or those of certain of our subsidiaries) or (b) liquidate, merge or consolidate with another person or sell or dispose of a substantial portion of our assets (or those of certain of our subsidiaries). During this two-year period, we may take certain actions prohibited by these covenants if we provide SpinCo with a ruling from the Service or a favorable opinion of tax counsel or of a nationally recognized accounting firm, reasonably satisfactory to SpinCo, to the effect that these actions should not affect the tax-free nature of the AS Split-Off .

These restrictions could limit our strategic and operational flexibility, including our ability to make acquisitions using equity securities, finance our operations by issuing equity securities, repurchase our equity securities, raise money by selling assets or enter into business combination transactions.

 

ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

None.

 

ITEM 2. PROPERTIES

We lease space in many locations worldwide, primarily for data centers, sales offices, customer support offices and administrative offices. We also own some of our computer and office facilities. Our principal facilities include our leased financial systems application service provider centers in Voorhees, New Jersey; Burlington, Massachusetts; Hopkins, Minnesota; Salem, New Hampshire; Ridgefield, New Jersey; and Wayne, Pennsylvania. We believe that our leased and owned facilities are adequate for our present operations.

 

ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

We are presently a party to certain lawsuits arising in the ordinary course of our business. We believe that none of our current legal proceedings will be material to our business, financial condition or results of operations. Information with respect to this item may be found in Note 17 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in this Report, which information is incorporated into this Item 3 by reference.

 

ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES

Not applicable.

 

18


Table of Contents

PART II

 

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANTS’ COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

Our outstanding common stock is privately held, and there is no established public trading market for our common stock. As of March 1, 2014, there were 376 holders of record of each of Class A common stock and Class L common stock of SCC, and there was one holder of record of common stock of SunGard.

See ITEM 7-LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES—COVENANT COMPLIANCE for a description of restrictions on our ability to pay dividends.

 

ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

SunGard Capital Corp.

 

     2010     2011     2012     2013      2014  
     (in millions)  

Income Statement Data (1)

           

Revenue

   $ 2,909      $ 2,921      $ 2,808      $ 2,761       $ 2,809   

Operating income (loss)

     59        242        348        404         86   

Income (loss) from continuing operations

     (463 )     (78 )     (43 )     45         (208 )

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

     (107 )     (73 )     (23 )     17         (14 )

Net Income (loss)

     (570 )     (151 )     (66 )     62         (222 )

Cash Flow Data

           

Cash flow from continuing operations

     N/A (2)   $ 164      $ 287      $ 421       $ 332   

Cash flow from discontinued operations

     N/A (2)     514        (43 )     324         33   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flow from operations

$ 721    $ 678    $ 244    $ 745    $ 365   

Balance Sheet Data

Total assets

$ 12,968    $ 12,550    $ 10,018    $ 9,778    $ 6,511   

Total short-term and long-term debt

  8,050      7,823      6,658      6,384      4,669   

Equity

  1,452      1,375      614      695      92   

SunGard Capital Corp. II

 

     2010     2011     2012     2013      2014  
     (in millions)  

Income Statement Data (1)

           

Revenue

   $ 2,909      $ 2,921      $ 2,808      $ 2,761       $ 2,809   

Operating income (loss)

     59        242        348        405         86   

Income (loss) from continuing operations

     (463 )     (78 )     (43 )     46         (208 )

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

     (107 )     (73 )     (23 )     17         (14 )

Net Income (loss)

     (570 )     (151 )     (66 )     63         (222 )

Cash Flow Data

           

Cash flow from continuing operations

     N/A (2)   $ 164      $ 287      $ 422       $ 332   

Cash flow from discontinued operations

     N/A (2)     514        (43 )     324         33   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flow from operations

$ 721    $ 678    $ 244    $ 746    $ 365   

Balance Sheet Data

Total assets

$ 12,968    $ 12,550    $ 10,018    $ 9,778    $ 6,511   

Total short-term and long-term debt

  8,050      7,823      6,658      6,384      4,669   

Equity

  1,567      1,433      688      780      169   

 

19


Table of Contents

SunGard Data Systems Inc.

 

     2010     2011     2012     2013      2014  
     (in millions)  

Income Statement Data (1)

           

Revenue

   $ 2,909      $ 2,921      $ 2,808      $ 2,761       $ 2,809   

Operating income (loss)

     59        242        348        405         87   

Income (loss) from continuing operations

     (463 )     (76 )     (43 )     46         (207

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

     (107 )     (73 )     (23 )     17         (17

Net Income (loss)

     (570 )     (149 )     (66 )     63         (224

Cash Flow Data

           

Cash flow from continuing operations

     N/A (2)   $ 164      $ 287      $ 422       $ 332   

Cash flow from discontinued operations

     N/A (2)     514        (43 )     324         33   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flow from operations

$ 721    $ 678    $ 244    $ 746    $ 365   

Balance Sheet Data

Total assets

$ 12,968    $ 12,550    $ 10,018    $ 9,774    $ 6,507   

Total short-term and long-term debt

  8,050      7,823      6,658      6,384      4,669   

Stockholder’s equity

  1,607      1,461      716      821      205   

 

(1) Included in the 2010 loss from continuing operations is a goodwill impairment charge of $205 million and a loss on the extinguishment of debt of $58 million, including tender and call premiums of $39 million, associated with the early retirement of $1.6 billion senior notes due 2013 and euro denominated term loans. Included in the 2010 loss from discontinued operations is a goodwill impairment charge of $123 million and a loss on disposal of discontinued operations of $94 million.

Included in the 2011 loss from continuing operations is a goodwill impairment charge of $12 million related to prior-year period, which has been corrected in 2011, and an income tax benefit of $48 million reflecting amortization of the deferred tax liability, which benefit would have been reflected in prior years in the statement of comprehensive income. Included in the 2011 income (loss) from discontinued operations is $135 million of deferred tax expense related to the book-over-tax basis difference of a Higher Education (“HE”) subsidiary that was classified as held for sale at December 31, 2011, and a goodwill impairment charge of $39 million.

Included in the 2012 loss from continuing operations is a loss on extinguishment of debt of $82 million, including tender and call premiums of $48 million, due primarily to the early extinguishments of the senior notes due 2015 and the senior subordinated notes due 2015, and the partial repayment of term loans in January and December 2012. Included in the 2012 income from discontinued operations are gains on the sale of discontinued operations of $571 million primarily related to the sale of HE and a goodwill impairment charge of $385 million. The AS business, which was split-off on March 31, 2014, and two small businesses within the FS segment, which were sold on January 31, 2014, are included in discontinued operations.

Included in the 2014 loss from continuing operations is a trade name impairment charge of $339 million as a result of the split-off of AS and how the trade name is being used following the split-off, and a $61 million loss on extinguishment of debt which includes (i) a $36 million loss associated with the exchange of approximately $425 million of senior notes issued by SunGard Availability Services Capital, Inc. for approximately $389 million of 7.375% senior notes due 2018 issued by SunGard and (ii) the write-off of $25 million of deferred financing fees resulting from the repayment or retirement of debt during the first quarter of 2014.

See Notes 1, 3 and 5 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

(2) The split of cash flow from continuing operations and cash flow from discontinued operations is not available for 2010 due to reclassifications of businesses into discontinued operations.

 

20


Table of Contents
ITEM 7. MANAGEMENTS DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

Our Company

SunGard is a global software company serving the financial services and the public sector and education industries. We offer a wide range of innovative software solutions, delivered as traditional software offerings or via Software as a Service (“SaaS”) and the cloud, and surround them with an extensive suite of services. These world-class systems, combined with our deep domain expertise and our steadfast attention to our customers’ needs, position us well to compete successfully and to benefit from the growth trends in the markets we serve. Considering the breadth of our product portfolio and the depth of our capabilities, we are uniquely capable of supporting virtually every type of financial institution, including the largest and most complex financial customers in the world.

In 2014, the Company generated over $2.8 billion of revenue, employing approximately 13,000 people, and serving over 15,000 customers. We are a leader in the industry and are consistently ranked in the top 10 companies in the “FinTech 100” ranking of financial technology companies.

The last few years have been truly transformative for SunGard. Since 2011, we have sold our Higher Education business and sold or exited other small non-strategic or low-margin businesses. In addition, on March 31, 2014, we completed the split-off of the Availability Services business, resulting in two separate companies. SunGard is now a more focused and streamlined software company, with financial services at its core, augmented by a leading position in the public sector and the kindergarten through 12th grade (“K-12”) education marketplaces.

During the same period, we have embarked on an organic growth strategy which is fueled by product innovation, improved sales reach, superior delivery and support of our customers’ mission critical applications. This allows us to integrate and build on our core technologies, surround them with services and support them on a global basis. As a result, customer retention has improved, new products have come to market and our sales investments have resulted in consistently improving sales results. Accelerated emerging markets growth reflects the geographic diversity and success of our investments. Finally, in the second half of 2014, we generated consistent growth, culminating in 5% constant currency growth in the fourth quarter of 2014. At the same time, our more focused approach has improved Adjusted EBITDA margins by 3 full percentage points since 2011.

Our customers’ business environment is dynamic and increasingly more complicated. Across the industries that we serve, sophisticated risk management requirements and compliance with ever-changing regulations are adding cost and complexity to our customer’s operations. At the same time, their shareholders are demanding improved efficiency and increased transparency. In this environment, our customers demand exceptional solutions and, with spending and resources under pressure, they are turning to a small number of trusted global technology companies to help make them successful. This plays to SunGard’s strength, as our applications can lower cost, improve control and speed decision making—all of which helps improve our customers’ profitability.

We are also expanding the reach of our products beyond our traditional software offerings to SaaS and the cloud. Our revenue growth is fueled by well-established SaaS offerings and global cloud delivery centers to host and support our applications. In some instances, we also perform business processing as a service (“BPaaS”), centered on our key technology, for our customers either individually or in a utility model.

Another key source of growth is our professional services organization, which offers technology consulting, product implementation and optimization to address customers’ needs. These highly skilled resources are capable of integrating and extending SunGard products into a customer’s computing infrastructure, speeding deployment and optimizing the software in their environment.

 

21


Table of Contents

Our Business Model

SunGard’s business model is founded on software, which is surrounded by services, resulting in strong recurring revenue streams with attractive profit margins. At the heart of our business model is SunGard’s proprietary intellectual property that is delivered both as traditional software licenses and also as SaaS offerings. Our license offerings have traditionally been run on our customer premises but are increasingly delivered from SunGard’s cloud computing centers. In addition, we provide professional services and business processing services (collectively, “services”).

We classify our revenue into three categories:

 

    Software revenue

 

    SaaS and Cloud revenue

 

    Professional and Business Processing Services revenue

Our revenue streams are highly recurring as a result of long-running contracts and strong customer renewal rates for software maintenance, rentals, SaaS and Cloud. These offerings comprise over 85% of our Software, SaaS and Cloud revenue (or roughly 70% of our overall revenue stream). This high-margin revenue stream provides good visibility to future results and allows the company to manage spending and profit proactively. We expect these offerings to grow in the future.

Software Revenue: Our software revenue represents approximately 40% of our total revenue and is comprised of traditional software license fees, maintenance and support fees, and fees from the resale of third party software licenses. These software license fees include term licenses, perpetual licenses and rental fees for customers who would prefer a periodic fee instead of a larger up-front payment. Maintenance and support fees provide customers with periodic technology updates and interactive support related to our software. Approximately three-fourths of our software revenue is recurring due to our long-term maintenance and rental revenue streams and strong customer renewal rates.

The remainder of our Software revenue is generated from software license sales to new and existing customers. This is very high margin revenue which may fluctuate from quarter to quarter. As a result, the timing of these license sales in any given quarter can impact that quarter’s revenue growth and profitability.

SaaS and Cloud Revenue: Our SaaS and Cloud offerings comprise approximately 38% of our total revenue. SaaS and Cloud offerings are delivered from SunGard data centers and provide customers with a secure and reliable environment operated by qualified SunGard personnel. These offerings allow customers to take advantage of SunGard’s deep domain expertise while avoiding the upfront cost of licensing and IT infrastructure. SaaS and Cloud revenue also includes revenue from our proprietary trading algorithms and trade execution network.

These SaaS and Cloud offerings are generally sold on multi-year contracts and have historically generated high customer renewal rates. As such, they form a strong recurring revenue stream for our company. Consistent with industry trends, we expect SaaS and Cloud revenue to become a greater portion of our overall revenue going forward.

Professional and Business Processing Services Revenue: Professional and Business Processing Services revenue is approximately 22% of our total revenue.

Professional Services offerings allow customers to install, optimize and integrate SunGard’s software into their computing environment. While this is not a recurring revenue stream, per se, it has generated a consistent revenue stream of $500 million to $525 million annually. The profit margin on this revenue stream is comparable to other professional services firms but lower than our software offerings. We are currently investing to improve our global delivery capacity, further improving customers’ adoption of our core technologies, but this investment puts some short-term pressure on our professional services profit margins.

 

22


Table of Contents

Our BPaaS offerings typically provide back-office processing services to our customers where the process is deeply related to a SunGard application. The combination of our industry and application knowledge, coupled with our customers’ desire to focus on their core competencies, is resulting in continued growth in these BPaaS offerings.

Geographic Operations

SunGard manages our operations in 4 major geographies around the world, generating over $2.8 billion in revenue, as described below.

 

Region

   Percent of
Total Revenue
 

North America

     64

Europe

     22

Asia Pacific

     10

Middle East, Africa, Central and South America

     4

The established markets, comprised of the US, Western Europe, Japan and Australia generated 88% of our revenue in 2014. These large, mature markets include some of our largest customers and the most extensive use of our technologies. The emerging markets are comprised of China, India, Southeast Asia, the Middle East, Africa, Latin America and Eastern Europe. These markets are less mature, but much faster growing and customers in these regions have embraced SunGard’s offerings as they compete on both a local and increasingly global basis. The emerging markets have grown consistently over time, and now comprise 12% of SunGard’s overall revenue.

Similar to our revenue, SunGard’s resources and facilities are also geographically dispersed. This provides better local customer support and also results in natural currency hedges such that currency movements that may impact revenue growth have less of an impact on profit growth.

Our Segments

We operate our company in two broad segments, Financial Systems and Public Sector & Education.

Financial Systems

Our Financial Systems (“FS”) business provides software and services to the breadth of the financial marketplace including capital markets (sell side) and asset management (buy side) customers. In addition, we provide specific offerings to address the needs of a broad range of customers, including insurance companies, corporate treasurers, wealth managers and leasing companies. Increasingly our core technology is being applied across the firms in the industry, providing greater consistency for our customers and improved operating leverage for SunGard. A brief description of our capabilities is included below.

Our Asset Management solutions address the needs of institutional investors, hedge funds, private equity, fund administrators and securities transfer agents. Our solutions support every stage of the investment process, from research and portfolio management, to valuation, risk management, compliance, investment accounting, transfer agency and client reporting.

Our Capital Markets offerings help financial institutions to increase the efficiency, transparency and control of their trading operations, post-trade settlement, risk management, securities lending, tax processing, and regulatory compliance. The breadth of our offerings also facilitate advanced business intelligence and market data distribution based on our extensive market data access.

 

23


Table of Contents

Our Corporate Liquidity solutions help chief financial officers and treasurers derive maximum value from working capital by increasing visibility to cash, reducing risk and improving communication and response time between a company’s buyers, suppliers, banks and other stakeholders.

Our Energy and Commodities solutions help energy companies, hedge funds and financial services firms to compete efficiently in global energy and commodities markets by streamlining and integrating the trading, risk management and operations of physical commodities and their associated financial instruments.

Our Insurance solutions provide solutions for a variety of insurance lines, including life and health, annuities and pensions, property and casualty, reinsurance and asset management. Our software and services help support front office and back office functions including customer service, policy administration and actuarial calculations, and financial and investment accounting and reporting.

Our Wealth Management solutions help banks, trust companies, brokerage firms, insurance firms, benefit administrators and independent advisors acquire, service and grow their client relationships. We provide solutions for client acquisition, transaction management, trust accounting and recordkeeping that can be deployed as stand-alone products or as part of an integrated wealth management platform.

Public Sector & Education

Our Public Sector & Education (“PS&E”) segment provides mission critical software and technology services to domestic governments at all levels and Kindergarten through 12th grade (“K-12”) educational institutions.

Our public sector offerings include software and technology services supporting a range of specialized enterprise resource planning and administrative processes for functions such as accounting, human resources, payroll, utility billing, land management and managed IT services. Public safety and justice agencies use our solutions to manage emergency dispatch operations, citizen and incident records, mobile computing in the field, and the operation of courts and jails. Our e-Government solutions help local governments to leverage the Internet and wireless technologies to serve their constituents.

Our K-12 Education offerings provide software solutions and related implementation and support services for K-12 school districts and private schools throughout the United States. Our software and technology services help school districts improve the efficiency of their operations and use Web-based technologies to serve their constituents. We offer a fully integrated suite of products for student information, learning management, special education, financial management and human resource activities.

Results of Operations:

We evaluate our performance using both U.S. GAAP (accounting principles generally accepted in the United States) and non-GAAP measures. Our primary non-GAAP measure is Adjusted EBITDA (defined below), whose corresponding GAAP measure is operating income.

We believe Adjusted EBITDA is an effective tool to measure our operating performance because it excludes non-cash items and certain variable charges. We use Adjusted EBITDA extensively to measure both SunGard and its reportable segments within the Company and also to report our results to our board of directors. We use a similar measure, as defined in our senior secured credit agreement, for purposes of computing our debt covenants.

While Adjusted EBITDA is useful for analysis purposes, it should not be considered as an alternative to our reported GAAP results. Also, Adjusted EBITDA may not be comparable to similarly titled measures used by other companies.

 

24


Table of Contents

Adjusted EBITDA is defined as operating income excluding the following items:

 

    depreciation;

 

    amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets;

 

    trade name and goodwill impairment charges;

 

    severance and facility closure charges;

 

    stock compensation;

 

    management fees; and

 

    certain other costs.

We are supplementing certain GAAP measures with comparable measures on a constant-currency basis, a non-GAAP measure, which exclude the impacts from changes in currency translation. We believe providing explanations of the year to year variances in our results on a constant-currency basis is meaningful for assessing how our underlying businesses have performed due to the fact that we have international operations that are material to our overall operations. As a result, total revenues and expenses are affected by changes in the U.S. Dollar against international currencies. To present our constant currency year over year changes, current period results for entities reporting in currencies other than U.S. Dollars are converted to U.S. Dollars at the average exchange rate used in the prior year period rather than the actual exchange rates in effect during the current year period. In each of the tables below, we present the percent change based on actual, unrounded results in reported currency and in constant currency.

SunGard is a wholly owned subsidiary of SunGard Holdco LLC, which is wholly owned by SunGard Holding Corp., which is wholly owned by SunGard Capital Corp. II (“SCCII”), which is a subsidiary of SunGard Capital Corp (“SCC”). SCCII and SCC are collectively referred to as the “Parent Companies.” All four of these companies were formed for the purpose of facilitating the LBO and are collectively referred to as the “Holding Companies.” The use of “we”, “our”, “us” and similar terms is meant to refer to each of SCC, SCCII and SunGard.

The following discussion reflects the results of operations and financial condition of SunGard, which are materially the same as the results of operations and financial condition of SCC and SCCII. Therefore, the discussions provided are applicable to each of SunGard, SCC and SCCII, unless otherwise noted. Also, the following discussion includes historical and certain forward-looking information that should be read together with the accompanying Consolidated Financial Statements and related footnotes and the discussion of certain risks and uncertainties (see ITEM 1A—RISK FACTORS) that could cause future operating results to differ materially from historical results or the expected results indicated by forward looking statements.

Year Ended December 31, 2014 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2013

On a GAAP basis, the Company generated revenue of $2.81 billion, operating income of $87 million, and a loss from continuing operations of $207 million for the year ended December 31, 2014. The loss from continuing operations for the year ended December 31, 2014 was primarily driven by the $339 million non-cash trade name impairment charge (see Goodwill and Trade Name impairment tests discussion below).

 

     (in millions)      Year over Year Change  
     2013      2014      Reported     Constant
Currency
 

Total Revenue

   $ 2,761       $ 2,809         2     2

Total SunGard revenue for 2014 was $2.8 billion, up 2% from 2013. Our revenue growth was due to market reception of our new technology, continued growth in the emerging markets, and growth in the broad array of

 

25


Table of Contents

services that surround and support our software. In 2014 and 2013, Software revenue was approximately 40% and 41%, respectively, of total revenue, SaaS and Cloud revenue was approximately 38% of total revenue and professional services and BPaaS revenue was approximately 22% and 21%, respectively, of total revenue.

Software revenue was relatively unchanged in 2014. Software revenue benefitted from strong customer acceptance of our latest technology but this was offset by reductions in certain legacy products, particularly in the established markets. Conversely, emerging market revenue grew in 2014 and accelerated in the second half of the year, driven by stronger maintenance revenue growth and a number of new customer wins.

SaaS and Cloud revenue increased approximately 2% in 2014 from the prior year. This growth was driven by increased volumes from our existing customers and increased adoption of our SaaS and Cloud offerings, supported by our new global delivery centers. The 2014 year to year growth rate was negatively impacted by approximately 1 point of growth due to the sale of a $12 million customer bankruptcy claim in the third quarter of 2013.

Professional services and BPaaS revenue increased approximately 5% in 2014 from the prior year primarily due to broad-based growth in professional services as customers increased spending to implement our software and integrate it into their operating environments.

Total Operating Margin:

 

     (in millions)     Year over Year Change  
     2013     2014     Reported     Constant
Currency
 

Revenue

   $ 2,761      $ 2,809        2     2

Operating income

     405        87        (79 )%      (78 )% 

Operating income margin

     14.7     3.1     (11.6 )pts      (11.5 )pts 

Our total operating income margin was 3.1% for 2014, compared to 14.7% for 2013. Total operating income margin declined 11.5 points on a constant-currency basis, driven by:

 

    a $339 million trade name impairment in 2014 reduced that period’s operating income margin by 12.0 points. There was no trade name impairment in the prior year period;

 

    a $12 million increase in spending primarily related to one-time expenses related to the AS Split-Off, which decreased the operating income margin by 0.4 points; and

 

    a $46 million decrease in amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets, which increased our margin by 1.6 points, primarily due to software intangible assets that were fully amortized during 2013 and early 2014.

The following items also impacted our 2014 operating income margin, as mentioned in our segment discussions below:

 

    investments we are making in sales, delivery and support resources in each of our segments;

 

    the increasing mix of professional services in our revenue stream; and

 

    the sale of a $12 million customer bankruptcy claim in 2013.

 

26


Table of Contents

Adjusted EBITDA:

The following table reconciles operating income to Adjusted EBITDA:

 

     (in millions)     Year over Year Change  
     2013     2014     Reported     Constant
Currency
 

Revenue

   $ 2,761      $ 2,809        2     2

Reconciliation of Operating income to Adjusted EBITDA:

        

Operating income

   $ 405      $ 87        (79 )%      (78 )% 

Depreciation (1)

     104        107        4     4

Amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets

     182        136        (25 )%      (25 )% 

Trade name impairment

     —          339        n/a        n/a   

Severance and facility closure costs

     17        27        58     62

Stock compensation

     39        42        8     8

Management fees

     8        9        9     9

Other costs

     11        18        62     63
  

 

 

   

 

 

     

Adjusted EBITDA

$ 766    $ 765      —     —  
  

 

 

   

 

 

     

Adjusted EBITDA margin

  27.7   27.2   (0.5 )pts    (0.4 )pts 

Our 2014 Adjusted EBITDA was $765 million, down $1 million from the prior year period. Our reported Adjusted EBITDA margin decreased 0.5 points to 27.2% in 2014. On a constant-currency basis, our Adjusted EBITDA margin decreased 0.4 points, driven primarily by continued investments in sales resources, increased delivery capacity to support our SaaS and Cloud offerings and skilled resources to support our professional services growth. Also, impacting the year to year decline in margin was the sale of a customer bankruptcy claim in the prior year.

Segment discussion:

Our business is organized into two segments, Financial Systems and Public Sector & Education. Corporate spending is held above the segments as noted in the table below. Corporate spending includes support functions such as corporate finance, human resources, and legal. The following table details Adjusted EBITDA for each of our two reportable segments and corporate spending to reconcile to total SunGard Adjusted EBITDA. Following the table is a discussion of each of our reportable segments.

 

     Adjusted EBITDA  
     (in millions)  
       2013          2014    

FS

   $ 746       $ 742   

PS&E

     66         68   

Corporate

     (46      (45
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ 766    $ 765   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial Systems segment:

 

     (in millions)     Year over Year Change  
     2013     2014     Reported     Constant
Currency
 

Total Revenue

   $ 2,551      $ 2,592        2     2

Adjusted EBITDA

     746        742        (1 )%      —  

Adjusted EBITDA margin

     29.2     28.6     (0.6 )pts      (0.5 )pts 

 

27


Table of Contents

Revenue:

In 2014, FS revenue grew 2% driven by SaaS and Cloud, and professional services. These results reflect the reception of our new technology offerings, particularly within our asset management, wealth management and treasury solutions, continued growth in the emerging markets, and growth in a broad array of services that surround and support our software. In 2014 and 2013, software revenue was approximately 38% and 39%, respectively, of FS revenue, SaaS and Cloud revenue was approximately 40% of FS revenue and services revenue was approximately 22% and 21%, respectively, of FS revenue.

Software revenue was relatively unchanged in 2014. Software revenue grew as a result of our new technology offerings which resulted in revenue growth in both new and existing customers. These increases however, were offset by reductions in certain legacy products.

SaaS and Cloud revenue increased approximately 1% in 2014 from the prior year. This growth was driven by increased volumes from our existing customers and increased adoption of our SaaS and Cloud offerings, supported by our new global delivery centers. The 2014 year to year growth rate was negatively impacted by approximately 1 point of growth due to the sale of a $12 million customer bankruptcy claim in the third quarter of 2013.

Professional services and BPaaS revenue increased approximately 4% in 2014 from the prior year primarily due to broad-based growth in professional services tied to our new technology offerings and increasing global reach, as customers increased their spending to implement our software and integrate it into their operating environments.

Adjusted EBITDA:

FS Adjusted EBITDA was $742 million, a decrease of 1% from the prior year period. On a constant currency basis, FS adjusted EBITDA was essentially unchanged. The FS Adjusted EBITDA margin was 28.6% and 29.2% for 2014 and 2013, respectively.

The FS Adjusted EBITDA margin decrease was driven by continued investments in sales resources, increased delivery capacity to support our SaaS and Cloud offerings and skilled resources to support our professional services growth. Also impacting the year to year margin decline was the sale of a customer bankruptcy claim in the prior year as previously discussed.

Public Sector & Education segment:

 

     (in millions)     Year over Year Change  
     2013     2014     Reported     Constant
Currency
 

Total Revenue

   $ 210      $ 217        4     4

Adjusted EBITDA

     66        68        2     2

Adjusted EBITDA margin

     31.6     31.1     (0.5 )pts      (0.5 )pts 

Revenue:

In 2014, PS&E revenue grew 4% principally driven by growth in services and accompanied by more modest increases in Software, SaaS and Cloud revenues. In 2014 and 2013, software revenue represented approximately 64% and 65%, respectively, of total PS&E revenue, SaaS and Cloud revenue was approximately 17% of segment revenue, and services revenue was approximately 19% and 18%, respectively, of PS&E revenue.

Software revenue increased 1% primarily due to annual software maintenance increases, sales to new customers and add-on sales to existing customers. SaaS and Cloud revenue increased 6% primarily due to the full

 

28


Table of Contents

year impact from new sales in 2013, add-on cloud services to the existing customer base and annual rate increases. Professional services revenue increased 12% due to new software license sales and product upgrades which generate related implementation and integration services.

Adjusted EBITDA:

PS&E Adjusted EBITDA was $68 million, an increase of 2% from 2013. On a constant currency basis, PS&E Adjusted EBITDA also increased 2%. The PS&E Adjusted EBITDA margin was 31.1% and 31.6% for 2014 and 2013, respectively. The 0.5% margin decrease was driven by investments in services and development resources to accelerate customer delivery and drive future revenue growth, partially offset by increased capitalization of software development costs.

Corporate Spending:

 

     (in millions)      Year over Year Change  
     2013      2014      Reported     Constant
Currency
 

Corporate Spending

   $ 46       $ 45         (4 )%      (4 )% 

The $1 million decrease in corporate spending was primarily due to lower employee costs and reduced external services expenses. Corporate spending includes supporting functions such as corporate finance, human resources, and legal.

Non-operating Expenses:

Interest expense and amortization of deferred financing costs:

Our interest expense was $291 million and $326 million for 2014 and 2013, respectively. The $35 million decrease in interest expense was due primarily to (i) approximately $10 million of non-capitalizable expenses associated with the March 2013 refinancing of SunGard’s senior secured credit facility and (ii) lower outstanding debt resulting from (a) the repayment of the senior secured notes due 2014 on January 15, 2014, (b) the term loan repayments in 2013 and 2014 and (c) the partial repayment of the receivables facility term loan on January 31, 2014. Interest expense related to the debt repaid or retired on March 31, 2014 in connection with the AS Split-Off was allocated to discontinued operations.

Loss on extinguishment of debt:

Loss on extinguishment of debt was $61 million and $6 million for 2014 and 2013, respectively. The loss on extinguishment of debt in 2014 includes (i) a $36 million loss associated with the exchange of approximately $425 million of senior notes issued by Sungard Availability Services, Inc. (“SpinCo”) (“SpinCo Notes”) for approximately $389 million of senior notes due 2018 issued by SunGard (“SunGard Notes”) in connection with the AS Split-Off and (ii) the write-off of $25 million of deferred financing fees resulting from the repayment or retirement of debt during the first quarter (see Notes 1 and 5 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements). Loss on extinguishment of debt in 2013 primarily includes the write-off of deferred financing fees associated with the March 2013 refinancing of $2.2 billion of term loans.

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax:

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax, was a loss of $17 million in 2014 and was income of $17 million in 2013. On March 31, 2014, we completed the AS Split-Off. Income (loss) from discontinued operations reflects the results of our AS business and two smaller FS subsidiaries that were sold in January 2014. Included in loss from discontinued operations in 2014 is a gain on the sale of two FS businesses of approximately $22 million. Also included in loss from discontinued operations in 2014 is sponsor management fee expense of approximately $15 million payable under the Management Agreement for services related to the issuance of the $1.025 billion AS term loan and $425 million of SpinCo Notes in connection with the AS Split-Off.

 

29


Table of Contents

Income (loss) attributable to the non-controlling interest:

For SCC, accreted dividends on SCCII’s cumulative preferred stock were $174 million and $169 million for 2014 and 2013, respectively. The increase in accreted dividends is due to compounding of the cumulative, undeclared dividend, partially offset by the decrease in outstanding preferred shares resulting from the share exchange as part of the AS Split-Off.

Year Ended December 31, 2013 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2012

The table below presents SunGard’s financial results including Adjusted EBITDA, and a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to GAAP operating income, which we believe to be a comparable measure.

 

     (in millions)      Year over Year Change  
     2012      2013      Reported     Constant
Currency
 

Total Revenue

   $ 2,808       $ 2,761         (2 )%      (2 )% 

In 2013 and 2012, software revenue was approximately 41% and 40%, respectively, of total revenue, SaaS and Cloud revenue was approximately 38% and 39%, respectively, of total revenue and services revenue was approximately 21% of total revenue.

Software revenue was relatively unchanged in 2013. In 2013, our license revenue increased due to new license sales of certain products, particularly in the emerging markets. In addition, software revenue benefitted from an acquisition in the fourth quarter of 2012. These increases in software revenue were offset by reductions in certain legacy products.

SaaS and Cloud revenue decreased approximately 3% in 2013 from the prior year due primarily to customer attrition, some of which was the result of customer bankruptcies and mergers. The decreases in SaaS and Cloud revenue were partially offset by the sale of a $12 million customer bankruptcy claim.

Professional services and BPaaS revenue decreased approximately 4% in 2013 from the prior year due primarily to a reduction in professional services reflecting the completion of certain large projects in 2012, partially offset by the recognition of significant customer milestones in the fourth quarter of 2013.

Total Operating Margin:

 

     (in millions)     Year over Year Change  
     2012     2013     Reported     Constant
Currency
 

Revenue

   $ 2,808      $ 2,761        (2 )%      (2 )% 

Operating income

     348        405        16     12

Operating income margin

     12.4     14.7     2.3 pts      1.7 pts 

Our total operating income margin was 14.7% for 2013. Our total operating income margin on a constant-currency basis was 14.1% for 2013 compared to 12.4% for 2012. The more significant factors impacting the 1.7 margin point improvement were:

 

    a 1.3 margin point improvement from the decrease in amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets due to a portion of software and customer base intangible assets that became fully amortized in 2012;

 

    a 0.9 margin point increase from the $25 million decrease in severance and facility closure costs; and

 

    a 0.6 margin point decrease from the combined $16 million increase in (i) depreciation due to increases in capitalized software and (ii) stock compensation expense.

 

30


Table of Contents

The following items also impacted our 2013 operating income margin, as further discussed below:

 

    lower development spending as we rationalized our overall spending and reoriented that spending to the faster growing market segments; and

 

    various reductions in spending related to our cross-company lean savings.

Adjusted EBITDA:

 

     (in millions)     Year over Year Change  
     2012     2013     Reported     Constant
Currency
 

Revenue

   $ 2,808      $ 2,761        (2 )%      (2 )% 

Reconciliation of Operating Income to Adjusted EBITDA:

        

Operating income

   $ 348      $ 405        16     12

Depreciation (1)

     96        104        9     9

Amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets

     217        182        (17 )%      (17 )% 

Severance and facility closure costs

     42        17        (59 )%      (59 )% 

Stock compensation

     31        39        24     24

Management fees

     9        8        (10 )%      (10 )% 

Other costs

     6        11        92     93
  

 

 

   

 

 

     

Adjusted EBITDA

$ 749    $ 766      2   —  
  

 

 

   

 

 

     

Adjusted EBITDA margin

  26.7   27.7   1.1  pts    0.5 p ts 

Our Adjusted EBITDA margin increased 1.1 points to 27.7% in 2013. The increase was driven by the expansion of the FS Adjusted EBITDA margin reflecting improvements in our administrative and development spending. The improvements in our development spending are the result of initiatives to exit certain slower growing products and shift our investments to new technologies. This shift also led to an increase in capitalized software, further reducing in period development spending. In addition, currency fluctuation improved margin by 0.6 points, primarily within our expense base, as the U.S. dollar strengthened against the Indian Rupee and the Pound Sterling.

Segment discussion:

The following table details the Adjusted EBITDA for each of our two reportable segments and corporate spending to reconcile total SunGard Adjusted EBITDA. Following the table below is a discussion of each of our reportable segments.

 

     Adjusted EBITDA  
     (in millions)  
       2012          2013    

FS

   $ 727       $ 746   

PS&E

     66         66   

Corporate

     (44      (46
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ 749    $ 766   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

31


Table of Contents

Financial Systems segment:

 

     (in millions)     Year over Year Change  
     2012     2013     Reported     Constant
Currency
 

Total Revenue

   $ 2,604      $ 2,551        (2 )%      (2 )% 

Adjusted EBITDA

     727        746        3     1

Adjusted EBITDA margin

     27.9     29.2     1.3 pts        0.8 pts   

Revenue:

In 2013, FS revenue declined 2% from 2012 due to customer attrition and a reduction in professional services, following completion of key 2012 milestones. In 2013 and 2012, software revenue was approximately 39% and 38%, respectively, of FS revenue, SaaS and Cloud revenue was approximately 40% of FS revenue and services revenue was approximately 21% and 22%, respectively, of FS revenue.

Software revenue was relatively unchanged in 2013. In 2013, our license revenue increased due to new license sales of certain products, particularly in the emerging markets. In addition, software revenue benefitted from an acquisition in the fourth quarter of 2012. These increases in software revenue were offset by reductions in certain legacy products.

SaaS and Cloud revenue decreased approximately 3% in 2013 from the prior year primarily due to customer attrition, some of which was the result of customer bankruptcies and mergers. The decreases in SaaS and Cloud revenue were partially offset by the sale of a $12 million customer bankruptcy claim.

Professional services and BPaaS revenue decreased approximately 4% in 2013 from the prior year due primarily to a reduction in professional services reflecting the completion of certain large projects in 2012, partially offset by the recognition of significant customer milestones in the fourth quarter of 2013.

Adjusted EBITDA:

The FS Adjusted EBITDA margin improved 1.3 points to 29.2% in 2013. Of the margin expansion, 0.5 points was due to currency fluctuation, primarily within our expense base as the U.S. dollar strengthened against the Indian Rupee and the Pound Sterling. The remaining 0.8 points of margin expansion was driven by two factors.

First, we continually execute a “lean” program designed to identify cost savings and productivity improvements. This program serves to improve our profitability and help fund our sales and development investments. For example, in 2013, we continued to reduce our administrative spending, improving margins by 1.0 point, which was driven by this program and the impact of our 2012 restructuring actions.

Second, we have realized a 0.6 margin point expansion through improvements in our development initiatives by exiting certain slower growing products or markets and shifting our investments to address the faster growing products. This also resulted in increased capitalized software, further reducing in-period development expense.

Public Sector & Education segment:

 

     (in millions)     Year over Year Change  
     2012     2013     Reported     Constant
Currency
 

Total Revenue

   $ 204      $ 210        3     3

Adjusted EBITDA

     66        66        —       —  

Adjusted EBITDA margin

     32.5     31.6     (0.9 )pts      (0.9 )pts 

 

32


Table of Contents

Revenue:

PS&E revenue grew 3% in 2013 reflecting strong acceptance of our Public Sector solutions. In 2013 and 2012, software revenue was approximately 65% and 66%, respectively, of PS&E revenue, SaaS and Cloud revenue was approximately 17% and 16%, respectively, of PS&E revenue and professional services revenue was approximately 18% of PS&E revenue.

The strong acceptance of our solutions drove a 2% increase in software revenue, a 7% increase in SaaS and Cloud revenue and a 3% increase in professional services revenue. We have been investing in professional resources to accelerate customer start dates and build customer satisfaction associated with these services.

Adjusted EBITDA:

The PS&E Adjusted EBITDA margin declined 0.9 points to 31.6% in 2013. The 0.9 point reduction is driven by incentive payments on higher sales and an increase in professional service resources to reduce our backlog and accelerate customer start dates.

Corporate Spending:

 

     (in millions)      Year over Year Change  
     2012      2013      Reported     Constant
Currency
 

Corporate Spending

   $ 44       $ 46         6     6

The $2 million increase in corporate spending was primarily due to higher employee costs.

Non-operating Expenses:

Interest expense and amortization of deferred financing costs:

Since April 2012, we refinanced approximately $3.2 billion of debt, taking advantage of the attractive debt markets, and repaid certain higher-cost senior notes. As a result, interest expense decreased to $326 million in 2013 from $360 million in 2012.

Loss on extinguishment of debt:

The refinancing and repayments of debt mentioned above resulted in a loss on extinguishment of debt of $6 million in 2013 and $82 million in 2012. The loss on extinguishment of debt in 2013 includes the loss related to the March 2013 refinance of $2.2 billion of term loans. The loss on extinguishment of debt in 2012 is driven by the early extinguishment of the senior notes due 2015, the senior subordinated notes due 2015 and the partial repayment of term loans in January and December 2012.

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax:

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax, was $17 million in 2013 and $(23) million in 2012. On March 31, 2014, we completed the AS Split-Off. During 2012, we sold our Higher Education business (“HE”) and a FS subsidiary. Also during 2012, we recorded a combined gain on the sales of two businesses of $571 million and a goodwill impairment charge of $385 million. See Note 3 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for further information.

Income (loss) attributable to the non-controlling interest:

Income (loss) attributable to the non-controlling interest represents accreted dividends on SCCII’s cumulative preferred stock. The amount of accreted dividends was $169 million and $251 million in 2013 and 2012, respectively. The decrease in accreted dividends is due to the declaration and payment of a dividend in December 2012, partially offset by compounding.

 

33


Table of Contents

Income Taxes:

The effective income tax rates for 2014 and 2013 were a benefit of 22% and a provision of 36%, respectively. Our effective tax rate fluctuates from period to period due to changes in the mix of income or losses in jurisdictions with a wide range of tax rates, permanent differences between U.S. GAAP and local tax laws, certain one-time items including tax rate changes, and adjustments related to the repatriation of earnings from foreign subsidiaries, net of a U.S. foreign tax credit. For 2014, the benefit for income taxes includes a benefit of $138 million related to the impairment of the SunGard trade name, an expense of $48 million due to changes in certain state deferred tax rates, which are primarily driven by the change in the legal entity ownership of the SunGard trade name caused by the AS Split-Off, and an expense of $7 million to increase the valuation allowance on state net operating losses driven primarily by the change in management’s judgment of their realizability due to the AS Split-Off. Also in the fourth quarter of 2014, after weighing the positive and negative evidence required, we recorded a valuation allowance of $3 million against certain losses generated in France. These losses were larger than anticipated and exceeded the scheduled reversal of deferred tax liabilities. The tax benefit of the French losses totals $24 million at December 31, 2014 and have an indefinite carryforward period. In evaluating the realizability of our deferred tax assets, we considered the scheduled reversal of deferred tax liabilities (including the impact of available carryback and carryforward periods), projected future taxable income, and for losses that do not have an indefinite carryforward period, tax planning strategies. The amount of the deferred tax asset considered realizable, however, could be reduced in the near term if estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are reduced or as the reversal of certain deferred tax liabilities continues.

The provision for income taxes includes an additional provision of $3 million compared to the provision included in the Form 8-K filed with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission on February 5, 2015. We decided to record this adjustment even though it was not material to the Consolidated Balance Sheet as of December 31, 2014 or the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income (Loss) for the year ended December 31, 2014.

The effective income tax rates for 2013 and 2012 were a provision of 36% and a benefit of 53%, respectively. Our effective tax rate fluctuates from period to period due to changes in the mix of income or losses in jurisdictions with a wide range of tax rates, permanent differences between U.S. GAAP and local tax laws, certain one-time items including tax rate changes, and adjustments related to the repatriation of earnings of foreign subsidiaries, net of a U.S. foreign tax credit.

Liquidity and Capital Resources:

At December 31, 2013 and 2014, our liquidity, a non-GAAP measure, was as follows (in Millions):

 

     (Pre AS Split-Off)
December 31, 2013
     (Post AS Split-Off)
March 31, 2014
     December 31,
2014
 

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 706       $ 355       $ 447   

Capacity: Revolving Credit Facility

     831         591         592   

Capacity: Receivables Facility

     46         15         39   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Liquidity

$ 1,583    $ 961    $ 1,078   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liquidity represents the amount of cash and readily available sources of cash. We use total liquidity to ensure we have an adequate amount of funds to meet our obligations.

Included in cash and cash equivalents at December 31, 2014 was $95 million invested in money market accounts in the United States immediately available for debt service. Approximately $196 million of cash and cash equivalents at December 31, 2014 was held by our wholly-owned non-U.S. subsidiaries, which is available

 

34


Table of Contents

to fund operations and strategic investment opportunities abroad. Also, approximately $43 million of cash and cash equivalents at December 31, 2014 relates to our broker/dealer operations, some of which is not readily available for general corporate use.

Our cash flows in the U.S. continue to be sufficient to fund our current domestic operations and obligations, including financing activities such as debt service. In addition, we have several options available to improve liquidity in the short term in the U.S., including repatriation of funds from foreign subsidiaries, borrowing funds under our revolving credit facilities, and calling intercompany loans that are in place with certain foreign subsidiaries. To the extent we elect to repatriate the earnings of our foreign subsidiaries, additional cash taxes could be payable. See Note 12 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for the year ended December 31, 2014 for more detail.

Cash flow from operations:

Cash flow from continuing operations was $332 million in 2014, a decrease of $90 million versus 2013. In late 2012, we instituted a series of working capital and tax initiatives, which generated a significant increase in 2013 cash flow from continuing operations. The decrease in 2014 cash flow from continuing operations was due to:

 

    a $91 million reduction in cash sourced from working capital, reflecting our strong 2013 performance in A/R collections and reduced Days Sales Outstanding (DSO). In addition, 2014 cash flow from working capital was reduced due to higher incentive payments resulting from the strong performance in 2013; and

 

    a $19 million decrease in cash earned from operations, primarily due to lower operating performance and transaction costs associated with the AS Split-Off; partially offset by

 

    $12 million less in interest payments;

 

    $8 million less in income tax payments, net of refunds.

Cash flow from continuing operations in 2013 was $422, an increase of $135 million versus 2012. The improvement in cash flow from operations in 2012 was primarily due to:

 

    $83 million of lower interest payments in 2013;

 

    a $37 million increase in cash earned from operations;

 

    a $15 million decrease in income tax payments in 2013; and

 

    a net increase in cash flow from deferred revenue and accounts receivable reflecting our strong 2013 performance in A/R collections and reduced DSO offset primarily by a one-time benefit in 2012 from exiting certain lower margin services in our Broker/Dealer business which required significant cash reserves.

Cash flow from investing activities:

Net cash used by continuing operations in investing activities is primarily comprised of cash paid for property and equipment and capitalized software development, as well as cash paid to acquire businesses. In 2014, cash paid by continuing operations for investing activities increased by $35 million to $147 million primarily due to a $21 million increase in capitalized software development costs related to our product investments, as well as investments to increase hosting and cloud capacity on a global basis. We have been shifting our investment strategy to new product development initiatives to address the faster growing products, services and geographic markets. The remainder of the increase was primarily due to $7 million of purchased software and a $4 million increase generally tied to computer and telecommunications equipment.

In 2013, cash paid by continuing operations for investing activities decreased by $24 million to $112 million primarily due to a $38 million decrease in cash paid for businesses acquired and a $5 million decrease in capital

 

35


Table of Contents

expenditures generally tied to computer and telecommunications equipment, partially offset by a $19 million increase in capitalized software development costs. We have been very selective in our acquisition strategy, spending $2 million in 2013 for one acquisition and $40 million in 2012 for two acquisitions.

Cash flow from financing activities:

In 2014, net cash from continuing operations used in financing activities was $1.355 billion, which included the following:

 

    repayment of $1.005 billion of term loans as part of the AS Split-Off;

 

    repayment of the $250 million senior secured notes;

 

    repayment of $60 million of our receivables facility term loan; and

 

    repayment of the $7 million tranche A term loan maturing in February 2014.

In 2013, net cash from continuing operations used in financing activities was $325 million, which included the following:

 

    refinancing $2.2 billion of term loans;

 

    additional repayments of $224 million of term loans; and

 

    repayment of $50 million of our receivables facility revolver.

In 2012, net cash from continuing operations used in financing activities was $2.04 billion, which included the following:

 

    repayment of $1.22 billion of term loans resulting from the sale of HE;

 

    $1.02 billion to repurchase and redeem $1 billion of senior subordinated notes due 2015;

 

    a $724 million preferred stock dividend;

 

    $527 million to redeem the 10.625% senior notes due 2015; and

 

    $217 million of optional prepayments of term loans;

partially offset by

 

    the issuance of $1 billion of senior subordinated notes due 2019; and

 

    a $720 million term loan to fund the dividend.

 

36


Table of Contents

As a result of the LBO (August 11, 2005), we are highly leveraged. Total debt outstanding as of December 31, 2013, March 31, 2014 (post AS Split-Off) and December 31, 2014 consists of the following (in millions):

 

     (pre AS
Split-Off)
December 31,
2013
    (post AS
Split-Off)
March 31,
2014
    December 31,
2014
    Change from
Mar. 31 to
Dec. 31
 

Senior Secured Credit Facilities:

        

Secured revolving credit facility due March 8, 2018

   $ —        $ —        $ —        $ —     

Tranche A due February 28, 2014, effective interest rate of 1.92%

     7        —          —          —     

Tranche C due February 28, 2017, effective interest rate of 4.41%, 4.44% and 4.44%

     427        400        400        —     

Tranche D due January 31, 2020, effective interest rate of 4.50%

     713        —          —          —     

Tranche E due March 8, 2020, effective interest rate of 4.10%, 4.31% and 4.31%

     2,183        1,918        1,918        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Senior Secured Credit Facilities

  3,330      2,318      2,318      —     

Senior Secured Notes due 2014 at 4.875%

  250      —        —        —     

Senior Notes due 2018 at 7.375%

  900      511      511      —     

Senior Notes due 2020 at 7.625%

  700      700      700      —     

Senior Subordinated Notes due 2019 at 6.625%

  1,000      1,000      1,000      —     

Secured accounts receivable facility, at 3.67%, 3.66% and 3.16%

  200      140      140      —     

Other, primarily foreign bank debt and capital lease obligations

  4      2      —        (2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Debt—continuing operations

  6,384      4,671      4,669      (2

Debt—discontinued operations

  8      —        —        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total debt

$ 6,392    $ 4,671    $ 4,669    $ (2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Leverage Metric per Credit Agreement

  4.56x      5.42x      5.41x      -0.01x   

Weighted Average Interest Rate

  5.42   5.63   5.61   -0.02 points   

Percent Fixed Rate (swap adjusted)

  54   67   67   0 points   

Percent Bonds of Total Debt

  45   47   47   0 points   

At December 31, 2013, March 31, 2014 (post AS Split-Off) and December 31, 2014, the contractual future maturities of debt of continuing operations were as follows (in millions):

 

     (pre AS
Split-Off)
December 31,
2013
     (post AS
Split-Off)
March 31,
2014
     December 31,
2014
     Change from
Mar. 31 to
Dec. 31
 

2014

   $ 290       $ —         $ —         $ —     

2015

     29         2         —           (2

2016

     29         —           —           —     

2017

     656         540         400         (140

2018

     929         511         511         —     

2019

     1,029         1,000         1,140         140   

Thereafter

     3,422         2,618         2,618         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ 6,384    $ 4,671    $ 4,669    $ (2
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

37


Table of Contents

See Notes 1 and 5 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements which contains a full description of our debt.

In 2012, 2013 and 2014, we restructured our debt in light of the attractive credit markets. Specifically, we have extended our maturities, lowered our interest rates, removed the financial maintenance covenants with respect to our term loan facility and used interest rate swaps to manage the amount of floating rate debt in order to reduce our exposure to variable rate interest payments.

Senior Secured Credit Facilities

We had $592 million of available borrowing capacity and $8 million of outstanding letters of credit under our $600 million revolving credit facility as of December 31, 2014. In addition, we had $4 million of letters of credit outstanding at December 31, 2014 that did not impact availability under the revolving credit facility.

On February 7, 2014, we amended and restated our Amended and Restated Credit Agreement dated as of August 11, 2005, as amended and restated from time to time (“Credit Agreement”) to, among other things, (a) amend certain covenants and other provisions of the Credit Agreement in order to permit the AS Split-Off, including (i) the ability to effect the split-off without requiring an initial public offering, (ii) permitting AS to incur up to $1.5 billion of indebtedness in connection with the split-off, and (iii) SunGard’s total secured leverage ratio (less cash and Cash Equivalents in excess of $50 million), after giving pro forma effect to the split-off, to increase no more than 0.60x of Adjusted EBITDA at the time of the split-off; and (b) amend certain covenants and other provisions in order to, among other things (i) modify the financial maintenance covenant included therein, and (ii) permit us and our affiliates to repurchase term loans.

On February 28, 2014, we repaid the remaining $7 million tranche A term loan. On March 31, 2014 in connection with the AS Split-Off, we used the $1,005 million net cash proceeds we received from SpinCo from the issuance of a SpinCo term loan facility to repay approximately $27 million of our tranche C term loan, $713 million of our tranche D term loan and $265 million of our tranche E term loan.

Tranche E and the revolving credit commitments are subject to certain springing maturities which are described in the Credit Agreement.

Secured Accounts Receivable Facility

We also maintain a secured accounts receivables facility, which consists of an outstanding term loan of $140 million and a revolving credit commitment of $60 million as of December 31, 2014. At December 31, 2014, $364 million of accounts receivable secured the borrowings under the receivables facility, and no amount was drawn on the revolving commitment. During January 2014, we removed AS as a seller in the accounts receivable facility and, as a result, we repaid $60 million of the term loan component which permanently reduced the facility limit. The impact of removing AS as a seller and the resulting $60 million repayment of the term loan had the effect of reducing the amount available for borrowing to an aggregate of $200 million, which is comprised of a $140 million term loan and a $60 million revolving credit commitment.

The receivables facility contains certain covenants. We are required to satisfy and maintain specified facility performance ratios, financial ratios and other financial condition tests.

On May 14, 2014, we amended and restated our secured accounts receivable facility in order to, among other things, (i) extend the maturity date from December 19, 2017 to May 14, 2019 and (ii) reduce the applicable margin on the advances under the facility from 3.50% for LIBOR advances and 2.50% for base rate advances to 3.00% and 2.00%, respectively.

 

38


Table of Contents

Interest Rate Swaps

We use interest rate swap agreements to manage the amount of our floating rate debt in order to reduce our exposure to variable rate interest payments associated with the senior secured credit facilities. We pay a stream of fixed interest payments for the term of the swap, and in turn, receive variable interest payments based on one-month LIBOR or three-month LIBOR (0.17% and 0.26%, respectively, at December 31, 2014). The net receipt or payment from the interest rate swap agreements is included in interest expense. As of December 31, 2014, including the impact of our outstanding interest rate swaps, the composition of our debt was 67% fixed and 33% floating. A summary of our interest rate swaps at December 31, 2014 follows (in millions):

 

Inception

   Maturity    Notional
Amount
(in millions)
     Interest rate
paid
    Interest
rate
received
(LIBOR)
 

August-September 2012

   February 2017    $ 400         0.69     1-Month   

June 2013

   June 2019      100         1.86     3-Month   

September 2013

   June 2019      100         2.26     3-Month   

February-March 2014

   March 2020      300         2.27     3-Month   
     

 

 

      
$ 900      1.52
     

 

 

      

Contractual Obligations

At December 31, 2014, our contractual obligations follow (in millions):

 

     Total      2015      2016      2017      2018-2019      Therafter  

Short-term and long-term debt

   $ 4,669       $ —         $ —         $ 400       $ 1,651       $ 2,618   

Interest payments (1)

     1,323         269         271         257         451         75   

Operating leases

     231         62         56         45         47         21   

Purchase obligations (2)

     123         94         19         6         4         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ 6,346    $ 425    $ 346    $ 708    $ 2,153    $ 2,714   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) Interest payments consist of interest on both fixed-rate and variable-rate debt. Variable-rate debt consists primarily of the tranche E term loan facility ($1,418 million at 4.00%), and the secured accounts receivable facility ($140 million at 3.16%), each as of December 31, 2014. See Note 5 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
(2) Purchase obligations include our estimate of the minimum outstanding obligations under noncancelable commitments to purchase goods or services.

Gross reserves for uncertain tax positions approximated $104 million as of December 31, 2014. We believe it is more-likely-than-not that the uncertain tax positions for which a benefit has been recognized are sustainable, based solely on their technical merits and consideration of the relevant taxing authority’s widely understood administrative practices and precedents. However, we have only recorded the portion of these tax benefits that are greater than fifty percent likely to be realized upon settlement with the taxing authority. To the extent that the relevant taxing authority disagrees with our positions it may result in a future cash outlay, which is not included in the contractual obligations table above. See Note 12 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

At December 31, 2014, contingent purchase price obligations that depend upon the operating performance of certain acquired businesses were $6 million, of which approximately $0.5 million is included in other long-term liabilities. We also have outstanding letters of credit and bid bonds that total approximately $19 million.

 

39


Table of Contents

We expect our available cash balances and cash flows from operations, combined with availability under the revolving credit facility and receivables facility, to provide sufficient liquidity to fund our current obligations, projected working capital requirements and capital spending for a period that includes at least the next 12 months.

Depending on market conditions, SunGard, its Sponsors and their affiliates may from time to time repurchase debt securities issued by SunGard, in privately negotiated or open market transactions, by tender offer or otherwise.

Covenant Compliance

As of December 31, 2014, we are in compliance with all financial and nonfinancial covenants. While we believe that we will remain in compliance, our continued ability to meet those financial ratios and tests can be affected by events beyond our control, and there is no assurance that we will continue to meet those ratios and tests.

Our senior secured credit facilities and the indentures governing our senior notes due 2018 and 2020 and our senior subordinated notes due 2019 contain various covenants that limit our ability to engage in specified types of transactions. These covenants limit our ability to, among other things:

 

    incur additional indebtedness or issue certain preferred shares,

 

    pay dividends on, repurchase or make distributions in respect of our capital stock or make other restricted payments,

 

    make certain investments,

 

    sell certain assets,

 

    create liens,

 

    consolidate, merge, sell or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of our assets, and

 

    enter into certain transactions with our affiliates.

In addition, pursuant to the Principal Investor Agreement by and among our Holding Companies and the Sponsors, we are required to obtain approval from our Sponsors prior to the declaration or payment of any dividend by us or any of our subsidiaries (other than dividends payable to us or any of our wholly owned subsidiaries).

Under the terms of our Credit Agreement, the financial maintenance covenant is applicable at quarter end only if there is an amount outstanding under the revolving credit facility that is greater than or equal to 25% of the total revolving commitments (see footnote 1 below for further details). If applicable, the financial maintenance covenant allows a maximum total leverage ratio of 6.35x at the end of such quarter through December 31, 2014, 6.00x at the end of such quarter through December 31, 2015 and 5.75x thereafter.

If the financial maintenance covenant in the revolving credit facility were to apply and we failed to satisfy such covenant, then a default solely of the revolving credit facility would occur. If the revolving credit lenders fail to waive such default, then the revolving credit lenders could elect (upon a determination by a majority of the revolving credit lenders) to terminate their commitments and declare all amounts borrowed under the revolving credit facility due and payable. If this happens, all amounts borrowed under the senior secured term loan facilities would be due and payable as well. This acceleration would also result in a default under the indentures.

Under the indentures governing SunGard’s senior notes due 2018 and 2020 and senior subordinated notes due 2019 and SunGard’s senior secured credit agreement, our ability to incur additional indebtedness, make investments and pay dividends remains tied to a leverage or fixed charge ratio based on Adjusted EBITDA.

 

40


Table of Contents

Adjusted EBITDA, in our credit facilities, is defined as EBITDA, which we define as earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization, further adjusted to exclude certain adjustments permitted in calculating covenant compliance under the indentures and senior secured credit facilities. Adjusted EBITDA is a non-GAAP measure used to determine our compliance with certain covenants contained in the indentures governing the senior notes due 2018 and 2020 and senior subordinated notes due 2019 and in our senior secured credit agreement. We believe that the inclusion of supplementary adjustments to EBITDA applied in presenting Adjusted EBITDA are appropriate to provide additional information to investors to demonstrate compliance with the financing covenants.

Adjusted EBITDA does not represent net income (loss) or cash flow from operations as those terms are defined by GAAP and does not necessarily indicate whether cash flows will be sufficient to fund cash needs. While Adjusted EBITDA and similar measures are frequently used as measures of operations and the ability to meet debt service requirements, these terms are not necessarily comparable to other similarly titled captions of other companies due to the potential inconsistencies in the method of calculation. Adjusted EBITDA does not reflect the impact of earnings or charges resulting from matters that we may consider not to be indicative of our ongoing operations. In particular, the definition of Adjusted EBITDA in the indentures allows us to add back certain noncash, extraordinary or unusual charges that are deducted in calculating net income (loss). However, these are expenses that may recur, vary greatly and are difficult to predict. Further, our debt instruments require that Adjusted EBITDA be calculated for the most recent four fiscal quarters. As a result, the measure can be disproportionately affected by a particularly strong or weak quarter. Further, it may not be comparable to the measure for any subsequent four-quarter period or any complete fiscal year. Adjusted EBITDA is similar, but not identical, to Adjusted EBITDA used to measure our performance (see Note 14 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for the year ended December 31, 2014).

The following is a reconciliation for SunGard of income (loss) from continuing operations, which is a GAAP measure of our operating results, to Adjusted EBITDA as defined in our debt agreements (in millions). This is similar, but not identical, to Adjusted EBITDA used for segment reporting as disclosed earlier. The terms and related calculations are defined in the credit agreement.

 

     2012     2013      2014  

Income (loss) from continuing operations

   $ (43   $ 46       $ (207

Interest expense, net

     359        325         290   

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

     (49     26         (57

Depreciation

     96        104         107   

Amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets

     217        182         136   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

EBITDA

  580      683      269   

Trade name impairment charge

  —        —        339   

Purchase accounting adjustments (a)

  7      6      1   

Stock compensation expense

  31      39      42   

Restructuring charges (b)

  42      17      27   

Management fees

  9      8      9   

Acquired EBITDA, net of disposed EBITDA (c)

  3      —        —     

Other costs (d)

  (3   3      16   

Loss on extinguishment of debt (e)

  82      6      61   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA—senior secured credit facilities, senior notes due 2018 and 2020 and senior subordinated notes due 2019

$ 751    $ 762    $ 764   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Purchase accounting adjustments include the adjustment of deferred revenue and lease reserves to fair value at the dates of the LBO and subsequent acquisitions made by SunGard and certain acquisition-related compensation expense.
(b) Restructuring charges includes severance and related payroll taxes and reserves to consolidate certain facilities.

 

41


Table of Contents
(c) Acquired EBITDA net of disposed EBITDA reflects the EBITDA impact of businesses that were acquired or disposed of during the period as if the acquisition or disposition occurred at the beginning of the period.
(d) Other costs includes strategic initiative expenses, certain other expenses associated with acquisitions made by the Company and franchise and similar taxes reported in operating expenses, partially offset by certain charges relating to the receivables facility.
(e) Loss on extinguishment of debt includes in 2012 the write-off of deferred financing fees associated with the January 2012 repayment of $1.22 billion of our US$-denominated term loans, the April 2012 retirement of $500 million, 10.625% senior notes due 2015, the December 2012 retirement of $1 billion, 10.25% senior subordinated notes due 2015 and the December 2012 repayment of $217 million of US$-denominated term loans. Loss on extinguishment of debt for 2014 primarily includes (i) a $36 million loss associated with the exchange of SpinCo Notes for SunGard Notes and (ii) the write-off of deferred financing fees associated with (a) the repayment of $1.005 billion of term loans and the retirement of $389 million of senior notes due 2018, both resulting from the AS Split-Off (see Note 1 and Note 5 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements), (b) the $250 million reduction of the revolving credit facility and (c) the repayment of $60 million of the accounts receivable facility term loans.

Covenant Ratios

Our covenant requirements and actual ratios for the year ended December 31, 2014 are as follows:

 

     Covenant
Requirements
     Actual
Ratios
 

Senior secured credit facilities (1)

     

Maximum total debt to Adjusted EBITDA

     6.35x         5.41x   

Senior notes due 2018 and 2020 and senior subordinated notes due 2019 (2)

     

Minimum Adjusted EBITDA to fixed charges ratio required to incur additional debt pursuant to ratio provisions

     2.00x         3.09x   

 

(1) If on the last day of any four consecutive fiscal quarters (“Test Period”) ending on December 31, 2014 our total revolving credit exposure minus the lesser of (x) the amount of outstanding letters of credit under the senior secured revolving credit facility and (y) $25 million, is equal to or greater than an amount equal to 25% of our aggregate revolving credit commitments, then on such day, we would be required to maintain a maximum consolidated total debt to Adjusted EBITDA ratio of 6.35x which steps down to 6.00x for any Test Period after December 31, 2014 and on or before December 31, 2015 and to 5.75x for any Test Period after December 31, 2015. Consolidated total debt is defined in the senior secured credit facilities as total debt less (i) certain indebtedness and (ii) cash and cash equivalents on our balance sheet in excess of $50 million. Failure to satisfy this ratio requirement would constitute a default solely under the senior secured revolving credit facility. If our revolving credit facility lenders failed to waive any such default and subsequently accelerated our obligations or terminated their commitments under the senior secured revolving credit facility, our repayment obligations under the senior secured term loan facilities would be accelerated as well, which would also constitute a default under our indentures.

 

(2) SunGard’s ability to incur additional debt and make certain restricted payments under our indentures, subject to specified exceptions, is tied to an Adjusted EBITDA to fixed charges ratio of at least 2.0x, except that we may incur certain debt and make certain restricted payments and certain permitted investments without regard to the ratio, such as the ability to incur up to an aggregate principal amount of $5.75 billion under credit facilities (inclusive of amounts outstanding under the senior credit facilities from time to time; as of December 31, 2014, we had $2.32 billion outstanding under the term loan facilities and available commitments of $592 million under the revolving credit facility), to acquire persons engaged in a similar business that become restricted subsidiaries and to make other investments equal to 6% of our consolidated assets. Fixed charges is defined in the indentures governing the Senior Notes due 2018 and 2020 and the Senior Subordinated Notes due 2019 as consolidated interest expense less interest income, adjusted for acquisitions, and further adjusted for non-cash interest and the elimination of interest expense and fees associated with the receivables facility.

 

42


Table of Contents

Use of Estimates and Critical Accounting Policies

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”) requires us to make many estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenue and expenses. Those estimates and judgments are based on historical experience, future expectations and other factors and assumptions we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances. We review our estimates and judgments on an ongoing basis and revise them when necessary. Actual results may differ from the original or revised estimates. A summary of our significant accounting policies is contained in Note 1 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. A description of the most critical policies and those areas where estimates have a relatively greater effect in the financial statements follows. Management has discussed the critical accounting policies described below with our audit committee.

Revenue Recognition

We generate revenue from the following sources: (1) software revenue, (2) SaaS and Cloud revenue, and (3) services revenue.

Software Revenue: Our software revenue represents approximately 40% of our total revenue and is comprised of traditional software license fees, maintenance and support fees, and fees from the resale of third party software licenses. These software license fees include term licenses, perpetual licenses and rental fees for customers who would prefer a periodic fee instead of a larger up-front payment. Maintenance and support fees provide customers with periodic technology updates and interactive support related to our software. Approximately three-fourths of our software revenue is recurring due to our long-term maintenance and rental revenue streams and strong customer renewal rates.

The remainder of our Software revenue is generated from software license sales to new and existing customers. This is very high margin revenue which may fluctuate from quarter to quarter. As a result, the timing of these license sales in any given quarter can impact that quarter’s revenue growth and profitability.

SaaS and Cloud Revenue: Our SaaS and Cloud offerings comprise approximately 38% of our total revenue. SaaS and Cloud offerings are delivered from SunGard data centers and provide customers with a secure and reliable environment operated by qualified SunGard personnel. These offerings allow customers to take advantage of SunGard’s deep domain expertise while avoiding the upfront cost of licensing and IT infrastructure. SaaS and Cloud revenue also includes revenue from our proprietary trading algorithms and trade execution network.

These SaaS and Cloud offerings are generally sold on multi-year contracts and have historically generated high customer renewal rates. As such, they form a strong recurring revenue stream for our company.

Professional and Business Processing Services Revenue: Professional and Business Processing Services revenue is approximately 22% of our total revenue.

Professional Services offerings allow customers to install, optimize and integrate SunGard’s software into their computing environment. While this is not a recurring revenue stream, per se, it has generated a consistent revenue stream of $500 million to $525 million annually. The profit margin on this revenue stream is comparable to other professional services firms but lower than our software offerings.

SunGard’s BPaaS offerings typically provide back-office processing services to our customers where the process is deeply related to a SunGard application.

The following criteria must be met in determining whether revenue may be recorded: persuasive evidence of a contract exists; software has been delivered and/or services have been provided; the price is fixed or determinable; and collection is reasonably assured.

 

43


Table of Contents

Revenue is recorded as the services are provided based on the relative fair value of each element. FS software maintenance and SaaS and Cloud revenue includes monthly fees, which may include a fixed minimum fee and/or variable fees based on a measure of volume or activity, such as the number of accounts, trades or transactions, users or the number of hours of service. Software rentals combine the license and maintenance services into a bundled element, and the fee is recognized ratably over the corresponding services period when the customer has the right to use the software product and receive maintenance and support services.

For fixed-fee professional services contracts, revenue is recorded based upon proportional performance, measured by the actual number of hours incurred divided by the total estimated number of hours for the project. Changes in the estimated costs or hours to complete the contract and losses, if any, are reflected in the period during which the change or loss becomes known. We also provide professional services on a time and materials basis, recognized monthly based upon hours incurred to date. In all cases contract milestones, project risk profile and refund provisions are taken into consideration.

Software license fees result from contracts that permit the customer to use a SunGard software product at the customer’s site or at the site of their choosing if the customer has the contractual right to take immediate possession of the software without significant penalty. Generally, these contracts are multiple-element arrangements since they usually provide for professional services and ongoing software maintenance. In these instances, license fees are recognized upon the signing of the contract and delivery of the software if the license fee and fees for other elements within the arrangement are fixed or determinable, collection is probable, and there is sufficient vendor specific evidence of the fair value of each undelivered element. When there are significant program modifications or customization, installation, systems integration or related services, the professional services and license revenue are combined in accordance with contract accounting guidance and recorded based upon proportional performance, measured in the manner described above. License revenue is recorded as each installment becomes due if customer payments are extended beyond normal billing terms, or at acceptance when there is significant acceptance, technology or service risk. Revenue also is recorded over the longest service period in those instances where the software is bundled together with post-delivery services and there is not sufficient evidence of the fair value of each undelivered service element.

With respect to software-related multiple element arrangements, sufficient evidence of fair value is defined as vendor specific objective evidence (“VSOE”). VSOE of the fair value for each element within an arrangement is based on either historical stand-alone sales of the element to third parties or stated renewal rates within the contract. If there is no VSOE of the fair value of the delivered element (which is usually the software since the license is rarely if ever sold separately) but there is VSOE of the fair value of each of the undelivered elements (typically maintenance and professional services), then the residual method is used to determine the portion of the arrangement fee allocated to the delivered element. The revenue for each of the undelivered elements is set at the fair value of those elements using VSOE of the price paid when each of the undelivered elements is sold separately. The revenue remaining after allocation to the undelivered elements (i.e., the residual) is allocated to the delivered element.

Our maintenance and support offerings entitle our customers to receive product upgrades and enhancements on a when and if available basis along with technical support, and revenue is recognized ratably over the term of the maintenance and support arrangement. VSOE supporting the fair value of maintenance and support is based on the stated (optional) renewal rates contained in the initial arrangement. VSOE for the maintenance element is dependent upon the software product and the annual maintenance fee is typically 18% to 20% of the software license fee. VSOE supporting the fair value of professional services is based on the standard daily rates charged when those services are sold separately, represented by a substantial portion of transactions falling within a reasonably tight pricing range.

In some software-related multiple-element arrangements, the maintenance or professional services rates are discounted. In these cases, a portion of the software license fee is deferred and recognized as the maintenance or professional services are performed based on VSOE of the services.

 

44


Table of Contents

From time to time, we enter into arrangements with customers that purchase non-software related services at the same time, or within close proximity, of purchasing software (non-software multiple-element arrangements). Each element within a non-software multiple-element arrangement is accounted for as a separate unit of accounting provided the following criteria are met: the delivered services have value to the customer on a standalone basis; and for an arrangement that includes a general right of return relative to the delivered services, delivery or performance of the undelivered service is considered probable and is substantially controlled by us. Where the criteria for a separate unit of accounting are not met, the deliverable is combined with the undelivered element(s) and treated as a single unit of accounting for the purposes of allocation of the arrangement consideration and revenue recognition.

For non-software multiple-element arrangements, we allocate revenue to each element based on a selling price hierarchy at the arrangement inception. The selling price for each element is based upon the following selling price hierarchy: VSOE, then third-party evidence (“TPE”), then best estimated selling price (“BESP”). The total arrangement consideration is allocated to each separate unit of accounting for each of the non-software deliverables using the relative selling prices of each unit based on this hierarchy. We limit the amount of revenue recognized for delivered elements to an amount that is not contingent upon future delivery of additional products or services or meeting of any specified performance conditions.

To determine the selling price in non-software multiple-element arrangements, we establish VSOE of the selling price using the price charged for a deliverable when sold separately. Where VSOE does not exist, TPE is established by evaluating similar competitor products or services in standalone arrangements with similarly situated customers. If we are unable to determine the selling price because VSOE or TPE doesn’t exist, we determine BESP for the purposes of allocating the arrangement consideration. BESP can be determined by considering pricing practices, margin objectives, contractually stated prices, competitive/market conditions and geographies.

Unbilled receivables are created when services are performed or software is delivered and revenue is recognized in advance of billings. Deferred revenue is created when billing occurs in advance of performing services or when all revenue recognition criteria have not been met.

Goodwill and Trade Name Impairment Tests

Goodwill

We test goodwill for impairment annually, at the reporting unit level, and whenever events or circumstances make it likely that an impairment may have occurred, such as a significant adverse change in the business climate or a decision to sell all or a portion of a reporting unit. We perform our annual goodwill impairment test as of July 1 for each of our reporting units and monitor for interim triggering events on an ongoing basis.

Goodwill is reviewed for impairment utilizing a qualitative assessment or a two-step quantitative process. If we choose to perform a qualitative assessment and determine the fair value more likely than not exceeds the carrying value, no further evaluation is necessary. As allowed, in the 2014 annual assessment, we chose to assess the qualitative factors of our reporting units noting that each had a fair value of goodwill in excess of 20% of its respective carrying value as of the most recent step one quantitative test, which was either as of July 1, 2012 or July 1, 2013.

Examples of qualitative factors that management assessed include the Company’s financial performance, market and competitive factors in the software and services industry, the amount of excess fair value over the carrying value of each reporting unit evident in prior years and other events specific to our reporting units.

We considered factors that would impact the reporting unit fair values as estimated by the market and income approaches used in the last step one test. We reviewed current projections of cash flows and compared these current projections to the projections included in the most recent step one test, and considered the fact that no new significant competitors entered the marketplace in the industry and that consumer demand for the

 

45


Table of Contents

industry’s products remains relatively constant, if not growing slightly. Also, economic factors over the past year (or two years in the case of units that were last tested quantitatively as of July 1, 2012) did not significantly affect the discount rates used for the valuation of these reporting units. We concluded that events occurring since the last step one test did not have a significant impact on the fair value of each of these reporting units. Therefore, we determined that it was not necessary to perform a quantitative (step one) goodwill impairment test for these reporting units as the fair value of each reporting unit appeared to exceed its respective carrying value.

If a quantitative test is elected or required, in step one of the two-step process, we estimate the fair values of each reporting unit by a combination of (i) estimation of the discounted cash flows of each of the reporting units based on projected earnings in the future (the income approach) and (ii) a comparative analysis of revenue and EBITDA multiples of public companies in similar markets (the market approach). We then compare the estimated fair value to the carrying value. If there is a deficiency (the estimated fair value of a reporting unit is less than the carrying value), a step-two test is required. In step two, the amount of any goodwill impairment is measured by comparing the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill to the carrying value of goodwill, with any resulting impairment reflected in operations. The implied fair value is determined in the same manner as the amount of goodwill recognized in a business combination.

Estimating the fair value of a reporting unit requires various assumptions including projections of future cash flows, perpetual growth rates and discount rates that reflect the risks associated with achieving those cash flows. The assumptions about future cash flows and growth rates are based on management’s assessment of a number of factors including the reporting unit’s recent performance against budget, performance of the market that the reporting unit serves, as well as industry and general economic data from third party sources. Discount rate assumptions are based on an assessment of the risk inherent in those future cash flows. Changes to the underlying businesses could affect the future cash flows, which in turn could affect the fair value of the reporting unit. There were no goodwill impairment charges in continuing operations in 2012, 2013 or 2014.

Trade Name

The trade name intangible asset represents the fair value of the SunGard trade name and is an indefinite-lived asset not subject to amortization. We performed an interim impairment test as of March 31, 2014 as a result of the AS Split-Off. The annual impairment test of the SunGard trade name was performed in the third quarter of 2014.

Interim Impairment Test

The AS Split-Off triggered an interim impairment test of the carrying value of the SunGard trade name as of March 31, 2014 due to changes in how the trade name is being used following the AS Split-Off. We utilized an income approach known as the relief-from-royalty method to determine the fair value of the SunGard trade name. Under this method, a royalty rate was applied to SunGard’s projected revenues to determine the annual cash savings attributable to ownership of the trade name. This amount was then tax-effected and discounted to present value to ultimately arrive at the estimated fair value of the trade name.

We developed certain assumptions and estimates related to the calculation of fair value of our trade name. The fair value assumptions and estimates primarily included projections of future revenues, a royalty rate, a tax rate, and a discount rate. The loss of projected AS revenues due to the AS Split-Off had a significant negative impact on the results of the trade name valuation. Based on the results of the impairment test, the fair value of the trade name was determined to be lower than its carrying value and resulted in a $339 million impairment of the trade name as of March 31, 2014.

In connection with the AS Split-Off, SunGard and AS agreed to a two-year royalty-free period for AS’ limited use of a derivative of the trade name, after which it will pay a pre-determined royalty rate based on its annual revenue for a specified number of years. As of March 31, 2014, we transferred an $8 million “right-to-use” asset representing the value of AS’ limited right to use the “SUNGARD AVAILABILITY SERVICES” trade name during the royalty-free period.

 

46


Table of Contents

Annual Impairment Test

As of July 1, 2014, we completed our annual impairment test and determined that the fair value of the trade name exceeded its carrying value, resulting in no further impairment of the trade name since the interim test performed as of March 31, 2014. From a sensitivity standpoint, a 50 basis point decrease in the assumed royalty rate would have resulted in an impairment of the trade name asset of approximately $123 million. A 50 basis point increase in the discount rate would result in an impairment of the trade name asset of approximately $24 million (100 basis point increase would result in an impairment of approximately $59 million). Furthermore, to the extent that additional businesses are sold, split-off or otherwise divested in the future, or revenues related to continuing operations decline, the revenue supporting the trade name will decline, which may result in further impairment charges.

See Note 1 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion.

Accounting for Income Taxes

The Company is subject to income taxes in the U.S. and numerous foreign jurisdictions. Significant judgments are required in determining the consolidated provision for income taxes. Income taxes are accounted for under the asset and liability method. Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are calculated based on the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases using the enacted income tax rates expected to be in effect during the years in which the temporary differences are expected to reverse.

Valuation allowances are recorded to reduce deferred tax assets when it is more likely than not that a tax benefit will not be realized. Significant judgment is required in determining whether a valuation allowance should be recorded against deferred tax assets. In assessing the need for a valuation allowance, we consider all available evidence for each jurisdiction including past operating results, estimates of future taxable income and the feasibility of ongoing tax planning strategies. In the event that we change our determination as to the amount of deferred tax assets that can be realized, we will adjust our valuation allowance with a corresponding impact to income tax expense in the period in which such determination is made.

During the ordinary course of business, there are many transactions and calculations for which the ultimate tax determination is uncertain. As a result, we recognize tax liabilities based on estimates of whether additional taxes and interest might be due. These tax liabilities are recognized when, despite our belief that our tax return positions are supportable, we believe that certain positions may not be fully sustained upon review by tax authorities. We believe that our accruals for tax liabilities are adequate for all years open to examination by taxing authorities based on its assessment of many factors, including past experience and interpretations of the tax law. This assessment relies on estimates and assumptions and may involve a series of complex judgments about future events. To the extent that new information becomes available which causes us to change our judgment regarding the adequacy of existing tax liabilities, such changes to tax liabilities will impact income tax expense in the period in which such determination is made. Judgment is required in assessing and estimating these amounts and differences between the actual outcome of these future tax consequences and our estimates could have a material effect on our consolidated financial results.

The consolidated provision for income taxes will change period-to-period based on nonrecurring events, such as impairments of goodwill and certain intangible assets, the settlement of income tax examinations and changes in tax laws, as well as recurring factors including the geographic mix of income before taxes, the repatriation of earnings from foreign subsidiaries, state and local taxes and the effects of tax planning.

 

47


Table of Contents
ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK:

We do not use derivative financial instruments for trading or speculative purposes. We have invested our available cash in short-term, highly liquid financial instruments, substantially all having initial maturities of three months or less. When necessary, we have borrowed to fund acquisitions.

At December 31, 2014, we had total debt of $4.67 billion, including $2.46 billion of variable rate debt. We entered into interest rate swap agreements which fixed the interest rates for $900 million of our variable rate debt. Swap agreements expiring in February 2017 with a notional value of $400 million effectively fix our interest rates at 0.69%. Swap agreements expiring in June 2019 with a notional value of $200 million effectively fix our interest rates at 2.06%. Swap agreements expiring in March 2020 with a notional value of $300 million effectively fix our interest rates at 2.27%. Our remaining variable rate debt of $1.56 billion is subject to changes in underlying interest rates, and, accordingly, our interest payments will fluctuate. During the period when all of our interest rate swap agreements are effective, a 1% change in interest rates would result in a change in interest of approximately $16 million per year. Upon the expiration of the $400 million interest rate swap agreement in February 2017, a 1% change in interest rates would result in an incremental change in interest of approximately $4 million, or a total of $20 million. Upon the expiration of the $200 million interest rate swap agreements in June 2019, a 1% change in interest rates would result in an incremental change in interest of approximately $2 million, or a total of $22 million. Upon the expiration of the $300 million interest rate swap agreements in March 2020, a 1% change in interest rates would result in an incremental change in interest of approximately $3 million, or a total of $25 million. See Note 5 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

During 2014, approximately 39% of our revenue was from customers outside the United States with approximately 64% of this revenue coming from customers located in the United Kingdom, Continental Europe and Canada. Only a portion of the revenue from customers outside the United States is denominated in other currencies, the majority being pound Sterling and Euros. Revenue and expenses of our foreign operations are generally denominated in their respective local currencies. We continue to monitor our exposure to currency exchange rates and we enter into currency hedging transactions from time to time to mitigate certain currency exposures.

 

48


Table of Contents
ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

SunGard Capital Corp.

SunGard Capital Corp. II

SunGard Data Systems Inc.

Index to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

  50   
SunGard Capital Corp.

Consolidated Balance Sheets

  53   

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

  54   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

  55   

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity

  56   
SunGard Capital Corp. II

Consolidated Balance Sheets

  58   

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

  59   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

  60   

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity

  61   
SunGard Data Systems Inc.

Consolidated Balance Sheets

  63   

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

  64   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

  65   

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity

  66   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

  67   

 

49


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of SunGard Capital Corp.:

In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of comprehensive income, of changes in equity and of cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of SunGard Capital Corp. and its subsidiaries at December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2014 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting appearing under Item 9A. Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements and on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

Philadelphia, Pennsylvania

March 25, 2015

 

50


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of SunGard Capital Corp. II:

In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of comprehensive income, of changes in stockholders’ equity and of cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of SunGard Capital Corp. II and its subsidiaries at December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2014 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting appearing under Item 9A. Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements and on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

Philadelphia, Pennsylvania

March 25, 2015

 

51


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Board of Directors and Stockholder of SunGard Data Systems Inc.:

In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of comprehensive income, of changes in stockholder’s equity and of cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of SunGard Data Systems Inc. and its subsidiaries at December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2014 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting appearing under Item 9A. Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements and on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

Philadelphia, Pennsylvania

March 25, 2015

 

52


Table of Contents

SunGard Capital Corp.

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(In millions except share and per-share amounts)

 

     December 31,
2013
    December 31,
2014
 

Assets

    

Current:

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 675      $ 447   

Trade receivables, less allowance for doubtful accounts of $17 and $22

     565        572   

Earned but unbilled receivables

     92        114   

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

     127        116   

Assets of discontinued operations

     2,516        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

  3,975      1,249   

Property and equipment, less accumulated depreciation of $376 and $414

  152      152   

Software products, less accumulated amortization of $1,644 and $1,754

  270      224   

Customer base, less accumulated amortization of $486 and $531

  421      360   

Other assets, less accumulated amortization of $21 and $22

  113      94   

Trade name

  1,019      672   

Goodwill

  3,828      3,760   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Assets

$ 9,778    $ 6,511   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities and Equity

Current:

Short-term and current portion of long-term debt

$ 290    $ —     

Accounts payable

  8      21   

Accrued compensation and benefits

  245      227   

Accrued interest expense

  40      30   

Other accrued expenses

  129      131   

Deferred revenue

  589      589   

Liabilities of discontinued operations

  799      —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

  2,100      998   

Long-term debt

  6,094      4,669   

Deferred and other income taxes

  746      616   

Other long-term liabilities

  39      39   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

  8,979      6,322   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies

Noncontrolling interest in preferred stock of SCCII subject to a put option

  42      37   

Class L common stock subject to a put option

  58      57   

Class A common stock subject to a put option

  4      3   

Stockholders’ equity:

Class L common stock, convertible, par value $.001 per share; cumulative 13.5% per annum, compounded quarterly; aggregate liquidation preference of $7,040 million and $8,064 million; 50,000,000 shares authorized, 29,062,421 shares issued

  —        —     

Class A common stock, par value $.001 per share; 550,000,000 shares authorized, 261,565,118 shares issued

  —        —     

Capital in excess of par value

  2,482      2,674   

Treasury stock, 528,709 and 442,460 shares of Class L common stock; and 4,761,694 and 3,985,453 shares of Class A common stock

  (47   (38

Accumulated deficit

  (3,497   (3,902

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

  16      (132
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total SunGard Capital Corp. stockholders’ equity (deficit)

  (1,046   (1,398

Noncontrolling interest in preferred stock of SCCII

  1,741      1,490   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

  695      92   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Liabilities and Equity

$ 9,778    $ 6,511   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

53


Table of Contents

SunGard Capital Corp.

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

(In millions)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2012     2013     2014  

Revenue

   $ 2,808      $ 2,761      $ 2,809   

Costs and expenses:

      

Cost of sales and direct operating (excluding items described in Note 1)

     1,082        1,045        1,098   

Sales, marketing and administration

     643        634        667   

Product development and maintenance

     422        392        376   

Depreciation

     96        104        107   

Amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets

     217        182        136   

Trade name impairment charge

     —          —          339   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total costs and expenses

  2,460      2,357      2,723   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income

  348      404      86   

Other income (expense):

Interest income

  1      1      1   

Interest expense and amortization of deferred financing fees

  (360   (326   (291

Loss on extinguishment of debt

  (82   (6   (61

Other income (expense)

  1      (2   —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other income (expense)

  (440   (333   (351
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

  (92   71      (265

Benefit from (provision for) income taxes

  49      (26   57   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  (43   45      (208

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax

  (23   17      (14
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

  (66   62      (222

(Income) attributable to the non-controlling interest

  (251   (169   (174
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to SunGard Capital Corp.

  (317   (107   (396
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss):

Foreign currency translation, net

  33      19      (65

Unrealized gain (loss) on derivative instruments, net of tax

  10      3      (5

Other, net of tax

  —        (3   (3
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

  43      19      (73
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss)

  (23   81      (295

Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to the non-controlling interest

  (251   (169   (174
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to SunGard Capital Corp.

$ (274 $ (88 $ (469
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

54


Table of Contents

SunGard Capital Corp.

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(In millions)

 

    Year Ended December 31,  
    2012     2013     2014  

Cash flow from operations:

     

Net income (loss)

  $ (66   $ 62      $ (222

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

    (23     17        (14
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  (43   45      (208

Reconciliation of income (loss) from continuing operations to cash flow from (used in) operations:

Depreciation and amortization

  313      286      243   

Trade name impairment charge

  —        —        339   

Deferred income tax provision (benefit)

  (54   (24   (104

Stock compensation expense

  31      39      42   

Amortization of deferred financing fees and debt discount

  36      37      18   

Loss on extinguishment of debt

  82      6      61   

Other noncash items

  (1   1      —     

Changes in working capital:

Accounts receivable and other current assets

  58      (3   (57

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

  (11   (5   (18

Accrued interest

  (49   (1   (5

Accrued income taxes

  (52   7      12   

Deferred revenue

  (23   33      9   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from (used in) continuing operations

  287      421      332   

Cash flow from (used in) discontinued operations

  (43   324      33   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from (used in) operations

  244      745      365   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investment activities:

Cash paid for acquired businesses, net of cash acquired

  (40   (2   (4

Cash paid for property and equipment, and software

  (97   (111   (143

Other investing activities

  1      1      —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) continuing operations

  (136   (112   (147

Cash provided by (used in) discontinued operations

  1,597      (146   7   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) investment activities

  1,461      (258   (140
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing activities:

Cash received from borrowings, net of fees

  1,715      2,171      (7

Cash used to repay debt

  (2,943   (2,475   (1,326

Premium paid to retire debt

  (48   —        —     

Dividends paid

  (724   (3   (2

Cash used to purchase treasury stock

  (22   (10   (9

Other financing activities

  (14   (7   (11
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) continuing operations

  (2,036   (324   (1,355

Cash provided by (used in) discontinued operations

  (3   (2   887   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) financing activities

  (2,039   (326   (468
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash

  7      (1   (16
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

  (327   160      (259

Beginning cash and cash equivalents includes cash of discontinued operations: 2012, $41; 2013, $11; 2014, $31

  873      546      706   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending cash and cash equivalents includes cash of discontinued operations: 2012, $11; 2013, $31; 2014, $-

$ 546    $ 706    $ 447   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental information:

Interest paid

$ 444    $ 363    $ 302   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income taxes paid, net of refunds of $8 million, $21 million and $19 million, respectively

$ 482    $ 86    $ 43   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-cash financing activities:

Distribution of net assets of SpinCo (see Note 1)

$ —      $ —      $ 227   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Receipt of SpinCo Notes in connection with AS Split-Off (see Note 1)

$ —      $ —      $ 425   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Exchange of SpinCo Notes for SunGard Notes (see Note 5)

$ —      $ —      $ 389   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

55


Table of Contents

SunGard Capital Corp.

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity

(In millions)

 

          Permanent Equity  
                Treasury Stock  
    Temporary Equity     Common Stock           Common Stock  
    Subject to a put option     Number of
Shares issued
                Shares              
    Class L     Class A     Noncontrolling
Interest
    Class L     Class A     Par
Value
    Capital in
Excess of
Par Value
    Class L     Class A     Par
Value
    Amount  

Balances at December 31, 2011

  $ 47      $ 6      $ 28        29        260      $ —        $ 2,768        —          3      $ —        $ (39

Net income (loss)

    —          —          1        —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Foreign currency translation

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax expense of $2)

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Stock compensation expense

    —          —          —          —          —          —          38        —          —          —          —     

Dividends declared ($72.80 per preferred share)

    —          —          (3     —          —          —          (300     —          —          —          —     

Issuance of common and preferred stock

    (1     —          (1     —          1        —          1        —          —          —          —     

Purchase of treasury stock

    (1     —          —          —          —          —          (4     1        2        —          (11

Transfer intrinsic value of vested restricted stock units to temporary equity

    18        1        10        —          —          —          (30     —          —          —          —     

Cancellation of put options due to employee terminations

    (18     (2     (9     —          —          —          24        —          —          —          —     

Other

    —          —          —          —          —          —          (14     —          —          —          —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2012

    45        5        26        29        261        —          2,483        1        5        —          (50

Net income (loss)

    —          —          2        —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Foreign currency translation

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax expense of $3)

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Stock compensation expense

    —          —          —          —          —          —          46        —          —          —          —     

Issue common and preferred stock

    —          —          —          —          1        —          (9     —          —          —          9   

Purchase of treasury stock

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          (6

Transfer intrinsic value of vested restricted stock units to temporary equity

    23        1        17        —          —          —          (41     —          —          —          —     

Cancellation of put options due to employee terminations

    (10     (2     (3     —          —          —          12        —          —          —          —     

Other

    —          —          —          —          —          —          (9     —          —          —          —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2013

    58        4        42        29        262        —          2,482        1        5        —          (47

Net income (loss)

    —          —          1        —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Foreign currency translation

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax benefit of $3)

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Stock compensation expense

    —          —          —          —          —          —          44        —          —          —          —     

Issue common and preferred stock

    (1     —          —          —          —          —          (12     (1     (1     —          15   

Purchase of treasury stock

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          (6

Impact of exchange of SpinCo common stock for SCCII preferred stock

    —          —          (1     —          —          —          174        —          —          —          —     

Impact of modification of SunGard Awards

    3        —          (4     —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Impact of modification of SpinCo Awards

    (8     —          (6     —          —          —          13        —          —          —          —     

Transfer intrinsic value of vested restricted stock units to temporary equity

    20        —          13        —          —          —          (33     —          —          —          —     

Cancellation of put options due to employee terminations

    (15     (1     (8     —          —          —          18        —          —          —          —     

Other

    —          —          —          —          —          —          (12     —          —          —          —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2014

  $ 57      $ 3      $ 37        29        262      $ —        $ 2,674        —          4      $ —        $ (38
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

56


Table of Contents

SunGard Capital Corp.

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity (continued)

(In millions)

 

    Permanent Equity  
          Accumulated Other
Comprehensive Income (Loss)
             
    Retained Earnings
(Accumulated
Deficit)
    Foreign
Currency
Translation
    Net Unrealized
Gain (Loss) on
Derivative
Instruments
    Other     Noncontrolling
Interest
    Total  

Balances at December 31, 2011

  $ (3,346   $ (37   $ (9   $ —        $ 2,038      $ 1,375   

Net income (loss)

    (317     —          —          —          251        (66

Foreign currency translation

    —          33        —          —          —          33   

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax expense of $2)

    —          —          10        —          —          10   

Stock compensation expense

    —          —          —          —          —          38   

Dividends declared ($72.80 per preferred share)

    272        —          —          —          (714     (742

Issuance of common and preferred stock

    —          —          —          —          —          1   

Purchase of treasury stock

    —          —          —          —          (6     (21

Transfer intrinsic value of vested restricted stock units to temporary equity

    —          —          —          —          —          (30

Cancellation of put options due to employee terminations

    —          —          —          —          6        30   

Other

    —          —          —          —          —          (14
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2012

    (3,391     (4     1        —          1,575        614   

Net income (loss)

    (107     —          —          —          167        60   

Foreign currency translation

    —          19        —          —          —          19   

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax expense of $3)

    —          —          3        —          —          3   

Stock compensation expense

    —          —          —          —          —          46   

Issue common and preferred stock

    —          —          —          —          —          —     

Purchase of treasury stock

    —          —          —          —          (4     (10

Transfer intrinsic value of vested restricted stock units to temporary equity

    —          —          —          —          —          (41

Cancellation of put options due to employee terminations

    —          —          —          —          3        15   

Other

    1        —          —          (3     —          (11
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2013

    (3,497     15        4        (3     1,741        695   

Net income (loss)

    (396     —          —          —          173        (223

Foreign currency translation

    —          (65     —          —          —          (65

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax benefit of $3)

    —          —          (5     —          —          (5

Stock compensation expense

    —          —          —          —          —          44   

Issue common and preferred stock

    —          —          —          —          —          3   

Purchase of treasury stock

    —          —          —          —          (3     (9

Impact of exchange of SpinCo common stock for SCCII preferred stock

    (9     (75     —          —          (428     (338

Impact of modification of SunGard Awards

    —          —          —          —          —          —     

Impact of modification of SpinCo Awards

    —          —          —          —          —          13   

Transfer intrinsic value of vested restricted stock units to temporary equity

    —          —          —          —          —          (33

Cancellation of put options due to employee terminations

    —          —          —          —          6        24   

Other

    —          —          —          (3     1        (14
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2014

  $ (3,902   $ (125   $ (1   $ (6   $ 1,490      $ 92   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

57


Table of Contents

SunGard Capital Corp. II

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(In millions except share and per-share amounts)

 

     December 31,
2013
    December 31,
2014
 

Assets

    

Current:

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 675      $ 447   

Trade receivables, less allowance for doubtful accounts of $17 and $22

     565        572   

Earned but unbilled receivables

     92        114   

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

     127        116   

Assets of discontinued operations

     2,516        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

  3,975      1,249   

Property and equipment, less accumulated depreciation of $376 and $414

  152      152   

Software products, less accumulated amortization of $1,644 and $1,754

  270      224   

Customer base, less accumulated amortization of $486 and $531

  421      360   

Other assets, less accumulated amortization of $21 and $22

  113      94   

Trade name

  1,019      672   

Goodwill

  3,828      3,760   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Assets

$ 9,778    $ 6,511   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities and Equity

Current:

Short-term and current portion of long-term debt

$ 290    $ —     

Accounts payable

  8      21   

Accrued compensation and benefits

  245      227   

Accrued interest expense

  40      30   

Other accrued expenses

  128      127   

Deferred revenue

  589      589   

Liabilities of discontinued operations

  799      —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

  2,099      994   

Long-term debt

  6,094      4,669   

Deferred and other income taxes

  746      616   

Other long-term liabilities

  22      32   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

  8,961      6,311   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies

Preferred stock subject to a put option

  37      31   

Stockholders’ equity:

Preferred stock, par value $.001 per share; cumulative 11.5% per annum, compounded quarterly; aggregate liquidation preference of $1,752 million and $1,498 million; 14,999,000 shares authorized, 10,060,069 issued

  —        —     

Common stock, par value $.001 per share; 1,000 shares authorized, 100 shares issued and outstanding

  —        —     

Capital in excess of par value

  3,501      3,519   

Treasury stock, 183,014 and 2,516,374 preferred shares

  (29   (280

Accumulated deficit

  (2,708   (2,939

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

  16      (132
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total SunGard Capital Corp. II stockholders’ equity

  780      168   

Noncontrolling interest

  —        1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

  780      169   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

$ 9,778    $ 6,511   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

58


Table of Contents

SunGard Capital Corp. II

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

(In millions)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2012     2013     2014  

Revenue

   $ 2,808      $ 2,761      $ 2,809   

Costs and expenses:

      

Cost of sales and direct operating (excluding items described in Note 1)

     1,082        1,045        1,098   

Sales, marketing and administration

     643        633        667   

Product development and maintenance

     422        392        376   

Depreciation

     96        104        107   

Amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets

     217        182        136   

Trade name impairment charges

     —          —          339   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total costs and expenses

  2,460      2,356      2,723   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income

  348      405      86   

Other income (expense):

Interest income

  1      1      1   

Interest expense and amortization of deferred financing fees

  (360   (326   (291

Loss on extinguishment of debt

  (82   (6   (61

Other income (expense)

  1      (2   —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other income (expense)

  (440   (333   (351
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

  (92   72      (265

Benefit from (provision for) income taxes

  49      (26   57   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  (43   46      (208

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax

  (23   17      (14
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

  (66   63      (222
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss):

Foreign currency translation, net

  33      19      (65

Unrealized gain (loss) on derivative instruments, net of tax

  10      3      (5

Other, net of tax

  —        (3   (3
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss)

  43      19      (73
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss)

$ (23 $ 82    $ (295
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

59


Table of Contents

SunGard Capital Corp. II

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(In millions)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2012     2013     2014  

Cash flow from operations:

      

Net income (loss)

   $ (66   $ 63      $ (222

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

     (23     17        (14
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  (43   46      (208

Reconciliation of income (loss) from continuing operations to cash flow from (used in) operations:

Depreciation and amortization

  313      286      243   

Trade name impairment charge

  —        —        339   

Deferred income tax provision (benefit)

  (54   (24   (104

Stock compensation expense

  31      39      42   

Amortization of deferred financing fees and debt discount

  36      37      18   

Loss on extinguishment of debt

  82      6      61   

Other noncash items

  (1   1      —     

Changes in working capital:

Accounts receivable and other current assets

  58      (3   (57

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

  (11   (5   (18

Accrued interest

  (49   (1   (5

Accrued income taxes

  (52   7      12   

Deferred revenue

  (23   33      9   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from (used in) continuing operations

  287      422      332   

Cash flow from (used in) discontinued operations

  (43   324      33   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from (used in) operations

  244      746      365   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investment activities:

Cash paid for acquired businesses, net of cash acquired

  (40   (2   (4

Cash paid for property and equipment, and software

  (97   (111   (143

Other investing activities

  1      1      —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) continuing operations

  (136   (112   (147

Cash provided by (used in) discontinued operations

  1,597      (146   7   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) investment activities

  1,461      (258   (140
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing activities:

Cash received from borrowings, net of fees

  1,715      2,171      (7

Cash used to repay debt

  (2,943   (2,475   (1,326

Premium paid to retire debt

  (48   —        —     

Dividends paid

  (724   (3   (2

Cash used to purchase treasury stock

  (12   (5   (4

Other financing activities

  (24   (13   (16
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) continuing operations

  (2,036   (325   (1,355

Cash provided by (used in) discontinued operations

  (3   (2   887   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) financing activities

  (2,039   (327   (468
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash

  7      (1   (16
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

  (327   160      (259

Beginning cash and cash equivalents includes cash of discontinued operations: 2012, $41; 2013, $11; 2014, $31

  873      546      706   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending cash and cash equivalents includes cash of discontinued operations: 2012, $11; 2013, $31; 2014, $-

$ 546    $ 706    $ 447   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental information:

Interest paid

$ 444    $ 363    $ 302   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income taxes paid, net of refunds of $8 million, $21 million and $19 million, respectively

$ 482    $ 86    $ 43   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-cash financing activities:

Distribution of net assets of SpinCo (see Note 1)

$ —      $ —      $ 227   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Receipt of SpinCo Notes in connection with AS Split-Off (see Note 1)

$ —      $ —      $ 425   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Exchange of SpinCo Notes for SunGard Notes (see Note 5)

$ —      $ —      $ 389   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

60


Table of Contents

SunGard Capital Corp. II

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity

(In millions)

 

          Permanent Equity  
    Temporary
Equity
    Preferred Stock     Common Stock        
    Preferred Stock
Subject to a
Put Option
    Number of Shares
Issued
    Par
Value
    Number of
Shares
issued
    Par
Value
    Capital
in
Excess
of Par
Value
 

Balances at December 31, 2011

  $ 23        10      $ —          —        $ —        $ 3,785   

Net income (loss)

    —          —          —          —          —          —     

Foreign currency translation

    —          —          —          —          —          —     

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax expense of $2)

    —          —          —          —          —          —     

Stock compensation expense

    —          —          —          —          —          38   

Dividends declared ($72.80 per preferred share)

    —          —          —          —          —          (330

Purchase of treasury stock

    —          —          —          —          —          —     

Transfer intrinsic value of vested restricted stock units to temporary equity

    10        —          —          —          —          (10

Cancellation of put options due to employee terminations

    (9     —          —          —          —          9   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2012

  24      10      —        —        —        3,492   

Net income (loss)

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Foreign currency translation

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax expense of $3)

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Stock compensation expense

  —        —        —        —        —        46   

Issue preferred stock

  —        —        —        —        —        (5

Purchase of treasury stock

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Transfer intrinsic value of vested restricted stock units to temporary equity

  17      —        —        —        —        (17

Cancellation of put options due to employee terminations

  (4   —        —        —        —        4   

Other

  —        —        —        —        —        (19
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2013

  37      10      —        —        —        3,501   

Net income (loss)

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Foreign currency translation

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax benefit of $3)

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Stock compensation expense

  —        —        —        —        —        44   

Issue preferred stock

  —        —        —        —        —        (8

Purchase of treasury stock

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Impact of exchange of SpinCo common stock for SCCII preferred stock

  —        —        —        —        —        (4

Impact of modification of SunGard Awards

  (4   —        —        —        —        4   

Impact of modification of SpinCo Awards

  (6   —        —        —        —        6   

Transfer intrinsic value of vested restricted stock units to temporary equity

  13      —        —        —        —        (13

Cancellation of put options due to employee terminations

  (8   —        —        —        —        8   

Other

  (1   —        —        —        —        (19
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2014

$ 31      10    $ —        —      $ —      $ 3,519   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

61


Table of Contents

SunGard Capital Corp. II

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity (continued)

(In millions)

 

    Permanent Equity  
    Treasury Stock
(Preferred Stock)
          Accumulated Other
Comprehensive Income (Loss)
             
    Shares     Amount     Retained
Earnings
(Accumulated
Deficit)
    Foreign
Currency
Translation
    Net
Unrealized
Gain (Loss)
on Derivative
Instruments
    Other     Noncontrolling
Interest
    Total  

Balances at December 31, 2011

    —        $ (18   $ (2,288   $ (37   $ (9   $ —        $ —        $ 1,433   

Net income (loss)

    —          —          (66     —          —          —          —          (66

Foreign currency translation

    —          —          —          33        —          —          —          33   

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax expense of $2)

    —          —          —          —          10        —          —          10   

Stock compensation expense

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          38   

Dividends declared ($72.80 per preferred share)

    —          —          (417     —          —          —          —          (747

Purchase of treasury stock

    —          (12     —          —          —          —          —          (12

Transfer intrinsic value of vested restricted stock units to temporary equity

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          (10

Cancellation of put options due to employee terminations

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          9   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2012

  —        (30   (2,771   (4   1      —        —        688   

Net income (loss)

  —        —        63      —        —        —        —        63   

Foreign currency translation

  —        —        —        19      —        —        —        19   

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax expense of $3)

  —        —        —        —        3      —        —        3   

Stock compensation expense

  —        —        —        —        —        —        —        46   

Issue preferred stock

  —        5      —        —        —        —        —        —     

Purchase of treasury stock

  —        (4   —        —        —        —        —        (4

Transfer intrinsic value of vested restricted stock units to temporary equity

  —        —        —        —        —        —        —        (17

Cancellation of put options due to employee terminations

  —        —        —        —        —        —        —        4   

Other

  —        —        —        —        —        (3   —        (22
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2013

  —        (29   (2,708   15      4      (3   —        780   

Net income (loss)

  —        —        (222   —        —        —        —        (222

Foreign currency translation

  —        —        —        (65   —        —        —        (65

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax benefit of $3)

  —        —        —        —        (5   —        —        (5

Stock compensation expense

  —        —        —        —        —        —        —        44   

Issue preferred stock

  —        8      —        —        —        —        —        —     

Purchase of treasury stock

  —        (4   —        —        —        —        —        (4

Impact of exchange of SpinCo common stock for SCCII preferred stock

  3      (255   (9   (75   —        —        —        (343

Impact of modification of SunGard Awards

  —        —        —        —        —        —        —        4   

Impact of modification of SpinCo Awards

  —        —        —        —        —        —        —        6   

Transfer intrinsic value of vested restricted stock units to temporary equity

  —        —        —        —        —        —        —        (13

Cancellation of put options due to employee terminations

  —        —        —        —        —        —        —        8   

Other

  —        —        —        —        —        (3   1      (21
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2014

  3    $ (280 $ (2,939 $ (125 $ (1 $ (6 $ 1    $ 169   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

62


Table of Contents

SunGard Data Systems Inc.

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(In millions except share and per-share amounts)

 

     December 31,
2013
    December 31,
2014
 

Assets

    

Current:

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 675      $ 447   

Trade receivables, less allowance for doubtful accounts of $17 and $22

     565        572   

Earned but unbilled receivables

     92        114   

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

     123        112   

Assets of discontinued operations

     2,516        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

  3,971      1,245   

Property and equipment, less accumulated depreciation of $376 and $414

  152      152   

Software products, less accumulated amortization of $1,644 and $1,754

  270      224   

Customer base, less accumulated amortization of $486 and $531

  421      360   

Other assets, less accumulated amortization of $21 and $22

  113      94   

Trade name

  1,019      672   

Goodwill

  3,828      3,760   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Assets

$ 9,774    $ 6,507   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities and Equity

Current:

Short-term and current portion of long-term debt

$ 290    $ —     

Accounts payable

  8      21   

Accrued compensation and benefits

  245      227   

Accrued interest expense

  40      30   

Other accrued expenses

  127      127   

Deferred revenue

  589      589   

Liabilities of discontinued operations

  799      —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

  2,098      994   

Long-term debt

  6,094      4,669   

Deferred and other income taxes

  739      608   

Other long-term liabilities

  22      31   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

  8,953      6,302   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies

Stockholder’s equity:

Common stock, par value $.01 per share; 100 shares authorized, issued and outstanding

  —        —     

Capital in excess of par value

  3,513      3,380   

Accumulated deficit

  (2,708   (3,044

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

  16      (132
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total SunGard Data Systems stockholder’s equity

  821      204   

Noncontrolling interest

  —        1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

  821      205   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Liabilities and Stockholder’s Equity

$ 9,774    $ 6,507   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

63


Table of Contents

SunGard Data Systems Inc.

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

(In millions)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2012     2013     2014  

Revenue

   $ 2,808      $ 2,761      $ 2,809   

Costs and expenses:

      

Cost of sales and direct operating (excluding items described in Note 1)

     1,082        1,045        1,098   

Sales, marketing and administration

     643        633        666   

Product development and maintenance

     422        392        376   

Depreciation

     96        104        107   

Amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets

     217        182        136   

Trade name impairment charge

     —          —          339   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total costs and expenses

  2,460      2,356      2,722   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income

  348      405      87   

Other income (expense):

Interest income

  1      1      1   

Interest expense and amortization of deferred financing fees

  (360   (326   (291

Loss on extinguishment of debt

  (82   (6   (61

Other income (expense)

  1      (2   —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other income (expense)

  (440   (333   (351
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

  (92   72      (264

Benefit from (provision for) income taxes

  49      (26   57   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  (43   46      (207

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax

  (23   17      (17
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

  (66   63      (224
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss):

Foreign currency translation, net

  33      19      (65

Unrealized gain (loss) on derivative instruments, net of tax

  10      3      (5

Other, net of tax

  —        (3   (3
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss)

  43      19      (73
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss)

$ (23 $ 82    $ (297
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

64


Table of Contents

SunGard Data Systems Inc.

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(In millions)

 

    Year Ended December 31,  
    2012     2013     2014  

Cash flow from operations:

     

Net income (loss)

  $ (66   $ 63      $ (224

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

    (23     17        (17
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  (43   46      (207

Reconciliation of income (loss) from continuing operations to cash flow from (used in) operations:

Depreciation and amortization

  313      286      243   

Trade name impairment charge

  —        —        339   

Deferred income tax provision (benefit)

  (55   (25   (105

Stock compensation expense

  31      39      42   

Amortization of deferred financing fees and debt discount

  36      37      18   

Loss on extinguishment of debt

  82      6      61   

Other noncash items

  (1   1      —     

Changes in working capital:

Accounts receivable and other current assets

  58      (3   (57

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

  (11   (5   (18

Accrued interest

  (49   (1   (5

Accrued income taxes

  (51   8      12   

Deferred revenue

  (23   33      9   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from (used in) continuing operations

  287      422      332   

Cash flow from (used in) discontinued operations

  (43   324      33   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from (used in) operations

  244      746      365   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investment activities:

Cash paid for acquired businesses, net of cash acquired

  (40   (2   (4

Cash paid for property and equipment, and software

  (97   (111   (143

Other investing activities

  1      1      —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) continuing operations

  (136   (112   (147

Cash provided by (used in) discontinued operations

  1,597      (146   7   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) investment activities

  1,461      (258   (140
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing activities:

Cash received from borrowings, net of fees

  1,715      2,171      (7

Cash used to repay debt

  (2,943   (2,475   (1,326

Premium paid to retire debt

  (48   —        —     

Dividends paid

  (724   (3   (2

Other financing activities

  (36   (18   (20
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) continuing operations

  (2,036   (325   (1,355

Cash provided by (used in) discontinued operations

  (3   (2   887   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) financing activities

  (2,039   (327   (468
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash

  7      (1   (16
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

  (327   160      (259

Beginning cash and cash equivalents includes cash of discontinued operations: 2012, $41; 2013, $11; 2014, $31

  873      546      706   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending cash and cash equivalents includes cash of discontinued operations: 2012, $11; 2013, $31; 2014, $-

$ 546    $ 706    $ 447   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental information:

Interest paid

$ 444    $ 363    $ 302   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income taxes paid, net of refunds of $8 million, $21 million and $19 million, respectively

$ 482    $ 86    $ 43   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-cash financing activities:

Distribution of net assets of SpinCo (see Note 1)

$ —      $ —      $ 231   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Receipt of SpinCo Notes in connection with AS Split-Off (see Note 1)

$ —      $ —      $ 425   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Exchange of SpinCo Notes for SunGard Notes (see Note 5)

$ —      $ —      $ 389   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

65


Table of Contents

SunGard Data Systems Inc.

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity

(In millions)

 

    Common Stock                 Accumulated Other
Comprehensive Income
(Loss)
             
    Number
of
Shares
Issued
    Par
Value
    Capital
in
Excess
of Par
Value
    Retained
Earnings
(Accumulated
Deficit)
    Foreign
Currency
Translation
    Net
Unrealized
Gain
(Loss) on
Derivative
Instruments
    Other     Noncontrolling
Interest
    Total  

Balances at December 31, 2011

    —        $ —        $ 3,793      $ (2,286   $ (37   $ (9   $ —        $ —        $ 1,461   

Net income (loss)

    —          —          —          (66     —          —          —          —          (66

Foreign currency translation

    —          —          —          —          33        —          —          —          33   

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax expense of $2) and other

    —          —          —          —          —          10        —          —          10   

Dividend declared to Parent

    —          —          (327     (419     —          —          —          —          (746

Stock compensation expense

    —          —          38        —          —          —          —          —          38   

Other

    —          —          (14     —          —          —          —          —          (14
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2012

  —        —        3,490      (2,771   (4   1      —        —        716   

Net income (loss)

  —        —        —        63      —        —        —        —        63   

Foreign currency translation

  —        —        —        —        19      —        —        —        19   

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax expense of $3)

  —        —        —        —        —        3      —        —        3   

Stock compensation expense

  —        —        46      —        —        —        —        —        46   

Other

  —        —        (23   —        —        —        (3   —        (26
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2013

  —        —        3,513      (2,708   15      4      (3   —        821   

Net income (loss)

  —        —        —        (224   —        —        —        —        (224

Foreign currency translation

  —        —        —        —        (65   —        —        —        (65

Net unrealized gain on derivative instruments (net of tax benefit of $3)

  —        —        —        —        —        (5   —        —        (5

Stock compensation expense

  —        —        44      —        —        —        —        —        44   

Distribute AS to parent

  —        —        (157   (112   (75   —        —        —        (344

Other

  —        —        (20   —        —        —        (3   1      (22
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balances at December 31, 2014

  —      $ —      $ 3,380    $ (3,044 $ (125 $ (1 $ (6 $ 1    $ 205   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

66


Table of Contents

SunGard Capital Corp.

SunGard Capital Corp. II

SunGard Data Systems Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

1. Basis of Presentation and Summary of Significant Accounting Policies:

SunGard Data Systems Inc. (“SunGard”) was acquired on August 11, 2005 in a leveraged buy-out (the “LBO”) by a consortium of private equity investment funds associated with Bain Capital Partners, The Blackstone Group, Goldman Sachs & Co., Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co., Providence Equity Partners, Silver Lake and TPG (collectively, the “Sponsors”).

SunGard is a wholly owned subsidiary of SunGard Holdco LLC, which is wholly owned by SunGard Holding Corp., which is wholly owned by SunGard Capital Corp. II (“SCCII”), which is a subsidiary of SunGard Capital Corp. (“SCC”). SCC and SCCII are collectively referred to as the “Parent Companies.” All four of these companies were formed in 2005 for the purpose of facilitating the LBO and are collectively referred to as the “Holding Companies.” The Holding Companies have no other operations beyond those of their ownership of SunGard. SCC, SCCII and SunGard are separate reporting companies and are collectively referred to as the “Company.”

On March 31, 2014, SunGard completed the split-off of its Availability Services (“AS”) business to its existing stockholders, including its private equity owners, on a tax-free and pro-rata basis. As part of that transaction, the assets and liabilities of the AS business were contributed to a new subsidiary, and then SunGard transferred all of its ownership interests in that subsidiary to Sungard Availability Services Capital, Inc. (“SpinCo”) in exchange for common stock of SpinCo, approximately $425 million of SpinCo senior notes (“SpinCo Notes”), and $1,005 million of net cash proceeds from the issuance of an AS term loan facility (“SpinCo Term Loan”). Immediately after these transactions, SunGard distributed the common stock of SpinCo through SunGard’s ownership chain ultimately to SCCII, and then all stockholders of preferred stock of SCCII exchanged a portion of their shares of preferred stock for all of the shares of common stock of SpinCo on a pro-rata basis (together, with the transactions described above, the “AS Split-Off”). As a result, on March 31, 2014 the preferred stockholders of SCCII owned 100% of the common stock of SpinCo, a separate, independent company. The distribution of AS’ nets assets in connection with the AS Split-Off was based on the recorded amount of the net assets and did not result in a gain or loss upon disposal in the consolidated financial statements.

The AS business and two small FS businesses that were sold on January 31, 2014 have been included in the Company’s financial results as discontinued operations for all periods presented.

SunGard is one of the world’s leading software and technology services companies and has two segments: Financial Systems (“FS”) and Public Sector & Education (“PS&E”). The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and its majority-owned subsidiaries. All significant intercompany transactions and accounts have been eliminated.

Certain prior year amounts have been reclassified to conform to current presentation. Refer to Note 2 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for information regarding the reclassification of facilities and information technology-related expenses to more accurately present them within the functional expense categories for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2013.

The Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2013 have been revised to present stock compensation expense and developer time spent on customer billable professional services projects in the correct functional expense categories. Refer to Note 2 of Notes to Consolidated Financial statements for additional details.

The Consolidated Balance Sheet as of December 31, 2013 has been revised to correct an immaterial misclassification of certain income tax receivable balances. Total assets and total liabilities each decreased by

 

67


Table of Contents

$7 million at December 31, 2013. Refer to Note 19 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for information regarding the revision to correct immaterial errors in the presentation of the Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Schedule of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2013.

Estimates

The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”) requires management to make many estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenue and expenses. The Company evaluates its estimates and judgments on an ongoing basis and revises them when necessary. Actual results may differ from the original or revised estimates.

Revenue Recognition

The Company generates revenue from the following sources: (1) software revenue, (2) software-as-a-service (“SaaS”) and Cloud revenue, and (3) professional services and Business Process as a Service (“BPaaS”) revenue.

Software Revenue: Our software revenue is comprised of traditional software license fees, maintenance and support fees, and fees from the resale of third party software licenses. These software license fees include term licenses, perpetual licenses and rental fees for customers who would prefer a periodic fee instead of a larger up-front payment. Maintenance and support fees provide customers with periodic technology updates and interactive support related to our software. The remainder of our software revenue is generated from software license sales to new and existing customers.

SaaS and Cloud Revenue: SaaS and Cloud offerings are delivered from SunGard data centers and provide customers with a secure and reliable environment operated by qualified SunGard personnel. These offerings allow customers to take advantage of SunGard’s deep domain expertise while avoiding the upfront cost of licensing and IT infrastructure. SaaS and Cloud revenue also includes revenue from our proprietary trading algorithms and trade execution network. These SaaS and Cloud offerings are generally sold on multi-year contracts and have historically generated high customer renewal rates.

Professional and Business Processing Services Revenue: Professional Services offerings allow customers to install, optimize and integrate SunGard’s software into their computing environment. SunGard’s BPaaS offerings typically provide back-office processing services (together with professional services, “services”) to our customers where the process is deeply related to a SunGard application.

The following criteria must be met in determining whether revenue may be recorded: persuasive evidence of a contract exists; software has been delivered and/or services have been provided; the price is fixed or determinable; and collection is reasonably assured.

Revenue is recorded as the services are provided based on the relative fair value of each element. Software maintenance and SaaS and Cloud revenue include monthly fees, which may include a fixed minimum fee and/or variable fees based on a measure of volume or activity, such as the number of accounts, trades or transactions, users or the number of hours of service. Software rentals combine the license and maintenance services into a bundled element, and the fee is recognized ratably over the corresponding services period when the customer has the right to use the software product and receive maintenance and support services.

For fixed-fee professional services contracts, revenue is recorded based upon proportional performance, measured by the actual number of hours incurred divided by the total estimated number of hours for the project. Changes in the estimated costs or hours to complete the contract, and losses, if any, are reflected in the period during which the change or loss becomes known. The Company also provides professional services on a time and materials basis, recognized monthly based upon hours incurred to date. In all cases, contract milestones, project risk profile and refund provisions are taken into consideration.

 

68


Table of Contents

Software license fees result from contracts that permit the customer to use a SunGard software product at the customer’s designated site or at the site of their choosing if the customer has the contractual right to take immediate possession of the software without significant penalty. Generally, these contracts are multiple-element arrangements since they usually provide for professional services and ongoing software maintenance. In these instances, license fees are recognized upon the signing of the contract and delivery of the software if the license fee and fees for other elements within the arrangement are fixed or determinable, collection is probable, and there is sufficient vendor specific evidence of the fair value of each undelivered element. When there are significant program modifications or customization, installation, systems integration or related services, the professional services and license revenue are combined in accordance with contract accounting guidance and recorded based upon proportional performance, measured in the manner described above. License revenue is recorded as each installment becomes due if customer payments are extended beyond normal billing terms, or at acceptance when there is significant acceptance, technology or service risk. Revenue also is recorded over the longest service period in those instances where the software is bundled together with post-delivery services and there is not sufficient evidence of the fair value of each undelivered service element.

With respect to software-related multiple element arrangements, sufficient evidence of fair value is defined as vendor specific objective evidence (“VSOE”). VSOE of the fair value for each element within an arrangement is based on either historical stand-alone sales of the element to third parties or stated renewal rates within the contract. If there is no VSOE of the fair value of the delivered element (which is usually the software since the license is rarely if ever sold separately), but there is VSOE of the fair value of each of the undelivered elements (typically maintenance and professional services), then the residual method is used to determine the portion of the arrangement fee allocated to the delivered element. The revenue for each of the undelivered elements is set at the fair value of those elements using VSOE of the price paid when each of the undelivered elements is sold separately. The revenue remaining after allocation to the undelivered elements (i.e., the residual) is allocated to the delivered element.

The Company’s maintenance and support offerings entitle the customers to receive product upgrades and enhancements on a “when and if available” basis along with technical support, and revenue is recognized ratably over the term of the maintenance and support arrangement. VSOE supporting the fair value of maintenance and support is based on the stated (optional) renewal rates contained in the initial arrangement. VSOE for the maintenance element is dependent upon the software product and the annual maintenance fee is typically 18% to 20% of the software license fee. VSOE supporting the fair value of professional services is based on the standard daily rates charged when those services are sold separately, represented by a substantial portion of transactions falling within a reasonably tight pricing range.

In some software-related multiple-element arrangements, the maintenance or professional services rates are discounted. In these cases, a portion of the software license fee is deferred and recognized as the maintenance or professional services are performed based on VSOE of the services.

From time to time, the Company enters into arrangements with customers that purchase non-software related services at the same time as, or within close proximity to, purchasing software (non-software multiple-element arrangements). Each element within a non-software multiple-element arrangement is accounted for as a separate unit of accounting provided the delivered services have value to the customer on a standalone basis, and, for an arrangement that includes a general right of return relative to the delivered services, delivery or performance of the undelivered service is considered probable and is substantially controlled by the Company. Where the criteria for a separate unit of accounting are not met, the deliverable is combined with the undelivered element(s) and treated as a single unit of accounting for the purposes of allocation of the arrangement consideration and revenue recognition.

For non-software multiple-element arrangements, the Company allocates revenue to each element based on a selling price hierarchy at the arrangement inception. The selling price for each element is based upon the following selling price hierarchy: VSOE, then third-party evidence (“TPE”), then best estimated selling price

 

69


Table of Contents

(“BESP”). The total arrangement consideration is allocated to each separate unit of accounting for each of the non-software deliverables using the relative selling prices of each unit based on this hierarchy. The Company limits the amount of revenue recognized for delivered elements to an amount that is not contingent upon future delivery of additional products or services or meeting of any specified performance conditions.

To determine the selling price in non-software multiple-element arrangements, the Company establishes VSOE of the selling price using the price charged for a deliverable when sold separately. Where VSOE does not exist, TPE is established by evaluating similar competitor products or services in standalone arrangements with similarly situated customers. If the Company is unable to determine the selling price because VSOE or TPE doesn’t exist, it determines BESP for the purposes of allocating the arrangement consideration. BESP can be determined by considering pricing practices, margin objectives, contractually stated prices, competitive/market conditions and geographies.

Unbilled receivables are created when services are performed or software is delivered and revenue is recognized in advance of billings. Deferred revenue is created when billing occurs in advance of performing services or when all revenue recognition criteria have not been met.

Cost of Sales and Direct Operating Expenses

Cost of sales and direct operating expenses represents the cost of providing the Company’s software and services offerings to customers and excludes depreciation, amortization and the cost of maintenance.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents consist of investments that are readily convertible into cash and have original maturities of three months or less.

Concentration of Credit Risk

Financial instruments that potentially subject the Company to concentrations of credit risk consist primarily of accounts receivable. The Company sells a significant portion of its products and services to the financial services industry and could be affected by the overall condition of that industry. The Company believes that any credit risk associated with accounts receivable is substantially mitigated by the relatively large number of customer accounts and reasonably short collection terms. Accounts receivable are stated at estimated net realizable value, which approximates fair value. By policy, the Company places its available cash and short-term investments with institutions of high credit-quality and limits the amount of credit exposure to any one issuer.

Foreign Currency Translation

The functional currency of each of the Company’s foreign operations is generally the local currency of the country in which the operation is located. All assets and liabilities are translated into U.S. dollars using exchange rates in effect at the balance sheet date. Revenue and expenses are translated using average exchange rates during the period. Increases and decreases in net assets resulting from currency translation are reflected in stockholder’s equity as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss).

 

70


Table of Contents

Allowance for Doubtful Accounts Receivable

A reconciliation of the beginning and ending balance of the allowance for doubtful accounts receivable follows (in millions):

 

     Continuing
operations
     Discontinued
operations
    Total  

Balance at December 31, 2013

   $  17       $  6      $  23   

Additions charged to operations

     5         2        7   

Translation adjustments and other

     —           (8 )(1)      (8
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2014

$  22    $ —      $  22   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Translation adjustments and other for discontinued operations includes $7 million that was removed as a result of the AS Split-Off in 2014.

Property and Equipment

Property and equipment are recorded at cost and depreciated using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets (three to eight years for equipment and ten to 40 years for buildings and improvements). Leasehold improvements are amortized ratably over their remaining lease term or useful life, if shorter. Depreciation and amortization of property and equipment in continuing operations was $62 million in 2012, $63 million in 2013 and $55 million in 2014.

Software Products

Software development costs are expensed as incurred and consist primarily of design and development costs of new products, and significant enhancements to existing products incurred before the establishment of technological feasibility. Costs incurred subsequent to technological feasibility of new and enhanced products, costs incurred to purchase or to create and implement internal-use software, and software obtained through business acquisitions are capitalized. Such costs are amortized over the estimated useful lives of the related products, using the straight-line method. For purchased and internally developed software, costs are generally amortized over three to five years. For software acquired in business acquisitions, costs are generally amortized over three to twelve years (average life is nine years).

Amortization of all software products in continuing operations were as follows for 2012, 2013 and 2014 (in millions):

 

     2012      2013      2014  

Amortization of all acquired and purchased software products

   $ 173       $ 141       $ 102   

Amortization of all internally developed software products (included in depreciation)

     11         19         27   

Purchase Accounting and Intangible Assets

Purchase accounting requires that all assets and liabilities be recorded at fair value on the acquisition date, including identifiable intangible assets separate from goodwill. Identifiable intangible assets include customer base (which includes customer contracts and relationships), software, trade name and non-compete agreements. Goodwill represents the excess of cost over the fair value of net assets acquired.

The estimated fair values and useful lives of identifiable intangible assets are based on many factors, including estimates and assumptions of future operating performance and cash flows of the acquired business, the nature of the business acquired, the specific characteristics of the identified intangible assets, and our historical experience and that of the acquired business. The estimates and assumptions used to determine the fair values

 

71


Table of Contents

and useful lives of identified intangible assets could change due to numerous factors, including product demand, market conditions, technological developments, economic conditions and competition. In connection with determination of fair values, the Company may engage independent appraisal firms to assist with the valuation of intangible and certain tangible assets acquired and certain assumed obligations.

Customer Base Intangible Assets

Customer base intangible assets represent customer contracts and relationships obtained as a result of the LBO and as part of businesses acquired since the LBO and are amortized using the straight-line method over their estimated useful lives, ranging from three to 18 years (average life is 15 years). Amortization of all customer base intangible assets in continuing operations totaled $63 million in 2012, $61 million in 2013 and $58 million in 2014.

Other Assets

Other assets consist primarily of deferred financing costs incurred in connection with the Company’s outstanding debt (see Note 5), noncompetition agreements and long-term accounts receivable. Deferred financing costs are amortized over the term of the related debt. Noncompetition agreements are amortized using the straight-line method over their stated terms, ranging from three to five years.

Impairment Reviews for Long-Lived Assets

The Company periodically reviews the carrying values and useful lives of long-lived assets for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value of the asset may not be recoverable. Factors that could indicate an impairment include significant underperformance of the asset as compared to historical or projected future operating results, or significant negative industry or economic trends. When the Company determines that the carrying value of an asset may not be recoverable, the related estimated future undiscounted cash flows expected to result from the use and eventual disposition of the asset are compared to the carrying value of the asset. If the sum of the estimated future undiscounted cash flows is less than the carrying amount, an impairment charge is recorded based on the difference between the carrying value of the asset and its fair value, which the Company estimates based on discounted expected future cash flows. In determining whether an asset is impaired, the Company makes assumptions regarding recoverability of costs, estimated future cash flows from the asset, intended use of the asset and other relevant factors. If these estimates or their related assumptions change, impairment charges for these assets may be required.

Future Amortization of Acquisition-Related Intangible Assets

Based on amounts recorded at December 31, 2014, total expected amortization of all acquisition-related intangible assets in each of the years ended December 31 follows (in millions):

 

2015

$ 84   

2016

  67   

2017

  59   

2018

  54   

2019

  46   

Trade Name

The trade name intangible asset represents the value of the SunGard trade name and is an indefinite-lived asset not subject to amortization. The Company completes its annual trade name impairment test as of July 1 of each year and more frequently when negative conditions or triggering events arise.

 

72


Table of Contents

Interim Impairment Test

The AS Split-Off triggered an interim impairment test of the carrying value of the SunGard trade name as of March 31, 2014 due to changes in how the trade name was to be used following the AS Split-Off. The Company utilized an income approach known as the relief-from-royalty method to determine the fair value of the SunGard trade name. Under this method, a royalty rate was applied to SunGard’s projected revenues to determine the annual cash savings attributable to ownership of the trade name. This amount was then tax-effected and discounted to present value to ultimately arrive at the estimated fair value of the trade name.

The Company developed certain assumptions and estimates related to the calculation of fair value of its trade name. The fair value assumptions and estimates primarily included projections of future revenues, a royalty rate, a tax rate, and a discount rate. The loss of projected AS revenues due to the AS Split-Off had a significant negative impact on the results of the trade name valuation. Based on the results of the impairment test, the fair value of the trade name was determined to be lower than its carrying value and resulted in a $339 million impairment of the trade name as of March 31, 2014.

In connection with the AS Split-Off, SunGard and AS agreed to a two-year royalty-free period for AS’ limited use of a derivative of the trade name, after which it will pay a pre-determined royalty rate based on its annual revenue for a specified number of years. As of March 31, 2014, SunGard transferred an $8 million “right-to-use” asset representing the value of AS’ limited right to use the “SUNGARD AVAILABILITY SERVICES” trade name during the royalty-free period.

Annual Impairment Test

As of July 1, 2014, the Company completed its annual impairment test and determined that the fair value of the trade name exceeded its carrying value, resulting in no further impairment of the trade name since the interim test performed as of March 31, 2014. From a sensitivity standpoint, a 50 basis point decrease in the assumed royalty rate would have resulted in an impairment of the trade name asset of approximately $123 million. A 50 basis point increase in the discount rate would result in an impairment of the trade name asset of approximately $24 million (100 basis point increase would result in an impairment of approximately $59 million). Furthermore, to the extent that additional businesses are sold, split-off or otherwise divested in the future, or revenues related to continuing operations decline, the revenue supporting the trade name will decline, which may result in further impairment charges.

The following table summarizes changes in the value of the trade name for the year ended December 31, 2014 (in millions):

 

    Trade name, net  

Balance at December 31, 2013

  $ 1,019   

Transfer limited “right to use” trade name asset to AS

    (8

Trade name impairment

    (339
 

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2014

$ 672   
 

 

 

 

Goodwill

July 1, 2014 Annual Impairment Test

The Company performs a goodwill impairment test annually and more frequently when negative conditions or triggering events arise. The Company completes its annual goodwill impairment test as of July 1 for each of its reporting units. The Company has the option of performing an assessment of certain qualitative factors to determine if it is more likely than not (that is, a likelihood of more than 50 percent) that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying value (referred to as a “step-zero” test) or proceeding directly to a quantitative analysis (referred to as a “step-one” test).

 

73


Table of Contents

Since each of the reporting units had an estimated fair value in excess of 20% of its respective carrying value as of the most recent step-one test, which was either as of July 1, 2012 or July 1, 2013, and no events were noted that would significantly decrease the fair value of the reporting unit, the Company elected to apply the qualitative assessment under the step-zero testing approach for all reporting units as of July 1, 2014. Based on the results of these tests, no step-one tests were determined to be necessary.

When performing a qualitative test, the Company assesses numerous factors to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of the reporting units are less than their respective carrying values. Examples of qualitative factors that management assesses include the Company’s financial performance, market and competitive factors in the software and services industry, the amount of excess fair value over the carrying value of each reporting unit evident in prior years and other events specific to the Company’s reporting units.

Management considered factors that would impact the reporting unit fair values as estimated by the market and income approaches used in the last step-one test. Management reviewed current projections of cash flows and compared these current projections to the projections included in the most recent step-one test, and considered the fact that no new significant competitors entered the marketplace in the industry and that consumer demand for the industry’s products remains relatively constant, if not growing slightly. Also, economic factors over the past year (or two years in the case of units that were last tested quantitatively as of July 1, 2012) did not significantly affect the discount rates used for the valuation of these reporting units. Management concluded that events occurring since the last step one test did not have a significant impact on the fair value of each of these reporting units. Therefore, management determined that it was not necessary to perform a quantitative (step-one) goodwill impairment test for these reporting units as the fair value of each reporting unit appeared to exceed its respective carrying value.

July 1, 2013 Impairment Test

For the annual impairment test as of July 1, 2013, the Company chose to assess the qualitative factors of five of its reporting units and determined, for each of those five reporting units, a step-one test was not required. Management concluded that events occurring in 2013 did not have a significant impact on the fair value of each of these reporting units. Therefore, management determined that it was not necessary to perform a quantitative (step-one) goodwill impairment test for these reporting units. The Company performed a step-one test for the remaining six reporting units.

In step one, the estimated fair value of each reporting unit is compared to its carrying value. The Company estimated the fair values of each reporting unit by a combination of (i) estimation of the discounted cash flows of each of the reporting units based on projected earnings (the income approach) and (ii) a comparative analysis of revenue and EBITDA multiples of public companies in similar markets (the market approach). An equal weighting of the income approach and the market approach was used in the July 1, 2013 test. If there is a deficiency (the estimated fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying value), a step-two test is required. In step two, the amount of any goodwill impairment is measured by comparing the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill to the carrying value of goodwill, with the resulting impairment reflected as a charge to operations. The implied fair value is determined in the same manner as the amount of goodwill recognized in a business combination.

Estimating the fair value of a reporting unit requires various assumptions including projections of future cash flows, perpetual growth rates and discount rates. The assumptions about future cash flows and growth rates are based on management’s assessment of a number of factors, including the reporting unit’s recent performance against budget, performance in the market that the reporting unit serves, as well as industry and general economic data from third party sources. Discount rate assumptions reflect an assessment of the risk inherent in those future cash flows. Changes to the underlying businesses could affect the future cash flows, which in turn could affect the fair value of the reporting unit.

 

74


Table of Contents

For the July 1, 2013 impairment test, the discount rates used were between 9% and 13.5% and the perpetual growth rates used were between 1.5% and 4%. Based on the results of the step-one tests, the Company determined that the fair values of each of the reporting units tested exceeded the respective carrying value and a step-two test was not required.

The Company determined that the excess of the estimated fair value over the carrying value of one of its reporting units, which is included in discontinued operations, was 9% of the carrying value as of the July 1, 2013 impairment test. This reporting unit’s goodwill balance at July 1, 2013 was $527 million. As mentioned above, the Company uses a combination of the income approach and market approach to determine the fair value of each reporting unit. Under the income approach, which is subject to variability based on the discount and perpetual growth rate assumptions used, a 50 basis point decrease in the perpetual growth rate or a 50 basis point increase in the discount rate would not have caused this reporting unit to fail the step-one test. A one hundred basis point decrease in the perpetual growth rate or a one hundred basis point increase in the discount rate would have caused this reporting unit to fail the step-one test and require a step-two analysis, and some or all of this goodwill could have been impaired. The other five reporting units for which the Company performed a step one test each had estimated fair values that exceeded the respective carrying value of the reporting unit by at least 25% as of the July 1, 2013 impairment test.

July 1, 2012 Annual Impairment Test

Based on the results of the July 1, 2012 step-one tests, the Company determined that the carrying value of the Availability Services North America (“AS NA”) reporting unit, which is included in discontinued operations, was in excess of its respective fair value and a step-two test was required. The primary driver for the decline in the fair value of the AS NA reporting unit compared to the prior year was the decline in the cash flow projections for AS NA when compared to those used in the 2011 goodwill impairment test as a result of a decline in the overall outlook of this reporting unit.

Prior to completing the step-two test, the Company first evaluated certain long-lived assets, primarily software, customer base and property and equipment, for impairment. In performing the impairment tests for long-lived assets, the Company estimated the undiscounted cash flows for the asset groups over the remaining useful lives of the reporting unit’s primary assets and compared that to the carrying value of the asset groups. There was no impairment of the long-lived assets.

In completing the step-two test to determine the implied fair value of goodwill and therefore the amount of impairment, management first determined the fair value of the tangible and intangible assets and liabilities. Based on the testing performed, the Company determined that the carrying value of goodwill exceeded its implied fair value and recorded a goodwill impairment charge of $385 million in discontinued operations.

For the July 1, 2012 impairment test, the discount rates used were between 10% and 12% and the perpetual growth rates used were between 3% and 4%.

The following table summarizes the 2012 goodwill impairment charge included in discontinued operations by reporting unit (in millions):

 

Segment

   Reporting
unit
     Net goodwill
balance before
impairment
     Impairment
charge
     Net goodwill
balance after
impairment
 

Availability Services

     AS NA       $ 914       $ (385    $ 529   

 

75


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes changes in goodwill by segment for continuing operations (in millions):

 

     Cost     Accumulated impairment        
     FS     PS&E      Subtotal         PS&E             Subtotal         Total  

Balance at December 31, 2012

   $ 3,485      $ 544       $ 4,029      $ (217   $ (217   $ 3,812   

Adjustments related to the LBO and prior year acquisitions

     (1     —           (1     —          —          (1

Effect of foreign currency translation

     17        —           17        —          —          17   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2013

  3,501      544      4,045      (217   (217   3,828   

Adjustments related to the LBO and prior year acquisitions

  (2   —        (2   —        —        (2

Effect of foreign currency translation

  (66   —        (66   —        —        (66
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2014

$ 3,433    $ 544    $ 3,977    $ (217 $ (217 $ 3,760   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other Long-Term Liabilities

Other long-term liabilities consist of straight-line rent expense accruals, asset retirement obligations for leased properties and, at SCC, a $17 million and $7 million dividend payable at December 31, 2013 and 2014, respectively (see Note 8).

Stock Compensation

Stock-based compensation cost is measured at the grant date based on the fair value of the award and is recognized as expense over the appropriate service period. Fair value of restricted stock units (“RSUs”) with service-based or performance-based vesting is equal to the fair market value of the Company’s common and preferred stock at the time of grant. Fair value for stock options and share appreciation rights (“Appreciation Units”) with service-based or performance-based vesting is computed using the Black-Scholes pricing model. Fair value for Appreciation Units and RSUs with market-based vesting is computed using a Monte Carlo simulation. Determining the fair value of stock-based awards requires considerable judgment, including estimating the expected term of stock options, expected volatility of the Company’s stock price, the number of awards expected to be forfeited, and the expected performance of the Company’s stock price. In addition, for stock-based awards where vesting is dependent upon achieving certain operating performance goals, the Company estimates the likelihood of achieving the performance goals. Differences between actual results and these estimates could have a material effect on the consolidated financial results. A deferred income tax asset is recorded over the vesting period as stock compensation expense is recognized. The Company’s ability to use the deferred tax asset is ultimately based on the actual value of the stock option upon exercise or restricted stock unit or Appreciation Unit upon distribution. If the actual value is lower than the fair value determined on the date of grant, there could be an income tax expense for the portion of the deferred tax asset that cannot be used, which could have a material effect on the consolidated financial results.

Income Taxes

Income tax expense is based on income before income taxes, and is accounted for under the asset and liability method. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases and operating loss and tax credit carryforwards. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period that includes the enactment date. Valuation allowances are recorded when it is not more likely than not that a deferred tax asset will be realized. The Company recognizes the effect of income tax positions only if those positions are more likely than not of being sustained. Recognized income tax positions

 

76


Table of Contents

are measured at the largest amount that is greater than 50% likely of being realized. Changes in recognition or measurement are reflected in the period in which the change in judgment occurs. Considerable judgment is required in assessing and estimating these amounts and the difference between the actual outcome of these future tax consequences and the estimates made could have a material impact on the consolidated results. To the extent that new information becomes available which causes the company to change its judgment regarding the adequacy of existing tax liabilities, such changes to tax liabilities will impact income tax expense in the period in which such determination is made. The Company records interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits in income tax expense.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

Recently Adopted

In March 2013, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2013-05, “Parent’s Accounting for the Cumulative Translation Adjustment upon Derecognition of Certain Subsidiaries or Groups of Assets within a Foreign Entity or of an Investment in Foreign Entity.” This new guidance clarified that when a parent either sells a part or all of its investment in a foreign entity or no longer holds a controlling financial interest in a subsidiary or group of assets that is a business, the parent should only release the related cumulative translation adjustment (“CTA”) into net income if the deconsolidation or derecognition results in the complete or substantially complete liquidation of the foreign entity in which the subsidiary or group of assets resided. The adoption of ASU 2013-05 on January 1, 2014 did not have an impact on the consolidated financial statements as the Company has historically accounted for the removal of CTA related to sales of non-U.S. entities consistent with this new guidance.

In July 2013, the FASB issued ASU 2013-11, “Presentation of an Unrecognized Tax Benefit When a Net Operating Loss Carryforward, a Similar Tax Loss, or a Tax Credit Carryforward Exists” to eliminate diversity in practice in the presentation of unrecognized tax benefits in those instances. This ASU requires that companies net their unrecognized tax benefits against all same jurisdiction deferred tax assets for net operating losses or tax credit carryforwards that would be used to settle the position with a tax authority to the extent such deferred tax assets are available. If this criteria does not apply or the tax law of the applicable jurisdiction does not require the entity to use and the entity does not intend to use the deferred tax assets for such purpose, the unrecognized tax benefit should be presented in the financial statements as a liability and should not be combined with deferred tax assets. The adoption of ASU 2013-11 on January 1, 2014 did not have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.

Recently Issued

In April 2014, the FASB issued ASU 2014-08, “Reporting Discontinued Operations and Disclosures of Disposals of Components of an Entity” that changes the criteria for reporting a discontinued operation. According to the new guidance, only disposals of a component that represents a strategic shift that has (or will have) a major effect on an entity’s operations and financial results is a discontinued operation. The new guidance also requires expanded disclosures about discontinued operations and disposals of a significant part of an entity that does not qualify for discontinued operations reporting. ASU 2014-08 is effective beginning January 1, 2015 with early adoption permitted, but only for disposals (or classifications as held for sale) that have not been reported in previously-issued financial statements. Once adopted, ASU 2014-08 will affect how the Company identifies and presents discontinued operations in the consolidated financial statements for future disposals.

In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU 2014-09, “Revenue from Contracts with Customers,” which outlines a comprehensive revenue recognition model and supersedes most current revenue recognition guidance. This new guidance establishes a five step process that companies must use in order to recognize revenue properly. Those five steps are: (i) identifying contract(s) with a customer, (ii) identifying the performance obligations in the contract, (iii) determining the transaction price, (iv) allocating the transaction price to the performance obligations in the contract, and (v) recognizing revenue when (or as) the entity satisfies a performance obligation.

 

77


Table of Contents

The new ASU will affect any entity that either enters into contracts with customers to transfer goods or services or enters into contracts for the transfer of nonfinancial assets unless those contracts are within the scope of other standards. ASU 2014-09 will be effective for the Company starting in the first quarter of fiscal 2017. ASU 2014-09 allows for two methods of adoption: (a) “full retrospective” adoption, meaning the standard is applied to all periods presented, or (b) “modified retrospective” adoption, meaning the cumulative effect of applying ASU 2014-09 is recognized as an adjustment to the fiscal 2017 opening retained earnings balance. The Company is in the process of determining the adoption method as well as the effects the adoption of ASU 2014-09 will have on its consolidated financial statements.

In August 2014, the FASB issued ASU 2014-15, “Presentation of Financial Statements—Going Concern,” which establishes that in connection with the preparation of financial statements for each annual and interim reporting period, an entity’s management should evaluate whether there are conditions or events, considered in the aggregate, that raise substantial doubt about the entity’s ability to continue as a going concern within one year after the date that the financial statements are issued. ASU 2014-15 requires management to consider qualitative and quantitative information about conditions and events known and reasonably knowable at the date the financial statements are issued. ASU 2014-15 will be effective for the Company for the annual period ending after December 15, 2016 and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2016. The adoption of ASU 2014-15 is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

2. Expense Classification:

Effective January 1, 2014, within the Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income, the Company changed its presentation of facilities and information technology-related expenses that are not directly associated with the delivery of its products and services. Formerly, the Company presented these expenses within sales, marketing and administration expense. The Company’s new method for presenting facilities and information technology-related expenses includes allocating these items to all of its functional areas, which the Company considers a better presentation as it more accurately reflects the actual cost of these functions. The presentation of prior year amounts in the consolidated financial statements has been reclassified to conform to the current year presentation.

Also, the Company revised its presentation of stock compensation expense. Formerly, the Company presented this expense entirely within sales, marketing and administration expense. The Company’s revised presentation allocates these costs to the appropriate functional areas. Further, the Company has revised its presentation of the costs for developer time spent on customer billable professional services projects. Formerly, the Company presented this expense within product development and maintenance expense. The Company’s revised presentation records these amounts to cost of sales and direct operating expense.

There was no impact on total reported costs and expenses for any period as a result of the changes. Management does not believe these revisions are material to the previously issued financial statements.

 

78


Table of Contents

The impact within the functional areas, including the impact of the reclassification of AS to discontinued operations, is as follows for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2013 as compared to the results included in the statements of comprehensive income included in the 2013 Annual Report on Form 10-K (in millions):

 

    Year Ended December 31, 2013  
    As
reported
    Impact of
discontinued
operations
    Reclassification
of IT and
facilities costs
    Revised
presentation
of stock
compensation
expense
    Revised
presentation
of
developer
time spent
on
professional
services
projects
    As presented
in the
statement of
comprehensive
income (loss)
 

Cost of sales and direct operating (excluding depreciation)

  $ 1,706      $ (738   $ 52      $ 5      $ 20      $ 1,045   

Sales, marketing and administration

    964        (223     (98     (10     —          633   

Product development and maintenance

    366        (5     46        5        (20     392   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total functional expenses

$ 3,036    $ (966 $ —      $ —      $ —      $ 2,070   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Year Ended December 31, 2012  
    As
reported
    Impact of
discontinued
operations
    Reclassification
of IT and
facilities costs
    Revised
presentation
of stock
compensation
expense
    Revised
presentation
of
developer
time spent
on
professional
services
projects
    As presented
in the
statement of
comprehensive
income (loss)
 

Cost of sales and direct operating (excluding depreciation)

  $ 1,712      $ (713   $ 64      $ 4      $ 15      $ 1,082   

Sales, marketing and administration

    996        (223     (122     (8     —          643   

Product development and maintenance

    380        (5     58        4        (15     422   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total functional expenses

$ 3,088    $ (941 $ —      $ —      $ —      $ 2,147   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

3. Acquisitions and Discontinued Operations:

Acquisitions

SunGard is focused on generating organic growth from innovative products and services marketed on a global basis. The Company will selectively acquire businesses to help it achieve this goal by enhancing its products and services or extending its geographic reach.

During each of 2013 and 2014, the Company completed one acquisition in its FS segment. Cash paid, net of cash acquired, was $1 million and $4 million in 2013 and 2014, respectively (see Note 18). In addition, in 2013 the Company paid approximately $1 million related to deferred purchase price from a prior year acquisition.

During 2012, the Company completed two acquisitions in its FS segment. Cash paid, net of cash acquired, was $39 million. In addition, the Company paid approximately $1 million related to deferred purchase price from prior year acquisitions.

The acquisitions discussed above were not material to the Company’s operations, financial position or cash flows.

 

 

79


Table of Contents

At December 31, 2014, contingent purchase price obligations that depend upon the operating performance of certain acquired businesses were $6 million, of which less than $1 million is included in other long-term liabilities.

Discontinued Operations

In January 2014, the Company completed the sale of two small businesses within the FS segment in exchange for €27 million paid at closing, €9 million to be paid within three years (“deferred purchase price”) and €2 million to be paid upon the successful assignment of certain customer contracts. The deferred purchase price is unconditional and is secured by a bank guarantee. On March 31, 2014, AS was split-off from SunGard (see Note 1). These businesses are included in our financial results as discontinued operations for all periods presented.

In January 2012, the Company sold its Higher Education business (“HE”) and in July 2012 the Company sold one FS subsidiary. A $571 million gain was recorded on the sales. As a result of the HE sale, in 2012, the Company paid approximately $400 million in income tax payments, which is presented within income taxes paid, net of refunds on the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows.

The results for the discontinued operations for the years ended December 31, 2012, 2013 and 2014 were as follows (in millions):

 

     Year ended December 31,  
     2012      2013      2014  

Revenue

   $ 1,509       $ 1,421       $ 338   

Operating income (loss), excluding goodwill impairment

     106         71         (25

Goodwill impairment charge

     (385      —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

  (279   71      (25

Interest expense, net

  (68   (73   (18

Other income (expense)

  (1   1      —     

Gain on sale of business

  571      —        22   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

  223      (1   (21

Benefit from (provision for) income taxes

  (246   18      4   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

$ (23 $ 17    $ (17
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

An additional $3 million benefit from income taxes was recorded in 2014 in income (loss) from discontinued operations in the statement of comprehensive income for SCC and SCCII due to the deduction of certain previously capitalized costs for income tax purposes available as a result of the AS Split-Off.

 

80


Table of Contents

Assets of discontinued operations and liabilities of discontinued operations consisted of the following at December 31, 2013 (in millions):

 

     December 31, 2013  

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 31   

Trade receivables, net

     227   

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

     70   

Property and equipment, net

     669   

Software products, net

     40   

Customer base, net

     734   

Other

     10   

Goodwill

     735   
  

 

 

 

Assets of discontinued operations

$ 2,516   
  

 

 

 

Accounts payable

$ 47   

Accrued compensation and benefits

  45   

Other accrued expenses

  78   

Deferred revenue

  260   

Current portion of long-term debt

  2   

Long-term debt

  5   

Deferred income taxes

  282   

Other long-term liabilities

  80   
  

 

 

 

Liabilities of discontinued operations

$ 799   
  

 

 

 

4. Property and Equipment:

Property and equipment consisted of the following (in millions):

 

    December 31, 2013     December 31, 2014  

Computer and telecommunications equipment

  $ 349      $ 374   

Leasehold improvements

    81        84   

Office furniture and equipment

    68        67   

Buildings and improvements

    21        26   

Land

    2        2   

Construction in progress

    7        13   
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property and equipment—total cost

  528      566   

Accumulated depreciation

  (376   (414
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property and equipment, net

$ 152    $ 152   
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

81


Table of Contents

5. Debt and Derivative Instruments:

Debt consisted of the following (in millions):

 

    December 31,
2013
    December 31,
2014
 

Senior Secured Credit Facilities:

   

Secured revolving credit facility due March 8, 2018 (A)

  $ —        $ —     

Tranche A due February 28, 2014, effective interest rate of 1.92% (A)

    7        —     

Tranche C due February 28, 2017, effective interest rate of 4.41% and 4.44% (A)

    427        400   

Tranche D due January 31, 2020, effective interest rate of 4.50% (A)

    713        —     

Tranche E due March 8, 2020, effective interest rate of 4.10% and 4.31% (A)

    2,183        1,918   
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Senior Secured Credit Facilities

  3,330      2,318   

Senior Secured Notes due 2014 at 4.875% (B)

  250      —     

Senior Notes due 2018 at 7.375% (C)

  900      511   

Senior Notes due 2020 at 7.625% (C)

  700      700   

Senior Subordinated Notes due 2019 at 6.625% (C)

  1,000      1,000   

Secured accounts receivable facility, at 3.67% and 3.16% (D)

  200      140   

Other, primarily foreign bank debt, acquisition purchase price and capital lease obligations

  4      —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total debt

$ 6,384    $ 4,669   
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Short-term borrowings and current portion of long-term debt

$ 290    $ —     

Long-term debt

  6,094      4,669   
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Long-term debt

$ 6,384    $ 4,669   
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

The Company was in compliance with all covenants at December 31, 2014. Below is a summary of SunGard’s debt instruments.

(A) Senior Secured Credit Facilities

SunGard has a $600 million revolving credit facility, of which $592 million was available for borrowing after giving effect to $8 million of outstanding letters of credit as of December 31, 2014. In addition, there were $4 million of letters of credit outstanding at December 31, 2014 that did not impact availability under the revolving credit facility.

On March 2, 2012, SunGard amended its Amended and Restated Credit Agreement dated as of August 11, 2005, as amended and restated from time to time (“Credit Agreement”) to, among other things, extend the maturity date of approximately $908 million in aggregate principal amount of tranche A and incremental term loans from February 28, 2014 to February 28, 2017 (“tranche C”), extend the maturity of the $880 million revolving credit facility commitments from May 11, 2013 to November 29, 2016, and amend certain covenants and other provisions, in order to, among other things, permit the potential spin-off of AS. The revolving credit facility commitments and tranche C each have springing maturity provisions which are described in the Credit Agreement. The interest rate on tranche C is LIBOR plus 3.75%.

On December 17, 2012, SunGard amended its Credit Agreement to, among other things, allow for the issuance of a $720 million term loan (“tranche D”), permit incremental credit extensions under the restated credit agreement in an amount up to $750 million; and modify certain covenants and other provisions in order to, among other things, permit additional restricted payments to be made with the net proceeds of the tranche D term loan and available cash in an aggregate amount not to exceed $750 million. Tranche D had certain springing maturities, and the interest rate was LIBOR plus 3.5% with a 1% LIBOR floor.

 

82


Table of Contents

On December 31, 2012, SunGard voluntarily prepaid $48 million of its tranche A term loan and the entire outstanding incremental term loan balance of $169 million.

On March 8, 2013, SunGard amended and restated its Credit Agreement to, among other things, (i) issue an additional term loan of $2,200 million (“tranche E”) maturing on March 8, 2020, the proceeds of which were used to (a) repay in full the $1,719 million tranche B term loan and (b) repay $481 million of the tranche C term loan; (ii) replace the $880 million of revolving commitments with $850 million of new revolving commitments, which will mature on March 8, 2018; and (iii) modify certain covenants and other provisions in order to, among other things (x) modify (and in the case of the term loan facility, remove) the financial maintenance covenants included therein and (y) permit the Company to direct the net cash proceeds of permitted dispositions otherwise requiring a prepayment of term loans to the prepayment of specific tranches of term loans at the Company’s sole discretion. The interest rate on tranche E is LIBOR plus 3% with a 1% LIBOR floor.

During 2013, the Company repaid $200 million of tranche A term loans, $50 million outstanding on the revolving portion of the accounts receivable facility, and made the quarterly amortization payments on tranche D and E which totaled approximately $24 million.

On February 7, 2014, SunGard amended and restated its Credit Agreement to among other things (a) amend certain covenants and other provisions of the Credit Agreement in order to permit the AS Split-Off, including (i) the ability to effect the split-off without requiring an initial public offering, (ii) permitting AS to incur up to $1.5 billion of indebtedness in connection with the split-off, and (iii) SunGard’s total secured leverage ratio (less cash and cash equivalents in excess of $50 million), after giving pro forma effect to the split-off, to increase no more than 0.60x of Adjusted EBITDA at the time of the split-off; and (b) amend certain covenants and other provisions in order to, among other things (i) modify the financial maintenance covenant included therein, and (ii) permit the Company and its affiliates to repurchase term loans.

On February 28, 2014, SunGard repaid at maturity the remaining $7 million Tranche A term loan under the Senior Secured Credit Facilities.

On March 31, 2014, SunGard used net cash proceeds from the issuance of the SpinCo Term Loan to repay term loans (see mandatory prepayments below). Also, as a result of the AS Split-Off on March 31, 2014, SunGard’s revolving credit facility decreased from $850 million to $600 million.

Borrowings under the Credit Agreement bear interest at a rate equal to an applicable margin plus, at SunGard’s option, one of the following:

 

    LIBOR based on the costs of funds for deposits in the currency of such borrowing for either 30, 60, 90 or 180 days, or

 

    a base rate that is the higher of:

 

    the prime rate of JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and

 

    the federal funds rate plus one-half of 1%.

The applicable margin for borrowings under the various Credit Agreement tranches may change subject to attaining certain leverage ratios. In addition to paying interest on outstanding principal under the Credit Agreement, the Company pays a commitment fee to the lenders under the revolving credit facility in respect of the unutilized commitments. The commitment fee rate is currently 1.125% per annum and may change subject to attaining certain leverage ratios.

 

83


Table of Contents

As of December 31, 2014, the applicable interest rates and the effective interest rates adjusted for swaps (if applicable) were as follows:

 

     Applicable interest rate     Effective rate adjusted for
swaps
 

Revolving credit facility

     3.67     N/A   

Tranche C

     3.92     4.44

Tranche E

     4.00     4.31

N/A: Not Applicable

All obligations under the Credit Agreement are fully and unconditionally guaranteed by SunGard Holdco LLC and by substantially all domestic, 100% owned subsidiaries, referred to, collectively, as Guarantors.

Mandatory Prepayments

The Credit Agreement requires SunGard to prepay outstanding term loans, subject to certain exceptions, with 50% of annual excess cash flow (subject to attaining a certain leverage ratio) and proceeds from certain asset sales, casualty and condemnation events, other borrowings and certain financings under SunGard’s secured accounts receivable facility. Any mandatory prepayment resulting from a permitted disposition or the AS Split-Off are applied pro rata to the lenders of specific tranches of term loans at the Company’s sole discretion. All other mandatory payments would be applied pro rata to the term loan lenders and to installments of the term loans in direct order of maturity. Pursuant to the terms of the Credit Agreement, SunGard made the following mandatory prepayments:

 

    In January 2012, SunGard completed the sale of HE and used net cash proceeds (as defined in the Credit Agreement) of $1.22 billion to repay, on a pro-rata basis, $396 million, $689 million and $137 million of tranche A, tranche B and the incremental term loan, respectively. As a result of the prepayment, the Company incurred a loss on the extinguishment of debt of approximately $15 million; and

 

    On March 31, 2014, SunGard used the $1,005 million net cash proceeds from the issuance of the SpinCo Term Loan in connection with the AS Split-Off, to repay approximately $27 million of its tranche C term loan, $713 million of its tranche D term loan and $265 million of its tranche E term loan.

As a result of loan prepayments, SunGard is no longer required to make quarterly principal payments on the tranche C or tranche E term loans.

The Credit Agreement contains a number of covenants that, among other things, restrict, subject to certain exceptions, SunGard’s (and most or all of its subsidiaries’) ability to incur additional debt or issue preferred stock, pay dividends and distributions on or repurchase capital stock, create liens on assets, enter into sale and leaseback transactions, repay subordinated indebtedness, make investments, loans or advances, make capital expenditures, engage in certain transactions with affiliates, amend certain material agreements, change its lines of business, sell assets and engage in mergers or consolidations. In addition, under the revolving credit facility within the Credit Agreement, SunGard may be required to satisfy the total leverage ratio covenant depending on the amount drawn at the end of each fiscal quarter.

SunGard uses interest rate swap agreements to manage the amount of its floating rate debt in order to reduce its exposure to variable rate interest payments associated with the Credit Agreement. Each of these swap agreements is designated as a cash flow hedge. SunGard pays a stream of fixed interest payments for the term of the swap, and in turn, receives variable interest payments based on LIBOR. At December 31, 2014, one-month LIBOR was 0.17% and three-month LIBOR was 0.26%. The net receipt or payment from the interest rate swap agreements is included in interest expense.

 

84


Table of Contents

A summary of the Company’s interest rate swaps at December 31, 2014 follows:

 

Inception

  Maturity   Notional Amount
(in millions)
    Interest rate
paid
    Interest rate
received
(LIBOR)
 

August-September 2012

  February 2017   $ 400        0.69     1-Month   

June 2013

  June 2019     100        1.86     3-Month   

September 2013

  June 2019     100        2.26     3-Month   

February-March 2014

  March 2020     300        2.27     3-Month   
   

 

 

     

Total / Weighted Average Interest Rate

$ 900      1.52
   

 

 

     

The interest rate swaps are included at estimated fair value as an asset or a liability in the consolidated balance sheet based on a discounted cash flow model using applicable market swap rates and certain assumptions. For 2012 and 2013, the Company included unrealized after-tax gains of $2 million, $5 million respectively, and in 2014, the company had a $4 million unrealized after-tax loss in Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) related to the change in market value of the swaps. The market value of the swaps recorded in Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) may be recognized in the statement of operations if certain terms of the Credit Agreement change, are modified or if the loan is extinguished. The fair values of the swap agreements at December 31, 2013 are $4 million and are included in other assets. The fair values of the swap agreements at December 31, 2014 are $1 million and $5 million and are included in other assets and other accrued expenses, respectively. The effects of the interest rate swaps are reflected in the effective interest rate for the Credit Agreement loans in the components of the debt table above. The Company had no ineffectiveness related to its swap agreements as of December 31, 2014. The Company expects to reclassify in the next twelve months approximately $8 million from other comprehensive income (loss) into earnings related to the Company’s interest rate swaps based on the borrowing rates at December 31, 2014.

(B) Senior Secured Notes due 2014

On January 15, 2004, SunGard issued $250 million of 4.875% senior unsecured notes due January 2014, which were subject to certain standard covenants. As a result of the LBO, these senior notes became collateralized on an equal and ratable basis with loans under the Credit Agreement and were guaranteed by all subsidiaries that guarantee the senior notes due 2018 and 2020 and senior subordinated notes due 2019. The Senior Secured Notes were fully repaid and retired in January 2014.

(C) Senior Notes due 2015, 2018 and 2020 and Senior Subordinated Notes due 2015 and 2019

In November 2010, SunGard issued $900 million of 7.375% senior notes due 2018 (“SunGard 2018 Notes”) and $700 million of 7.625% of senior notes due 2020 (“SunGard 2020 Notes” and together with SunGard 2018 Notes “SunGard Senior Notes”). The proceeds, together with other cash, were used to retire the former $1.6 billion 9.125% senior notes that would have been due 2013. The SunGard Senior Notes (i) rank equally in right of payment to all existing and future senior debt and other obligations that are not, by their terms, expressly subordinated in right of payment to the SunGard Senior Notes, (ii) are effectively subordinated in right of payment to all existing and future secured debt to the extent of the value of the assets securing such debt, and (iii) are structurally subordinated to all obligations of each subsidiary that is not a guarantor of the SunGard Senior Notes. All obligations under the SunGard Senior Notes are fully and unconditionally guaranteed, subject to certain exceptions, by substantially all domestic, 100% owned subsidiaries of SunGard.

On April 2, 2012, SunGard redeemed for $527 million plus accrued and unpaid interest to the redemption date, all of its outstanding $500 million 10.625% senior notes due 2015 (“2015 Notes”) under the Indenture dated as of September 29, 2008 among SunGard, the guarantors named therein, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee, as amended or supplemented from time to time. In conjunction with the redemption of the 2015 Notes, the Company incurred a $37 million loss on the extinguishment of debt which included a $27 million premium.

 

85


Table of Contents

On November 1, 2012, SunGard issued $1 billion aggregate principal amount of 6.625% senior subordinated notes due 2019 (“Senior Subordinated Notes”) and used a portion of the net proceeds from this offering to repurchase approximately $490 million of its $1 billion 10.25% senior subordinated notes due 2015 (“existing 10.25% senior subordinated notes”). On December 3, 2012, SunGard redeemed the remaining existing 10.25% senior subordinated notes. As a result of this transaction, the Company incurred a $29 million loss on the extinguishment of debt which included a $21 million premium.

On March 31, 2014, SunGard exchanged the SpinCo senior notes with an aggregate principal amount of approximately $425 million for an aggregate principal amount of approximately $389 million of existing SunGard 2018 Notes which were then retired. The retirement of the SunGard 2018 Notes resulted in a $36 million loss on extinguishment of debt during the three months ended March 31, 2014. In addition, SunGard wrote-off approximately $25 million of capitalized deferred financing fees resulting from the repayment or retirement of debt during the three months ended March 31, 2014.

The Senior Subordinated Notes are unsecured senior subordinated obligations that are subordinated in right of payment to the existing and future senior debt, including the senior secured credit facilities, the SunGard 2018 Notes and the SunGard 2020 Notes. The Senior Subordinated Notes (i) rank equally in right of payment to all future senior subordinated debt, (ii) are effectively subordinated in right of payment to all existing and future secured debt to the extent of the value of the assets securing such debt, (iii) are structurally subordinated to all obligations of each subsidiary that is not a guarantor of the Senior Subordinated Notes, and (iv) rank senior in right of payment to all future debt and other obligations that are, by their terms, expressly subordinated in right of payment to the Senior Subordinated Notes.

The SunGard Senior Notes and Senior Subordinated Notes are redeemable in whole or in part, at SunGard’s option, at any time at varying redemption prices that generally include premiums, which are defined in the applicable indentures. In addition, upon a change of control, SunGard is required to make an offer to redeem all of the SunGard Senior Notes and Senior Subordinated Notes at a redemption price equal to 101% of the aggregate principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest.

The indentures governing the SunGard Senior Notes and Senior Subordinated Notes contain a number of covenants that restrict, subject to certain exceptions, SunGard’s ability and the ability of its restricted subsidiaries to incur additional debt or issue certain preferred shares, pay dividends on or make other distributions in respect of its capital stock or make other restricted payments, make certain investments, enter into certain types of transactions with affiliates, create liens securing certain debt without securing the SunGard Senior Notes or Senior Subordinated Notes, as applicable, sell certain assets, consolidate, merge, sell or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of its assets and designate its subsidiaries as unrestricted subsidiaries.

(D) Secured Accounts Receivable Facility

SunGard’s syndicated secured accounts receivable facility limit was $200 million at December 31, 2014, which consists of a term loan of $140 million and a revolving commitment of $60 million. Advances may be borrowed and repaid under the revolving commitment with no impact on the facility limit. The term loan commitment may be repaid at any time at SunGard’s option, but will result in a permanent reduction in the facility limit. The interest rate is one-month LIBOR plus 3.5% and one-month LIBOR plus 3.0% at December 31, 2013 and 2014 respectively, which were 3.67% and 3.16 % at December 31, 2013 and 2014 respectively. At December 31, 2014, $140 million was drawn against the term loan commitment and no amount was outstanding under the revolving credit commitment. Also at December 31, 2014, $364 million of accounts receivable secured the borrowings under the receivables facility.

On January 31, 2014, SunGard removed AS as a seller and, as a result, repaid $60 million of the term loan commitment. Before the removal of AS and the $60 million repayment of the term loan, the aggregate facility limit was $275 million, consisting of a $200 million term loan commitment and a $75 million revolving credit commitment.

 

86


Table of Contents

On May 14, 2014 SunGard amended and restated its secured accounts receivables facility in order to, among other things, (i) extend the maturity date of the receivables facility from December 19, 2017 to May 14, 2019; and (ii) reduce the applicable margin on the advances under the facility from 3.50% for LIBOR advances and 2.50% for base rate advances to 3.00% and 2.00%, respectively.

SunGard is subject to a fee on the unused portion of 0.75% per annum. The receivables facility contains certain covenants and SunGard is required to satisfy and maintain specified facility performance ratios, financial ratios and other financial condition tests.

Future Maturities

At December 31, 2014, the contractual future maturities of debt are as follows (in millions):

 

     Contractual  

2015

   $ —     

2016

     —     

2017

     400   

2018

     511   

2019

     1,140   

Thereafter

     2,618   
  

 

 

 

Total

$ 4,669   
  

 

 

 

6. Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss):

The following table summarizes the unrealized gains (losses) on derivative instruments including the impact of components reclassified into net income from accumulated other comprehensive income for the years ended December 31, 2012, 2013 and 2014 (in millions):

 

     Year Ended December 31,      

Other Comprehensive Income Components

     2012         2013         2014      

Affected Line Item in the Statement of
Comprehensive Income for Components
Reclassified from OCI

Unrealized gain (loss) on derivative instruments identified as accounting hedges

   $ (1   $ —        $ (15  

Loss (gain) on derivatives reclassified into income:

        

Interest rate contracts

     10        6        7      Interest expense and amortization of deferred financing fees

Forward Currency Hedges

     3        —          —        Cost of sales and direct operating
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

Total reclassified into income

  13      6      7   

Income tax benefit (expense)

  (2   (3   3   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income net of tax

  11      3      10   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

Unrealized gain (loss) on derivative instruments, net of tax

$ 10    $ 3    $ (5
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

87


Table of Contents

The following table provides a rollforward of the components of accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of tax, through December 31, 2014 as follows (in millions):

 

     Gains and Losses on
Cash Flow Hedges
    Currency
Translation
    Other     Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)
 

Balance at December 31, 2012

   $ 1      $ (4   $ —        $ (3

Other comprehensive income before reclassifications

     —          19        (3     16   

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income net of tax

     3        —          —          3   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net current-period other comprehensive income

  3      19      (3   19   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2013

  4      15      (3   16   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income before reclassifications

  (15   (65   (3   (83

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income net of tax

  10      —        —        10   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net current-period other comprehensive income

  (5   (65   (3   (73

Impact from AS Split-Off

  —        (75   —        (75
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2014

$ (1 $ (125 $ (6 $ (132
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

7. Fair Value Measurements:

The following table summarizes assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis at December 31, 2014 (in millions):

 

          Fair Value Measures Using         
    

Balance Sheet Caption

   Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total  

Assets

              

Money market funds

   Cash and cash equivalents    $ 106       $ —         $ —         $ 106   

Interest rate swap agreements

   Other assets      —           1         —           1   

Currency forward contracts

   Prepaid expenses and other current assets      —           3         —           3   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ 106    $ 4    $ —      $ 110   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities

Interest rate swap agreements

Other accrued expenses $ —      $ 5    $ —      $ 5   

Currency forward contracts

Other accrued expenses   —        1      —        1   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ —      $ 6    $ —      $ 6   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table summarizes assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis at December 31, 2013 (in millions):

 

          Fair Value Measures Using         
    

Balance Sheet Caption

   Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total  

Assets

              

Money market funds

   Cash and cash equivalents    $ 407       $ —         $ —         $ 407   

Interest rate swap agreements

   Other assets      —           4         —           4   

Currency forward contracts

   Prepaid expenses and other current assets      —           2         —           2   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ 407    $ 6    $ —      $ 413   
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

88


Table of Contents

A Level 1 fair value measure is based upon quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. A Level 2 fair value measure is based upon quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active markets or inputs that are observable. A Level 3 fair value measure is based upon inputs that are unobservable (for example, cash flow modeling inputs based on assumptions).

Money market funds are recognized and measured at fair value in the Company’s financial statements. Fair values of the interest rate swap agreements are calculated using a discounted cash flow model using observable applicable market swap rates and assumptions and are compared to market valuations obtained from brokers.

The Company uses currency forward contracts to manage its exposure to fluctuations in costs caused by variations in Indian Rupee (“INR”) exchange rates. These INR forward contacts are designated as cash flow hedges. The fair value of these currency forward contracts is determined using currency exchange market rates, obtained from reliable, independent, third party banks, at the balance sheet date. This fair value of forward contracts is subject to changes in currency exchange rates. The Company has no ineffectiveness related to its use of currency forward contracts. The fair value of the INR forward contracts were an asset of $2 million and $3 million at December 31, 2013 and 2014, respectively. The Company expects to reclassify in the next twelve months approximately $2 million from other comprehensive income (loss) into earnings related to the Company’s INR forward contracts.

Certain assets and liabilities are measured on a non-recurring basis. During the first quarter of 2014, the trade name (a level 3 non-recurring fair value measure) was written down to a fair value of $672 million due to the recognition of a $339 million impairment charge, which was the result of the AS Split-Off (see Note 3). The fair value of the trade name is categorized as Level 3, a fair value measurement using significant unobservable inputs, and is estimated by discounted cash flows based on projected future revenues. This requires the use of various assumptions including projections of future cash flows, perpetual growth rates and discount rates. In 2012, goodwill (a level 3 non-recurring fair value measure) with a carrying value of $914 million was written down to a fair value of $529 million due to the recognition of a $385 million impairment loss, which is reflected in discontinued operations (see Note 1).

The fair value of goodwill is categorized in Level 3, fair value measurement using significant unobservable inputs, and is estimated by a combination of (i) discounted cash flows based on projected earnings in the future (the income approach) and (ii) a comparative analysis of revenue and EBITDA multiples of public companies in similar markets (the market approach). This requires the use of various assumptions including projections of future cash flows, perpetual growth rates and discount rates.

The following table summarizes assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis at December 31, 2014 (in millions):

 

     Fair Value Measures Using  
     Level 1      Level 2      Level 3  

Assets

        

Trade name

   $ —         $ —         $ 672   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

89


Table of Contents

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

The fair values of cash and cash equivalents, accounts receivable, accounts payable and accrued expenses, to the extent the underlying liability will be settled in cash, approximate carrying values because of the short-term nature of these instruments. The derivative financial instruments are carried at fair value. The fair value of the Company’s floating rate and fixed rate long-term debt (Level 2) is determined using actual market quotes and benchmark yields received from independent vendors. The following table presents the carrying amount and estimated fair value of the Company’s debt, including current portion and excluding the interest rate swaps (in millions):

 

     December 31, 2013      December 31, 2014  
     Carrying
Value
     Fair
Value
     Carrying
Value
     Fair
Value
 
             

Floating rate debt

   $ 3,530       $ 3,548       $ 2,458       $ 2,431   

Fixed rate debt

     2,862         3,024         2,211         2,286   

8. Preferred Stock

SCCII

SCCII has preferred and common stock outstanding at December 31, 2013 and 2014. The preferred stock is non-voting and ranks senior in right of payment to the common stock. Each share of preferred stock has a liquidation preference of $100 (the initial Class P liquidation preference) plus an amount equal to the accrued and unpaid dividends accruing at a rate of 11.5% per year of the initial Class P liquidation preference ($100 per share), compounded quarterly. Holders of preferred stock are entitled to receive cumulative preferential dividends to the extent a dividend is declared by the Board of Directors of SCCII at a rate of 11.5% per year of the initial Class P liquidation preference ($100 per share) payable quarterly in arrears. The aggregate amount of cumulative but undeclared preferred stock dividends at December 31, 2013 and 2014 was $764 million and $744 million, respectively ($77.35 and $98.64 per share, respectively).

Preferred shares and stock awards which include preferred shares are held by certain members of management. In the case of termination resulting from disability or death, an employee or his/her estate may exercise a put option which would require the Company to repurchase vested shares at the current fair market value. Accordingly, these shares of preferred stock must be classified as temporary equity (between liabilities and stockholder’s equity) on the balance sheet of SCCII.

In December 2012, SunGard borrowed $720 million (see Note 5) and used the net proceeds, along with available cash, to finance a preferred stock dividend of approximately $718 million, or $72.80 per preferred share (equivalent to $3.64 per pre-split Unit, as defined in Note 10). As a result of the dividend, under the terms of various equity award agreements and the SCC and SCCII Dividend Rights Plan, SCC was required to make dividend-equivalent cash payments of up to approximately $30 million to equity award holders. Of the $30 million, approximately $6 million was paid in December 2012 and the remaining balance will be paid over approximately five years, subject to vesting of the underlying equity awards. The total dividend and dividend-equivalents paid in 2012 was $724 million. In order to effect this transaction, SDS declared a dividend of approximately $747 million through holding companies ultimately to SCCII, which in turn declared a dividend of approximately $718 million to the holders of the preferred stock and a dividend of approximately $30 million, representing the amount of the dividend-equivalent cash payments, to SCC as the sole holder of the common stock. Also as a result of the dividend, all outstanding options on Units, except for the options with an exercise price of $4.50 per Unit, were modified to reduce the exercise price by $3.64 per Unit. There was no incremental stock compensation expense as a result of the dividend. Approximately $3 million and $2 million of dividend-equivalents were paid in 2013 and 2014, respectively.

 

90


Table of Contents

On March 31, 2014, SCCII exchanged all of the common stock of SpinCo for 2,358,065 shares of its preferred stock held by its stockholders, which was recorded as treasury stock at the book value of the investment SCCII had in SpinCo. The decrease in the undeclared dividend is due to the reduced quantity of preferred stock outstanding partially offset by continued compounding.

SCC

Preferred stock of SCCII is classified as Non-controlling interest in the equity section or temporary equity on the balance sheet of SCC.

9. Common Stock

SCC has nine classes of common stock, Class L and Class A-1 through A-8. Class L common stock has identical terms as Class A common stock except as follows:

 

    Class L common stock has a liquidation preference: distributions by SCC are first allocated to Class L common stock up to its $81 per share liquidation preference plus an amount sufficient to generate a rate of return of 13.5% per annum, compounded quarterly (“Class L Liquidation Preference”). All holders of Common stock, as a single class, share in any remaining distributions pro rata based on the number of outstanding shares of Common stock; and

 

    each share of Class L common stock automatically converts into Class A common stock upon an initial public offering or other registration of the Class A common stock and is convertible into Class A common stock upon a majority vote of the holders of the outstanding Class L common stock upon a change in control or other realization events. If converted, each share of Class L common stock is convertible into one share of Class A common stock plus an additional number of shares of Class A common stock determined by dividing the Class L Liquidation Preference at the date of conversion by the adjusted market value of one share of Class A common stock as set forth in the certificate of incorporation of SCC.

In the case of termination resulting from disability or death, an employee or his/her estate may exercise a put option which would require the Company to repurchase vested shares at the current fair market value. Accordingly, these common shares must be classified as temporary equity (between liabilities and equity) on the balance sheet of SCC.

10. Stock Option and Award Plans and Stock-Based Compensation:

The SunGard 2005 Management Incentive Plan as amended from time to time (“Plan”) was established to provide long-term equity incentives. The Plan authorizes the issuance of equity subject to awards made under the Plan for up to 70 million shares of Class A common stock and 7 million shares of Class L common stock of SCC and 2.5 million shares of preferred stock of SCCII.

Under the Plan, awards of time-based and performance-based options have been granted to purchase “Units” in the Parent Companies. Each “Unit” consisted of 1.3 shares of Class A common stock and 0.1444 shares of Class L common stock of SCC and 0.05 shares of preferred stock of SCCII before the AS Split-Off and 0.038 shares of preferred stock of SCCII after the AS Split-Off. The shares comprising a Unit are in the same proportion as the shares issued to all stockholders of the Parent Companies. From 2005 to 2007, options for Units were granted. Options for Units cannot be separately exercised for the individual classes of stock. Beginning in late 2007, awards were composed of restricted stock units (“RSUs”) for Units and options to purchase Class A common stock in SCC. Class A options were no longer granted after September 2010. Currently, RSUs and Appreciation Units (discussed below) are granted. All awards under the Plan are granted at fair market value on the date of grant.

As a result of the AS Split-Off, the proportion of preferred stock of SCCII included in each “Unit” of equity in the Parent Companies changed from 0.05 shares to 0.038 shares, while there was no change in the proportion

 

91


Table of Contents

of the Class A or Class L common stock of SCC. Accordingly, post-split, a “Unit” consists of 1.3 shares of Class A common stock and 0.1444 shares of Class L common stock of SCC and 0.038 shares of preferred stock of SCCII.

In conjunction with the AS Split-Off, SCC and SCCII amended all outstanding share-based awards to comply with the existing anti-dilution provisions in the Plan and respective share-based award agreements. The anti-dilution provisions require modification of the share-based awards in certain circumstances in order to prevent enlargement or dilution of benefits intended to be made available under the Plan.

To comply with the requirement of the Plan, all outstanding options and other long-term incentive equity awards were modified to (i) maintain the ratio of the exercise or base price to the fair market value of the stock prior to the modification and (ii) increase the quantity granted to maintain the intrinsic value of the awards based on the Unit price and the SpinCo share price, as applicable. In addition, all outstanding share-based awards were modified such that employees remaining with SunGard would hold awards in SunGard only and employees of AS would hold awards in SpinCo only. In order to achieve this result, all outstanding awards held by employees of AS were converted immediately prior to the AS Split-Off into SpinCo Awards. There was no incremental stock-based compensation expense as a result of these modifications.

Time-based options and RSUs granted generally vest over four or five years with monthly or annual vesting depending on the timing of the grant. Performance-based options and RSUs are earned upon the attainment of certain annual earnings goals based on Adjusted EBITA (defined as operating income before amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets, stock compensation expense and certain other items) or Adjusted EBITDA (defined as operating income before amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets, stock compensation expense, depreciation and certain other items) targets for the Company, depending on the date of grant, during a specified performance period. For awards granted prior to May 2011, there were generally five annual performance periods, of which 2014 was the last performance period included. For awards granted after May 2011, the performance period is generally 12 months at the end of which a portion of what was earned vests and the remainder of what was earned vests monthly or annually generally over three years. Time-based and performance-based options can partially or fully vest upon a change of control and certain other termination events, subject to certain conditions, and expire ten years from the date of grant. Once vested, time-based and performance-based RSUs become payable in shares upon the first to occur of a change of control, separation from service without cause, or the date that is four or five years (ten years for certain performance-based RSUs) after the date of grant.

In 2013 and 2014, certain senior executives of the Company were granted long-term incentive equity awards (“Appreciation Units”) to be settled in stock. The Appreciation Units vesting terms are either market-based dependent upon the performance of the Company’s Unit price (“Performance-based”) or time-based. Performance-based Appreciation Units will vest only if the average value per Unit at each measurement date (as defined in the agreements) increases over a base Unit value specified in the agreements and may be subject to continued employment through June 1, 2017. Time-based Appreciation Units will vest in annual installments over a period of years as specified in the applicable award agreement, subject to continued employment. The Company determined the fair value of the Performance-based Appreciation Units using a Monte Carlo valuation model and will record the aggregate expense over the measurement period on a straight-line basis regardless of vesting, subject to continued employment, if applicable. Time-based Appreciation Units were valued using the Black-Scholes pricing model, and will be expensed over the service period on a straight-line basis.

In June 2014, in addition to granting RSUs subject to time-based vesting, the Company granted RSUs with market-based vesting dependent upon the performance of the Company’s Unit price in relation to predetermined Unit price thresholds (“Market-based”). Each threshold signifies a level of vesting with interpolation between levels. Vesting is subject to continued employment through June 1, 2017, the measurement date. The Company

 

92


Table of Contents

determined the fair value of the Market-based RSUs using a Monte Carlo valuation model and will record the aggregate expense of $26 million over the three-year service period on a straight-line basis regardless of vesting, subject to continued employment, as required by GAAP.

The total fair value of options that vested for 2012, 2013 and 2014 was $4 million, $2 million and $1 million, respectively. The total fair value of Appreciation Units that vested during 2013 and 2014 was $2 million and $1 million, respectively. The total fair value of RSUs that vested for the years 2012, 2013 and 2014 was $30 million, $41 million and $32 million, respectively. At December 31, 2013 and 2014, approximately 3.2 million and 3.1 million RSUs, respectively, were vested.

The assumptions used in valuing the Appreciation Units and the RSUs with market-based vesting follow:

 

     Year ended December 31, 2013     Year ended December 31, 2014  

Award type

   Appreciation Units     Appreciation Units     RSUs  

Vesting terms

     Market-based        Time-based        Market-based        Market-based   

Valuation model

     Monte-Carlo        Black-Scholes        Monte-Carlo        Monte-Carlo   

Weighted-average fair value on date of grant

   $ 5.45      $ 5.91      $ 6.51      $ 16.44   

Assumptions used to calculate fair value:

        

Volatility

     38     38     45     45

Risk-free interest rate

     0.8     0.8     0.9     0.8

Expected term

     4 years        4 years        3.2 years        3 years   

Dividends

     zero        zero        zero        zero   

Since the Company is not publicly traded, the Company utilizes equity valuations based on (a) stock market valuations of public companies in comparable businesses, (b) recent transactions involving comparable companies and (c) any other factors deemed relevant. The risk-free rate for periods within the contractual life of the Appreciation Unit or RSU is based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve in effect at the time of grant. Expected volatilities are based on implied volatilities from market comparisons of certain publicly traded companies and other factors. The expected term of Appreciation Units and Market-based RSUs granted is the term from grant date until distribution date.

For 2012, 2013 and 2014, the Company included stock compensation expense in the Statement of Comprehensive Income (Loss) as follows:

 

     2012      2013      2014  

Cost of sales and direct operating expenses

   $ 4       $ 5       $ 7   

Sales, marketing and administration

     23         29         30   

Product development and maintenance

     4         5         5   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Stock compensation expense—continuing operations

  31      39      42   

Stock compensation expense—discontinued operations

  7      7      2   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total stock compensation

$ 38    $ 46    $ 44   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

At December 31, 2014, there was approximately $1 million and $45 million of unearned non-cash stock-based compensation related to time-based options and RSUs, respectively, that the Company expects to record as expense over a weighted average of 1.9 and 3.0 years, respectively. Also, at December 31, 2014, there was approximately $15 million of unearned non-cash stock compensation related to Appreciation Units that the Company expects to record over 2.4 years. In addition, at December 31, 2014, there was approximately $0.2 million and $9 million of unearned non-cash stock-based compensation related to performance-based

 

93


Table of Contents

options and RSUs, respectively, that the Company could record as expense over a weighted average of 2.1 and 2.5 years, respectively, primarily depending on continued service. Included in the unrecognized expense related to performance award amounts above are approximately 39,000 option Units ($0.2 million) and 559,000 RSUs ($9 million) that were earned during 2012 through 2014, but that will vest monthly or annually during 2015 through 2017. For time-based options and RSUs, compensation expense is recorded on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period of four or five years. For performance-based options and RSUs, recognition of compensation expense starts when the achievement of financial performance goals becomes probable and is recorded over the remaining service period.

The following table summarizes option, RSU and Appreciation Unit activity during 2014:

 

    Units              
    Options
(in millions)
    Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price
    RSUs
(in millions)
    Weighted-
Average
Grant
Date
Fair Value
    Appreciation
Units
(in millions)
    Weighted-
Average
Base Unit
Value
    Class A
Options
(in millions)
    Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price
 

Outstanding at December 31, 2013

    14.8      $ 14.30        9.4      $ 20.59        4.6      $ 17.37        5.4      $ 1.72   

Granted

    —            3.1        19.09        0.5        17.44        —       

Exercised / released

    (0.9     8.69        (1.3     20.25        —            —       

Canceled

    (0.6     15.26        (1.5     17.62        (0.5     17.34        (1.7     1.40   

Impact of SunGard awards modified

    0.6        n/a        0.9        n/a        0.5        n/a        —       

Impact of SpinCo awards modified

    (1.8     14.41        (1.6     20.56        —            —       
 

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Outstanding at December 31, 2014

    12.1        13.08        9.0        18.67        5.1        16.58        3.7        1.86   
 

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Included in the table above are 1.4 million option Units (weighted-average exercise price of $13.43), 0.5 million RSUs (weighted-average grant-date fair value of $19.87) and 1.0 million Class A options (weighted-average exercise price of $1.82) that have not vested and for which the performance period has ended. These options and RSUs may be canceled in the future. Also, approximately 1.7 million of the RSUs granted in 2014 are subject to Market-based vesting and may vest of up to 200% of the quantity granted based upon the stock price on the measurement date.

Shares available for grant under the Plan at December 31, 2014 were approximately 27.9 million shares of Class A common stock and 2.7 million shares of Class L common stock of SunGard Capital Corp. and 0.8 million shares of preferred stock of SunGard Capital Corp. II.

The total intrinsic value of options exercised during the years 2012, 2013 and 2014 was $22 million, $4 million and $8 million, respectively.

Cash proceeds received by SCC, including proceeds received by SCCII, from exercise of stock options were $0.2 million in 2012. Cash proceeds received by SCCII from exercise of stock options were $0.04 million in 2012. Cash proceeds received by SCC and SCCII from exercise of stock options in 2013 was not material. Cash proceeds received by SCC, including proceeds received from SCCII, from purchases of stock were $0.5 million in 2014. Cash proceeds received by SCCII from purchases of stock were $0.2 million in 2014. No cash proceeds from exercise of stock options were received in 2014.

The tax benefit from options exercised during 2012, 2013 and 2014 was $7 million, $1 million and $3 million, respectively. The tax benefit from release of RSUs during each of 2012, 2013 and 2014 was $6 million. The tax benefit is realized by SCC since SCC files as a consolidated group which includes SCCII and SunGard.

 

94


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes information as of December 31, 2014 concerning options for Units, Appreciation Units and options for Class A shares that have vested and that are expected to vest in the future:

 

     Vested and Expected to Vest      Exercisable  

Exercise Price ($)

   Quantity
Outstanding
(in millions)
     Weighted-average
Remaining

Life (years)
     Aggregate
Intrinsic Value
(in millions)
     Quantity
(in millions)
     Weighted-average
Remaining

Life (years)
     Aggregate
Intrinsic Value
(in millions)
 

Option Units

                 

4.03

     0.21         0.2       $ 3         0.21         0.2       $ 3   

12.87-15.31

     10.04         0.9         39         9.94         0.9         39   

15.85-18.91

     0.37         5.4         —           0.33         5.2         —     

Appreciation Units

                 

14.89-15.96

     2.00         2.4         3         n/a         

Options for Class A shares

                 

0.21- 0.44

     1.00         4.9         —           0.98         4.9         —     

1.41

     0.17         3.9         —           0.17         3.9         —     

2.22-3.06

     1.50         3.3         —           1.50         3.3         —     

11. Savings Plans:

The Company and its subsidiaries maintain savings and other defined contribution plans. Certain of these plans generally provide that employee contributions are matched with cash contributions by the Company subject to certain limitations including a limitation on the Company’s contributions to 4% of the employee’s compensation. Total expense for continuing operations under these plans aggregated $43 million in 2012, $45 million in 2013 and $51 million in 2014.

12. Income Taxes:

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes for 2012, 2013 and 2014 consisted of the following (in millions):

 

     SCC     SCCII     SunGard  
     2012     2013     2014     2012     2013     2014     2012     2013     2014  

U.S. operations

   $ (154   $ (31   $ (363   $ (154   $ (30   $ (363   $ (154   $ (30   $ (362

Foreign operations

     62        102        98        62        102        98        62        102        98   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

$ (92 $ 71    $ (265 $ (92 $ 72    $ (265 $ (92 $ 72    $ (264
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

95


Table of Contents

The continuing operations provision (benefit) for income taxes for 2012, 2013 and 2014 consisted of the following (in millions):

 

     SCC     SCCII     SunGard  
     2012     2013     2014     2012     2013     2014     2012     2013     2014  

Current:

                  

Federal

   $ (21   $ 5      $ 1      $ (21   $ 5      $ 1      $ (20   $ 6      $ 2   

State

     4        9        4        4        9        4        4        9        4   

Foreign

     22        36        42        22        36        42        22        36        42   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current

  5      50      47      5      50      47      6      51      48   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred:

Federal

  (27   (13   (122   (27   (13   (122   (28   (14   (123

State

  1      —        33      1      —        33      1      —        33   

Foreign

  (28   (11   (15   (28   (11   (15   (28   (11   (15
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred

  (54   (24   (104   (54   (24   (104   (55   (25   (105
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

$ (49 $ 26    $ (57 $ (49 $ 26    $ (57 $ (49 $ 26    $ (57
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Differences between income tax expense (benefit) at the expected U.S. federal statutory income tax rate of 35% and the Company’s continuing operations reported income tax (benefit) expense and effective tax rate for 2012, 2013 and 2014 were as follows (in millions):

 

     SCC     SCCII     SunGard  
     2012     2013     2014     2012     2013     2014     2012     2013     2014  

Tax at federal statutory rate

   $ (32   $ 25      $ (93   $ (32   $ 25      $ (93   $ (32   $ 25      $ (93

State income taxes, net of federal benefit

     2        5        (10     2        5        (10     2        5        (10

Foreign taxes, net of U.S. foreign tax credit (1)

     (20     1        1        (20     1        1        (20     1        1   

Tax rate changes (2)

     7        (1     46        7        (1     46        7        (1     46   

Nondeductible expenses

     2        3        4        2        3        4        2        3        4   

Change in uncertain tax positions (3)

     10        1        2        10        1        2        10        1        2   

Research and development credit

     (1     (9     (6     (1     (9     (6     (1     (9     (6

Domestic Production Activities Deduction

     —          (1     (1     —          (1     (1     —          (1     (1

U.S. income taxes on non-U.S. unremitted earnings

     (20     4        (3     (20     4        (3     (20     4        (3

Other, net

     3        (2     3        3        (2     3        3        (2     3   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

$ (49 $ 26    $ (57 $ (49 $ 26    $ (57 $ (49 $ 26    $ (57
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effective income tax rate

  53   36   22   53   36   22   53   36   22
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Includes foreign taxes, dividends, utilization of foreign tax credits, and the rate differential between U.S. and foreign countries, and the change in foreign valuation allowance, as described in more detail below. Also includes $6 million, $4 million and $3 million in 2012, 2013 and 2014, respectively, related to benefits of tax holidays in Tunisia and India which expire in 2017 and 2024, respectively.
(2) Tax rate changes in 2014 includes an expense of $48 million due to changes in certain state deferred income tax rates, which are primarily driven by the change in the legal entity ownership of the SunGard trade name caused by the AS Split-Off.
(3) The change in uncertain tax positions recorded in continuing operations was an expense of $10 million, $1 million and $2 million in 2012, 2013 and 2014, respectively, which reflects the offsetting benefits recorded in prepaid expenses and other current assets and deferred income and other taxes on the balance sheet. The balance is recorded in discontinued operations.

 

96


Table of Contents

Deferred income taxes are recorded based upon differences between financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases and operating and tax credit carryforwards. Deferred income tax assets and liabilities at December 31, 2013 and 2014 consisted of the following (in millions):

 

    SCC     SCCII     SunGard  
    December 31,
2013
    December 31,
2014
    December 31,
2013
    December 31,
2014
    December 31,
2013
    December 31,
2014
 

Current:

           

Trade receivables and other current assets

  $ (2   $ —        $ (2   $ —        $ (2   $ —     

Accrued expenses, net

    28        17        28        17        28        17   

Tax credit carryforwards

    20        —          20        —          20        —     

Other current

    (11     (5     (11     (5     (11     (5
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current deferred income tax asset (liability)

  35      12      35      12      35      12   

Valuation allowance

  (5   (4   (5   (4   (5   (4

Net current deferred income tax asset (liability)

  30      8      30      8      30      8   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Less: amounts classified as related to discontinued operations

  (13   —        (13   —        (13   —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net current deferred income tax asset (liability)— continuing operations

$ 17    $ 8    $ 17    $ 8    $ 17    $ 8   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Long-term:

Property and equipment

$ 1    $ (2 $ 1    $ (2 $ 1    $ (2

Intangible assets

  (1,026   (596   (1,026   (596   (1,026   (596

Net operating loss carry-forwards

  98      71      98      71      98      71   

Stock compensation

  62      55      62      55      62      55   

U.S. income taxes on non-U.S. unremitted earnings

  (24   (13   (24   (13   (24   (13

Other non-current

  34      6      34      6      34      6   

Other, net

  (12   15      (12   15      (5   23   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total long-term deferred income tax liability

  (867   (464   (867   (464   (860   (456

Valuation allowance

  (62   (48   (62   (48   (62   (48
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net long-term deferred income tax liability

  (929   (512   (929   (512   (922   (504

Less: amounts classified as related to discontinued operations

  282      —        282      —        282      —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net long-term deferred income tax liability—continuing operations

$ (647 $ (512 $ (647 $ (512 $ (640 $ (504
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The deferred income tax assets and liabilities include amounts classified as related to discontinued operations on the face of the financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2013.

As of December 31, 2014 the Company has net operating loss carryforwards, the tax effect of which is $71 million, which consist of $12 million for U.S. federal income tax purposes, $17 million for U.S. state income tax purposes and $42 million for foreign income tax purposes. The tax benefit recorded for net operating losses, net

 

97


Table of Contents

of valuation allowance, is $30 million, which consists of $6 million for U.S. federal income tax purposes, $2 million for U.S. state income tax purposes and $22 million for foreign income tax purposes. These tax loss carryforwards expire through 2034 and utilization is limited in certain jurisdictions. Some foreign losses have indefinite carryforward periods.

The valuation allowances of $67 million and $52 million at December 31, 2013 and 2014, respectively, were primarily related to federal, state and foreign net operating loss carryforwards that, in the judgment of management, are not more-likely-than-not to be realized.

A reconciliation of the beginning and ending balance of the valuation allowance follows (in millions):

 

     Continuing
operations
     Discontinued
operations
    Total  

Balance at December 31, 2013

   $ 41       $ 26      $ 67   

Additions, net

     12         1        13   

Translation adjustments and other

     (1      (27 ) (1)      (28
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2014

$ 52    $ —      $ 52   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

(1) Translation adjustments and other for discontinued operations includes $27 million that was sold or removed as a result of the AS Split-Off in 2014.

In assessing the realizability of deferred tax assets, management considers whether it is more-likely-than-not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. The ultimate realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of future taxable income during the periods in which those temporary differences become deductible. Management considers the scheduled reversal of deferred tax liabilities (including the impact of available carryback and carryforward periods), projected future taxable income, and tax-planning strategies in making this assessment. In the fourth quarter of 2014 after weighing the positive and negative evidence required, the Company recorded a valuation allowance of $3 million against certain losses generated in France. These losses were larger than anticipated and exceeded the scheduled reversal of deferred tax liabilities. The tax benefit of the French losses totals $24 million at December 31, 2014 and have an indefinite carryover period. Based upon the level of historical taxable income, projections for future taxable income and the reversal of deferred tax liabilities over the periods in which the deferred tax assets are deductible, management believes it is more-likely-than-not that the Company will realize the benefits of these deductible differences, net of the existing valuation allowances at December 31, 2013 and 2014. The amount of the deferred tax asset considered realizable, however, could be reduced in the near term if estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are reduced or as the reversal of certain deferred tax liabilities continues.

A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of unrecognized tax benefits follows (in millions):

 

     2012      2013      2014  

Balance at beginning of year

   $ 22       $ 94       $ 99   

Additions for tax positions of prior years

     22         7         4   

Reductions for tax positions of prior years

     —           (5      (3

Additions for tax positions of current year

     50         3         7   

Settlements for tax positions of prior years

     —           —           (3
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance at end of year

$ 94    $ 99    $ 104   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

98


Table of Contents

As of December 31, 2014 the Company had unrecognized tax benefits and related accrued interest of approximately $104 million which, if recognized, would favorably affect the effective tax rate. Included in prepaid and other assets are amounts that would partially offset the impact on the effective tax rate. Increases in 2012 relate primarily to state income tax related matters. Included in the balance of unrecognized tax benefits is accrued interest and penalties, net of federal benefits of $4 million, $6 million and $8 million for 2012, 2013 and 2014, respectively. The Company recognizes interest and penalties in income tax expense.

As part of the AS Split-Off, SunGard entered into a tax sharing and disaffiliation agreement with AS that apportions responsibility for U.S. federal, state and local and foreign income and other taxes between the parties. See Note 15 for further information.

Tax years after 2006 remain open for examination by the Internal Revenue Service, although years 2007-2010 are effectively settled. The Internal Revenue Service recently completed its examination of tax years 2009 and 2010. In addition, French tax authorities have just begun an examination of the tax year 2012. SunGard entities in other jurisdictions are also under examination at December 31, 2014 and tax years after 2005 remain open for audit by various state, local and other foreign jurisdictions. The Company anticipates that it is reasonably possible that between $0 and $38 million of unrecognized tax benefits may be resolved within the next 12 months.

During the fourth quarter of 2012 as a result of debt refinancing activities, the Company reevaluated the earnings of all its foreign subsidiaries and those that could be expected to be permanently reinvested outside the U.S. The Company determined that certain of its foreign subsidiaries earnings are permanently reinvested. The recognition of U.S. income tax is required when earnings of the foreign subsidiaries are not considered permanently reinvested outside the U.S. As of December 31, 2013 and 2014, the Company provided a deferred income tax liability of approximately $24 million and $13 million, respectively for non-U.S. withholding and U.S. income taxes associated with the future repatriation of earnings for certain non-U.S. subsidiaries. The Company has not provided deferred taxes on approximately $94 million of undistributed earnings of non-U.S. subsidiaries at December 31, 2014. Quantification of the related deferred tax liability, if any, associated with permanently reinvested earnings is not practicable.

13. Employee Termination Benefits and Facility Closures:

The following table provides a rollforward of the liability balances for workforce reductions and facility closures for 2012, 2013 and 2014 (in millions):

 

     Workforce-
related
    Facilities     Total  

Balance at December 31, 2011

   $ 24      $ 5      $ 29   

Expense related to 2012 actions

     34        12        46   

Paid

     (31     —          (31

Other adjustments (1)

     (4     —          (4
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2012

  23      17      40   

Expense related to 2013 actions

  20      2      22   

Paid

  (23   (3   (26

Other adjustments (1)

  (6   (1   (7
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2013

  14      15      29   

Expense related to 2014 actions

  28 (2)    4      32 (3) 

Paid

  (26   (6   (32

Other adjustments (1)

  (4   —        (4 )(3) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2014

$ 12    $ 13    $ 25   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) The other adjustments rows in the table principally relate to changes in estimates from when the initial charge was recorded and also foreign currency translation adjustments.

 

99


Table of Contents
(2) During the three months ended September 30, 2014, the Company recorded a $17 million severance charge related to a workforce reduction plan to reduce headcount by approximately 3% of the total workforce.
(3) The sum of the expense related to 2014 actions and other adjustments in 2014 is the net amount of expense related to employee termination benefits and facility closures and may include rounding (see Note 14).

The workforce related actions are expected to be paid out over the next 18 months (the majority within 12 months). The facilities accruals are for ongoing obligations to pay rent for vacant space and are net of sublease reserves. The lengths of these obligations vary by lease with the majority ending in 2019. The $13 million of facilities reserves is included in the future minimum rentals under operating leases (see Note 16).

14. Segment Information:

The Company has two reportable segments: FS and PS&E.

FS primarily serves financial services companies through a broad range of software solutions that process their investment and trading transactions. The principal purpose of most of these systems is to automate the many detailed processes associated with trading securities, managing investment portfolios and accounting for investment assets.

PS&E primarily provides software and processing solutions designed to meet the specialized needs of local, state and federal governments, public safety and justice agencies, public schools, utilities, non-profits and other public sector institutions.

In reporting our results, we categorize revenue into three categories:

 

    Software Revenue

 

    SAAS and Cloud Revenue

 

    Professional & Business Processing Services.

The Company evaluates the performance of its segments based on Adjusted EBITDA. Adjusted EBITDA, a non-GAAP measure, is defined as operating income before the following items:

 

    depreciation,

 

    amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets,

 

    trade name and goodwill impairment,

 

    severance and facility closure charges,

 

    stock compensation,

 

    management fees, and

 

    certain other costs.

While these charges may be recurring, management excludes them in order to better analyze the segment results and evaluate the segment performance. This analysis is used extensively by management and is also used to communicate the segment results to the Company’s board of directors. In addition, management reviews Adjusted EBITDA on a constant currency basis, especially when comparing to the prior year results. While Adjusted EBITDA is useful for analysis purposes, it should not be considered as an alternative to the Company’s reported GAAP results. Also, Adjusted EBITDA may not be comparable to similarly titled measures used by other companies. Adjusted EBITDA is similar, but not identical, to adjusted EBITDA as defined in the Credit Agreement for purposes of SunGard’s debt covenants. The operating results apply to each of SCC, SCCII and SunGard unless otherwise noted.

 

100


Table of Contents

The operating results for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 for each segment follow (in millions):

 

     FS     PS&E     Sum of
Segments
 

Year Ended December 31, 2014

      

Revenue

   $ 2,592      $ 217      $ 2,809   

Adjusted EBITDA

     742        68        810   

Adjusted EBITDA margin

     28.6     31.1     28.8

Year over Year revenue change

     2     4     2

Year over Year Adjusted EBITDA change

     (1 )%      2     —  

Year Ended December 31, 2013

      

Revenue

   $ 2,551 (1)    $ 210      $ 2,761   

Adjusted EBITDA

     746 (1)      66        812   

Adjusted EBITDA margin

     29.2     31.6     29.4

Year over Year revenue change

     (2 )%      3     (2 )% 

Year over Year Adjusted EBITDA change

     3     —       2

Year Ended December 31, 2012

      

Revenue

   $ 2,604      $ 204      $ 2,808   

Adjusted EBITDA

     727        66        793   

Adjusted EBITDA margin

     27.9     32.5     28.2

Reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2012      2013      2014  

Adjusted EBITDA (sum of segments)

   $ 793       $ 812       $ 810   

Corporate

     (44      (46      (45

Depreciation (2)

     (96      (104      (107

Amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets

     (217      (182      (136

Trade name impairment charge

     —           —           (339

Severance and facility closure costs

     (42 )(3)       (17 )(4)       (27 )(5) 

Stock compensation expense

     (31      (39      (42

Management fees

     (9      (8      (9

Other costs (included in operating income)

     (6      (11      (18

Interest expense, net

     (359      (325      (290

Loss on extinguishment of debt

     (82      (6      (61

Other income (expense)

     1         (2      —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

$ (92 $ 72    $ (264
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Note: In 2013, SCC’s income from continuing operations before income taxes was $71 million. In 2014, SCC’s and SCCII’s income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes was $(265) million.

 

101


Table of Contents

Depreciation, amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets, total assets and capital expenditures by segment follow (in millions):

 

     FS      PS&E      Sum of
Segments
     Corporate
and other
adjustments
    Total  

Year Ended December 31, 2014

             

Depreciation (2)

   $ 95       $ 9       $ 104       $ 3      $ 107   

Amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets

     129         7         136         —          136   

Capital expenditures

     131         10         141         2        143   

Total assets

     6,225         833         7,058         (551 )(6)      6,507   

 

     FS      PS&E      Sum of
Segments
     Corporate
and other
adjustments
    Total  

Year Ended December 31, 2013

             

Depreciation (2)

   $ 95       $ 7       $ 102       $ 2      $ 104   

Amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets

     168         13         181         1        182   

Capital expenditures

     102         8         110         1        111   

Total assets

     5,956         780         6,736         3,038 (6)      9,774   

 

     FS      PS&E      Sum of
Segments
     Corporate      Total  

Year Ended December 31, 2012

              

Depreciation (2)

   $ 88       $ 7       $ 95       $ 1       $ 96   

Amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets

     199         17         216         1         217   

Capital expenditures

     88         7         95         2         97   

 

(1) SunGard received approximately $12 million in proceeds related to a bankruptcy claim assigned and sold to a third party in the third quarter of 2013. The claim related to a FS customer that filed for Chapter 11 bankruptcy in January 2013. The amount of the claim represented previously reserved revenue, which now has been recognized, and a termination charge related to the customer contract.
(2) Includes amortization of capitalized software.
(3) Includes $27 million, $2 million and $1 million of severance in FS, PS&E and corporate, respectively. Also includes $12 million of lease exit costs in FS.
(4) Includes $13 million and $1 million of severance in FS and corporate, respectively. Also includes $3 million of lease exit costs in FS.
(5) Includes $22 million and $1 million of severance in FS and PS&E, respectively. Also includes $4 million of lease exit costs in FS.
(6) Includes items that are eliminated in consolidation, trade name, deferred income taxes and the assets of the Company’s assets of discontinued operations.

 

102


Table of Contents

Geographic Presence

The Company transacts business and has operations globally. The Company’s revenue by customer location follows (in millions):

 

     Year ended December 31,  
     2012      2013      2014  

United States

   $ 1,733       $ 1,685       $ 1,712   

International:

        

United Kingdom

     171         170         182   

Continental Europe

     466         453         428   

Asia/Pacific

     253         261         280   

Canada

     89         85         90   

Other

     96         107         117   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Subtotal—International

  1,075      1,076      1,097   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ 2,808    $ 2,761    $ 2,809   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Company’s property and equipment by geographic location follows (in millions):

 

     December 31,
2013
     December 31,
2014
 

United States

   $ 92       $ 99   

International:

     

United Kingdom

     16         16   

Continental Europe

     17         15   

Canada

     1         —     

Asia/Pacific

     23         19   

Other

     3         3   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ 152    $ 152   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

15. Related Party Transactions:

Sponsor Transactions

SunGard is required to pay management fees to affiliates of the Sponsors in connection with management consulting services provided to SunGard and the Parent Companies. These services include financial, managerial and operational advice and implementation strategies for improving the operating, marketing and financial performance of SunGard and its subsidiaries. In March 2014, the Company and the Sponsors amended the management agreement to increase the management fee from 1% to 1.1% of quarterly Adjusted EBITDA for five of seven Sponsors and fixed payments of $50,000 per quarter for each of the two remaining Sponsors. Adjusted EBITDA is defined as earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization, and goodwill and trade name impairments, further adjusted to exclude unusual items and other adjustments as defined in the management agreement, which is consistent with the Credit Agreement. Management fees are payable quarterly in arrears. In addition, these affiliates of the Sponsors may be entitled to additional fees in connection with certain financing, acquisition, disposition and change in control transactions. For the years ended December 31, 2012, 2013 and 2014, SunGard recorded $9 million, $8 million and $9 million, respectively, relating to management fees in continuing operations in the statement of comprehensive income, of which $4 million and $3 million is included in other accrued expenses at December 31, 2013 and 2014, respectively. In addition, for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2013, SunGard recorded $23 million and $4 million, respectively, relating to management fees in discontinued operations in the statement of comprehensive income (loss).

 

103


Table of Contents

During 2012, Goldman Sachs & Co. and/or its respective affiliates received fees in connection with the March 2012 amendment and restatement of SunGard’s Credit Agreement, November 2012 Senior Subordinated Notes issuance and December 2012 amendment and restatement of SunGard’s Credit Agreement. In connection with these transactions, Goldman Sachs & Co. was paid approximately $3 million.

During 2013 and 2014, Goldman Sachs & Co. and/or its respective affiliates received fees of approximately $1 million and less than $1 million, respectively, in connection with the March 2013 and February 2014 amendments of SunGard’s Credit Agreement.

In addition to the amounts above, on March 31, 2014 the Company recorded approximately $15 million of management fees, which is included in income (loss) from discontinued operations, as provided in the Management Agreement for services rendered in connection with the issuance of the $1.025 billion SpinCo Term Loan and $425 million of SpinCo Notes. Also during the first quarter of 2014, the Company recorded approximately $1 million of management fees which is included in income (loss) from discontinued operations resulting from the sale of two FS businesses.

AS Transactions

In connection with the AS Split-Off, the following agreements, among others, were entered into on March 31, 2014:

(i) a Trademark License Agreement (the “Trademark License Agreement”) between a wholly-owned subsidiary of SunGard that owns the trademark “SunGard” and SpinCo. The Trademark License Agreement sets forth the terms under which SpinCo and its affiliates are permitted to use the mark “SUNGARD AVAILABILITY SERVICES.” During the first two years following the AS Split-Off, the use of the licensed mark is royalty free. In years 3 through 5, SpinCo will pay a royalty payment of 0.30% of their worldwide revenue, subject to certain exceptions. In years 6 and 7, the royalty will be reduced to 0.15% and 0.075%, respectively. Following year 7, SpinCo will have a perpetual, royalty-free license to use the mark going forward assuming they maintain compliance with the Trademark License Agreement;

(ii) a Transition Services Agreement (“TSA”) whereby SunGard agreed to provide certain transitional and administrative support services, including employee benefits services, to AS and AS agreed to provide transitional and administrative support services to SunGard generally for up to twelve months. At December 31, 2014, the Company had recorded approximately $2 million of accounts receivable from AS under the TSA;

(iii) a Global Master Services Agreement (“GMSA”) replaced the existing agreements under which AS provides certain availability services, managed services, and recovery services to SunGard. SunGard agreed to spend a minimum of approximately $66 million under the GMSA for the period from the AS Split-Off through March 31, 2016. For the nine months ended December 31, 2014, the Company incurred expenses of $25 million for services provided under the GMSA, substantially all of which is included in cost of sales and direct operating expenses in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income (loss). At December 31, 2014, the Company had recorded approximately $1 million of accounts receivable, $4 million of accounts payable, and a $1 million prepaid maintenance contract related to AS under the GMSA; and

(iv) a Tax Sharing and Disaffiliation Agreement (the “Agreement”) between the Company and SpinCo. Pursuant to the Agreement, the parties allocated responsibility for U.S. federal, state and local, and foreign income and other taxes relating to taxable periods before and after the AS Split-Off, and provided for computation and apportionment of tax liabilities and tax benefits between the parties. AS is generally responsible for all taxes attributable to the AS business for periods subsequent to the AS Split-Off and non-income related taxes attributable to the AS business for any taxable period before and after the date of the AS Split-Off. The Company retains responsibility for U.S. federal, state and local, and foreign income taxes for periods ending on or before the date of the AS Split-Off and has recorded a related $3 million liability payable to AS at December 31, 2014.

 

104


Table of Contents

In addition, during the nine months ended December 31, 2014, AS purchased certain data center outsourcing services and treasury products from FS, for which FS recognized approximately $2 million of revenue.

16. Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees:

The Company leases a substantial portion of its computer equipment and facilities under operating leases. The Company’s leases are generally non-cancelable or cancelable only upon payment of cancellation fees. All lease payments are based on the passage of time, but include, in some cases, payments for insurance, maintenance and property taxes. There are no bargain purchase options on operating leases at favorable terms, but most facility leases have one or more renewal options and have either fixed or Consumer Price Index escalation clauses. Certain facility leases include an annual escalation for increases in utilities and property taxes. In addition, certain facility leases are subject to restoration clauses, whereby the facility may need to be restored to its original condition upon termination of the lease. There were a combined $10 million of restoration liabilities included in accrued expenses and other long term liabilities at December 31, 2014.

Future minimum rentals and sublease income under operating leases with initial or remaining non-cancelable lease terms in excess of one year for continuing operations at December 31, 2014 follow (in millions):

 

     Future minimum
rentals
     Future minimum
sublease rental
income
 

2015

   $ 62       $ 5   

2016

     56         5   

2017

     45         5   

2018

     33         4   

2019

     14         —     

Thereafter

     21         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 231    $ 19   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Rent expense from continuing operations aggregated to $69 million in 2012, $62 million in 2013 and $58 million in 2014. Sublease income was $3 million, $5 million and $6 million in 2012, 2013 and 2014, respectively. At December 31, 2014, the Company had unconditional purchase obligations of approximately $123 million which includes the amounts due under the GMSA (see Note 15) and $19 million of outstanding letters of credit and bid bonds issued primarily as security for performance under certain customer contracts.

In the event that the management agreement described in Note 15 is terminated by the Sponsors (or their affiliates) or SunGard and its Parent Companies, the Sponsors (or their affiliates) will receive a lump sum payment equal to the present value of the annual management fees that would have been payable for the remainder of the term of the management agreement. The initial term of the management agreement is ten years, and it extends annually for one year unless the Sponsors (or their affiliates) or SunGard and its Parent Companies provide notice to the other. The initial ten year term expires August 11, 2015.

The Company is presently a party to certain lawsuits arising in the ordinary course of its business. In the opinion of management, none of its current legal proceedings are expected to have a material impact on the Company’s business or financial results. The Company’s customer contracts generally include typical indemnification of customers, primarily for intellectual property infringement claims. Liabilities in connection with such obligations have not been material.

The Company has had patent infringement lawsuits filed against it or certain of its customers claiming that certain of its products infringe the intellectual property rights of others. Adverse results in these lawsuits may include awards of substantial monetary damages, costly royalty or licensing agreements, or limitations on the Company’s ability to offer certain features, functionalities, products, or services, and may also cause the

 

105


Table of Contents

Company to change its business practices, and require development of non-infringing products or technologies, which could result in a loss of revenues and otherwise harm the Company’s business. Also, certain agreements with previously owned businesses of the Company require indemnification to the new owners for certain matters as part of the sale of those businesses. At December 31, 2014, the Company does not have any significant accruals related to patent indemnification or infringement claims.

The Company evaluates, on a regular basis, developments in its legal matters. The Company records a provision for a liability when it believes that it is both probable that a liability has been incurred, and the amount can be reasonably estimated.

With respect to any current legal proceedings or claims pending against the Company for which it has not made an accrual, but for which it is reasonably possible that a loss may occur, the Company is unable to estimate a range of loss due to various reasons, including, among others: (1) that the proceedings are in early stages, (2) that there is uncertainty as to the outcome of pending appeals, motions, or settlements, (3) that there are significant factual issues to be resolved, and (4) that there are novel legal issues presented. Such legal matters are inherently unpredictable and subject to significant uncertainties, some of which are beyond the Company’s control. Based on current knowledge, the Company believes that the final outcome of the matters discussed above will not, individually or in the aggregate, have a material adverse effect on its business, consolidated financial position, results of operations, or cash flows. While the Company intends to vigorously defend these matters, in light of the uncertainties involved in such matters, there exists the possibility of adverse outcomes, and the final outcome of a particular matter could have a material adverse effect on results of operations or cash flows in a particular period.

The Company has recorded a reserve for unrecognized tax benefits and related accrued interest for certain matters. Also, the Company is under examination in various federal, state and local and foreign jurisdictions related to income and non-income tax matters. Based on current knowledge, the Company believes that resolution of these matters, giving recognition to the reserve for unrecognized tax benefits, will not have a materially adverse impact on its business, consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

The State of Delaware, Department of Finance, Division of Revenue (Unclaimed Property) and nine other states are currently conducting a joint examination of the books and records of certain wholly owned subsidiaries of the Company to determine compliance with the unclaimed property laws. Additionally, the Company has entered into voluntary disclosure agreements to address the potential unclaimed property exposure for certain entities not included in the scope of the ongoing unclaimed property examination. The potential exposure related to the examination and the voluntary disclosure programs is not currently determinable.

 

106


Table of Contents

17. Quarterly Financial Data (unaudited):

 

     First
Quarter
    Second
Quarter
    Third
Quarter
    Fourth
Quarter
 

2013

        

Revenue

   $ 639      $ 672      $ 678      $ 772   

Gross profit (excluding items described in Note 1) (1)

     372        414        427        503   

Income (loss) before income taxes (SCC)

     (52     10 (2)      29 (2)(3)      84 (2) 

Income (loss) before income taxes (SunGard and SCCII)

     (52     10 (2)      29 (2)(3)      85 (2) 

Income (loss) from continuing operations (SCC)

     (35     5 (2)      22 (2)(3)      53 (2) 

Income (loss) from continuing operations (SunGard and SCCII)

     (35     5 (2)      22 (2)(3)      54 (2) 

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

     (12     10        1        18   

Net income (loss) (SCC)

     (47     15 (2)      23 (2)(3)      71 (2) 

Net income (loss) (SunGard and SCCII)

     (47     15 (2)      23 (2)(3)      72 (2) 

Net income (loss) attributable to SCC

     (72     (32 )(2)      (26 )(2)(3)      23 (2) 

2014

        

Revenue

   $ 653      $ 673      $ 691      $ 792   

Gross profit (excluding items described in Note 1) (1)

     384        400        411        516   

Income (loss) before income taxes (SCC and SCCII)

     (424 )(4)      5        22 (5)      132   

Income (loss) before income taxes (SunGard)

     (424 )(4)      5        22 (5)      133   

Income (loss) from continuing operations (SCC and SCCII)

     (323 )(4)      3        11 (5)      101   

Income (loss) from continuing operations (SunGard)

     (323 )(4)      3        11 (5)      102   

Income (loss) from discontinued operations (SCC and SCCII)

     (17     —          —          3   

Income (loss) from discontinued operations (SunGard)

     (17     —          —          —     

Net income (loss) (SCC and SCCII)

     (340 )(4)      3        11 (5)      104   

Net income (loss) (SunGard)

     (340 )(4)      3        11 (5)      102   

Net income (loss) attributable to SCC

     (390 )(4)      (37     (31 )(5)      62   

 

(1) Gross profit equals revenue less cost of sales and direct operating expenses.
(2) During the second quarter of 2013, the Company completed a review of its accounting practices related to vacation pay obligations. In countries where the vacation policy stipulated that vacation days earned in the current year must be used in that same year, the Company adjusted its quarterly estimate of accrued vacation costs to better match expense recognition with amounts payable to employees when leaving the Company. The impact of the change in estimate was an aggregate decrease to costs and expenses of $10 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2013. The impact of this change was negligible for the full year since the balance would have naturally reversed, with a substantial majority of that reversal occurring during the fourth quarter.
(3) SunGard received approximately $12 million in proceeds related to a bankruptcy claim assigned and sold to a third party in the third quarter of 2013. The claim related to an FS customer that filed for Chapter 11 bankruptcy in January 2013. The amount of the claim represented previously reserved revenue, which now has been recognized, and a termination charge related to the customer contract.
(4) Includes a $339 million impairment charge of the trade name asset (see Note 1 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements) and a $61 million loss on extinguishment of debt (see Note 5 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements).
(5) During the three months ended September 30, 2014, the Company recorded a $17 million severance charge related to a workforce reduction plan to reduce headcount by approximately 3% of the total workforce.

All of the previously-issued interim financial statements included in Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q for 2014 included an error in the Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) related to the removal of the cumulative foreign currency translation loss associated with the AS businesses that were split-off on March 31, 2014. The removal of the cumulative foreign currency translation loss was reflected in both the Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) and the rollforwards of stockholders’ equity included in the notes to the condensed consolidated financial statements in each of the Quarterly Reports. However, the inclusion of this item in the 2014 Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) was not appropriate since it relates to the distribution of the AS businesses to our owners and should have been excluded from the 2014 Other

 

107


Table of Contents

Comprehensive Income according to GAAP. Management does not believe the error is material to any of the previously-issued financial statements. The table below shows the impact of the correction of this error for each period. These revisions will also be reflected in the Company’s 2015 quarterly filings.

The following table presents the amounts as originally reported and as revised for each of SCC, SCCII and SunGard (in millions):

 

     Three Months Ended
March 31, 2014
    Six Months Ended
June 30, 2014
    Nine Months Ended
September 30, 2014
 
     As
reported
    As revised     As
reported
    As revised     As
reported
    As revised  

Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

   $ (57   $ 25      $ (63   $ 19      $ (110   $ (35

Comprehensive Income (Loss)

     (397     (315     (400     (318     (436     (361

Comprehensive Income (Loss) attributable to SunGard Capital Corp. (SCC only)

     (447     (365     (490     (408     (568     (493

18. Supplemental Cash Flow Information:

Supplemental cash flow information for 2012, 2013 and 2014 follows (in millions):

 

     Year ended December 31,  
     2012     2013      2014  

Supplemental information:

       

Acquired businesses:

       

Property and equipment

   $ —        $ —         $ —     

Software products

     12        1         3   

Customer base

     12        —           1   

Goodwill

     28        1         —     

Other assets

     1        —           —     

Deferred income taxes

     (3     —           —     

Purchase price obligations and debt assumed

     1        —           —     

Net current assets (liabilities) assumed

     (11     —           —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash paid for acquired businesses, net of cash acquired of $2 million and $- million and $- million, respectively

$ 40    $ 2    $ 4   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

19. Supplemental Guarantor Condensed Consolidating Financial Statements:

SunGard’s senior unsecured notes are jointly and severally, fully and unconditionally guaranteed on a senior unsecured basis and the senior subordinated notes are jointly and severally, fully and unconditionally guaranteed on an unsecured senior subordinated basis, in each case, subject to certain exceptions, by substantially all wholly owned, domestic subsidiaries of SunGard (collectively, the “Guarantors”). Each of the Guarantors is 100% owned, directly or indirectly, by SunGard. None of the other subsidiaries of SunGard, either direct or indirect, nor any of the Holding Companies, guarantee the senior notes and senior subordinated notes (“Non-Guarantors”). The Guarantors and SunGard Holdco LLC also unconditionally guarantee the senior secured credit facilities, described in Note 5. The Guarantors are subject to release under certain circumstances as described below.

The indentures evidencing the guarantees provide for a Guarantor to be automatically and unconditionally released and discharged from its guarantee obligations in certain circumstances, including upon the earliest to occur of:

 

    The sale, exchange or transfer of the subsidiary’s capital stock or all or substantially all of its assets;

 

    Designation of the Guarantor as an “unrestricted subsidiary” for purposes of the indenture covenants;

 

    Release or discharge of the Guarantor’s guarantee of certain other indebtedness; or

 

    Legal defeasance or covenant defeasance of the indenture obligations when provision has been made for them to be fully satisfied.

 

108


Table of Contents

As a result of the AS Split-Off, all U.S. subsidiaries of AS were removed as guarantors as of March 31, 2014.

The following tables present the financial position, results of operations and cash flows of SunGard (referred to as “Parent Company” for purposes of this note only), the Guarantor subsidiaries, the Non-Guarantor subsidiaries and Eliminations as of December 31, 2013 and 2014, and for the years ended December 31, 2012, 2013 and 2014 to arrive at the information for SunGard on a consolidated basis. SCC and SCCII are neither parties to nor guarantors of the debt issued as described in Note 5.

 

     Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Balance Sheet

December 31, 2013

 

(in millions)

   Parent
Company
    Guarantor
Subsidiaries (c)
    Non-
Guarantor
Subsidiaries
     Eliminations     Consolidated  

Assets

           

Current:

           

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 403      $ 4      $ 268       $ —        $ 675   

Intercompany balances

     —          3,078        715         (3,793     —     

Trade receivables, net

     7        399 (a)      251         —          657   

Prepaid expenses, taxes and other current assets

     1,455 (b)      39        46         (1,417 )(b)      123   

Assets of discontinued operations

     18        1,719        790         (11     2,516   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

  1,883      5,239      2,070      (5,221   3,971   

Property and equipment, net

  —        88      64      —        152   

Intangible assets, net

  105      1,427      291      —        1,823   

Deferred income taxes

  30      —        —        (30   —     

Intercompany balances

  220      5      98      (323   —     

Goodwill

  —        3,097      731      —        3,828   

Investment in subsidiaries

  8,826      2,081      —        (10,907   —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Assets

$ 11,064    $ 11,937    $ 3,254    $ (16,481 $ 9,774   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities and Stockholder’s Equity

Current:

Short-term and current portion of long-term debt

$ 286    $ —      $ 4    $ —      $ 290   

Intercompany balances

  3,793      —        —        (3,793   —     

Accounts payable and other current liabilities

  71      1,917 (b)    438      (1,417 )(b)    1,009   

Liabilities of discontinued operations

  —        565      245      (11   799   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

  4,150      2,482      687      (5,221   2,098   

Long-term debt

  5,894      —        200      —        6,094   

Intercompany debt

  103      —        220      (323   —     

Deferred and other income taxes

  96      622      51      (30   739   

Other liabilities

  —        7      15      —        22   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

  10,243      3,111      1,173      (5,574   8,953   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total stockholder’s equity

  821      8,826      2,081      (10,907   821   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Liabilities and Stockholder’s Equity

$ 11,064    $ 11,937    $ 3,254    $ (16,481 $ 9,774   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)

This balance is primarily comprised of a receivable from the Company’s Accounts Receivable Financing subsidiary, which is a non-Guarantor, resulting from the normal, recurring sale of accounts receivable under

 

109


Table of Contents
  the receivables facility. In a liquidation, the first $200 million (plus interest) of collections of accounts receivable sold to this subsidiary are due to the receivables facility lender. The remaining balance would be available for collection for the benefit of the Guarantors.
(b) The Company pushes down tax liabilities associated with the consolidated and combined filings in U.S. federal, state and local jursidictions from the Parent Company to its Gurantor Subsidiaries. As these intercompany balances have not been historically settled, this entry eliminates the accumulated Parent Company income tax receivable balance with Gurantor Subisidiaries’ income tax liability balance.
(c) The Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Balance Sheet for the Guarantor Subsidiaries for December 31, 2013 has been revised to present investment in subsidiaries related to discontinued operations within the investment in subsidiary caption. The portion of the Guarantor’s investment in subsidiary which related to discontinued operations had previously been presented separately in the assets of discontinued operations caption. While these revisions have no impact on the previously reported total assets of the Guarantor Subsidiaries, they resulted in the following changes to previously reported amounts. For the Guarantor Subsidiaries, assets of discontinued operations changed from $1,810 million to $1,719 million; total current assets changed from $5,330 million to $5,239 million; and investment in subsidiaries changed from $1,990 million to $2,081 million. These revisions had no impact on the consolidated results of the Company and were not material to the Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Balance Sheet for any period.

 

     Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Balance Sheet

December 31, 2014

 

(in millions)

   Parent
Company
    Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Non-
Guarantor
Subsidiaries
     Eliminations     Consolidated  

Assets

           

Current:

           

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 202      $ 1      $ 244       $ —        $ 447   

Intercompany balances

     —          3,049        500         (3,549     —     

Trade receivables, net

     1        446 (a)      239         —          686   

Prepaid expenses, taxes and other current assets

     32 (b)      43        39         (2 )(b)      112   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

  235      3,539      1,022      (3,551   1,245   

Property and equipment, net

  —        94      58      —        152   

Intangible assets, net

  68      348      262      —        678   

Trade name

  —        672      —        —        672   

Deferred income taxes

  69      —        —        (69   —     

Intercompany balances

  194      8      154      (356   —     

Goodwill

  —        3,099      661      —        3,760   

Investment in subsidiaries

  8,039      1,366      —        (9,405   —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Assets

$ 8,605    $ 9,126    $ 2,157    $ (13,381 $ 6,507   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities and Stockholder’s Equity

Current:

Short-term and current portion of long-term debt

$ —      $ —      $ —      $ —      $ —     

Intercompany balances

  3,549      —        —        (3,549   —     

Accounts payable and other current liabilities

  59      510 (b)    427      (2 )(b)    994   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

  3,608      510      427      (3,551   994   

Long-term debt

  4,529      —        140      —        4,669   

Intercompany debt

  162      —        194      (356   —     

Deferred and other income taxes

  101      559      17      (69   608   

Other liabilities

  —        18      13      —        31   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

  8,400      1,087      791      (3,976   6,302   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total stockholder’s equity

  205      8,039      1,366      (9,405   205   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Liabilities and Stockholder’s Equity

$ 8,605    $ 9,126    $ 2,157    $ (13,381 $ 6,507   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

110


Table of Contents

 

(a) This balance is primarily comprised of a receivable from the Company’s Accounts Receivable Financing subsidiary, which is a non-Guarantor, resulting from the normal, recurring sale of accounts receivable under the receivables facility. In a liquidation, the first $140 million (plus interest) of collections of accounts receivable sold to this subsidiary are due to the receivables facility lender. The remaining balance would be available for collection for the benefit of the Guarantors.
(b) The Company pushed down tax liabilities associated with the consolidated and combined filings in U.S. federal, state, and local jurisdictions. During the first quarter of 2014, the Parent Company and the Guarantor Subsidiaries decided to effect a non-cash settlement of the accumulated income tax receivable and payable balances in the amount of approximately $1.5 billion.

 

     Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Schedule of Comprehensive
Income

Year Ended December 31, 2012

 

(in millions)

   Parent
Company
    Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Non-
Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Eliminations     Consolidated  

Total revenue

   $ —        $ 1,936      $ 1,256      $ (384   $ 2,808   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Costs and expenses:

Cost of sales and administrative expenses

  69      1,430      1,032      (384   2,147   

Depreciation and amortization

  —        63      33      —        96   

Amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets

  1      165      51      —        217   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total costs and expenses

  70      1,658      1,116      (384   2,460   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

  (70   278      140      —        348   

Net interest income (expense)

  (331   —        (28   —        (359

Equity in earnings of unconsolidated subsidiary

  71      132      —        (203   —     

Other income (expense)

  (82   (1   2      —        (81
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

  (412   409      114      (203   (92

Benefit from (provision for) income taxes

  156      (96   (11   —        49   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  (256   313      103      (203   (43

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax

  190      (242   29      —        (23
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

$ (66 $ 71    $ 132    $ (203 $ (66
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss)

$ (23 $ 100    $ 157    $ (257 $ (23
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

111


Table of Contents
     Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Schedule of Comprehensive
Income

Year Ended December 31, 2013

 

(in millions)

   Parent
Company
    Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Non-
Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Eliminations     Consolidated  

Total revenue

   $ —        $ 1,908      $ 1,258      $ (405   $ 2,761   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Costs and expenses:

Cost of sales and administrative expenses

  77      1,401      997      (405   2,070   

Depreciation and amortization

  —        67      37      —        104   

Amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets

  1      134      47      —        182   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total costs and expenses

  78      1,602      1,081      (405   2,356   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

  (78   306      177      —        405   

Net interest income (expense)

  (300   —        (25   —        (325

Equity in earnings of unconsolidated subsidiary

  376      149      —        (525   —     

Other income (expense)

  (6   —        (2   —        (8
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

  (8   455      150      (525   72   

Benefit from (provision for) income taxes

  120      (96   (50   —        (26
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  112      359      100      (525   46   

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax

  (49   17      49      —        17   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

$ 63    $ 376    $ 149    $ (525 $ 63   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss)

$ 82    $ 386    $ 163    $ (549 $ 82   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

112


Table of Contents
     Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Schedule of Comprehensive
Income

Year Ended December 31, 2014

 

(in millions)

   Parent
Company
    Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Non-
Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Eliminations     Consolidated  

Total revenue

   $ —        $ 2,000      $ 1,265      $ (456   $ 2,809   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Costs and expenses:

Cost of sales and administrative expenses

  85      1,491      1,020      (456   2,140   

Depreciation and amortization

  —        66      41      —        107   

Amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets

  —        92      44      —        136   

Trade name impairment charge

  —        339      —        —        339   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total costs and expenses

  85      1,988      1,105      (456   2,722   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

  (85   12      160      —        87   

Net interest income (expense)

  (272   (1   (17   —        (290

Loss on extinguishment of debt

  (61   —        —        —        (61

Equity in earnings of unconsolidated subsidiary

  96      100      —        (196   —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

  (322   111      143      (196   (264

Benefit from (provision for) income taxes

  126      (22   (47   —        57   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  (196   89      96      (196   (207

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax

  (28   7      4      —        (17
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

$ (224 $ 96    $ 100    $ (196 $ (224
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss)

$ (297 $ 47    $ 48    $ (95 $ (297
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As discussed in Note 17, all of the previously-issued interim financial statements included in Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q for 2014 included an error in the Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) related to the removal of the cumulative foreign currency translation loss associated with the AS businesses that were split-off on March 31, 2014. The removal of the cumulative foreign currency translation loss was reflected in the 2014 Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Schedule of Comprehensive Income (Loss). However, the inclusion of this item was not appropriate since it relates to the distribution of the AS businesses to our owners and should have been excluded from the 2014 Other Comprehensive Income according to GAAP. Management does not believe the error is material to any of the previously-issued financial statements. The table below shows the impact of the correction of this error for each period. These revisions will also be reflected in the Company’s 2015 quarterly filings.

 

     Three Months Ended
March 31, 2014
    Six Months Ended
June 30, 2014
    Nine Months Ended
September 30, 2014
 
     As
originally
reported
    As
revised
    As
originally
reported
    As
revised
    As
originally
reported
    As
revised
 

Comprehensive Income- Parent

   $ (397   $ (315   $ (400   $ (318   $ (436   $ (361

Comprehensive Income- Guarantor

     (259     (226     (191     (158     (151     (118

Comprehensive Income- Non-Guarantor

     (23     26        9        58        (26     23   

Comprehensive Income-Eliminations

     282        200        182        100        177        95   

 

113


Table of Contents
     Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Schedule of Cash Flows

Year Ended December 31, 2012

 

(in millions)

   Parent
Company
    Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Non-
Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Eliminations     Consolidated  

Cash flow from operations:

          

Net income (loss)

   $ (66   $ 71      $ 132      $ (203   $ (66

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

     190        (242     29        —          (23
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  (256   313      103      (203   (43

Non cash adjustments

  61      77      65      203      406   

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

  (192   122      (6   —        (76
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from (used in) continuing operations

  (387   512      162      —        287   

Cash flow from (used in) discontinued operations

  (476   321      112      —        (43
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow (from (used in) operations (b) (c)

  (863   833      274      —        244   

Investment activities:

Intercompany transactions (a)

  2,432      (373   (288   (1,771   —     

Cash paid for property and equipment and software

  —        (31   (9   —        (40

Cash paid for property and equipment and software

  —        (67   (30   —        (97

Other investing activities

  (1   1      1      —        1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) continuing operations

  2,431      (470   (326   (1,771   (136

Cash provided by (used in) discontinued operations

  208      1,422      (33   —        1,597   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) investment activities

  2,639      952      (359   (1,771   1,461   

Financing activities:

Intercompany dividends of HE sale proceeds

  —        (1,771   —        1,771      —     

Net repayments of long-term debt

  (1,277   (1   50      —        (1,228

Premium paid to retire debt

  (48   —        —        —        (48

Dividends paid

  (724   —        —        —        (724

Other financing activities

  (36   —        —        —        (36
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) continuing operations

  (2,085   (1,772   50      1,771      (2,036

Cash provided by (used in) discontinued operations

  —        (1   (2   —        (3
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) financing activities

  (2,085   (1,773   48      1,771      (2,039

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash

  —        —        7      —        7   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

  (309   12      (30   —        (327

Beginning cash and cash equivalents (d)

  529      (15   359      —        873   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending cash and cash equivalents (d)

$ 220    $ (3 $ 329    $ —      $ 546   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)

The intercompany cash transactions reflected above within investment activities largely reflect cash dividends or the return of capital, including the cash dividend of $1.8 billion from Guarantor Subsidiaries to Parent in connection with the sale of our Higher Education business. Additionally, during 2012, the

 

114


Table of Contents
  company settled $2.5 billion of inter-company balances through a series of non-cash dividend and return of capital transactions. These settlements reduced inter-company payable or receivable balances between Parent Company and Guarantor Subsidiaries, with a related increase or decrease in investment in subsidiary or equity accounts and, therefore, these transactions are not reflected in the Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Schedule of Cash Flows presented above.
(b) The Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Schedule of Cash Flows for the year ended December 31, 2012 has been revised to correct the presentation of taxes paid and related intercompany transactions for the Parent Company, Guarantor Subsidiaries and Non-Guarantor Subsidiaries. While these revisions had no impact on the previously reported total cash flows of the Parent Company, Guarantor Subsidiaries or Non-Guarantor Subsidiaries, the corrections resulted in the following changes to previously reported amounts: For the Parent Company, cash flow from (used in) operations changed from $(881) million to $(863) million and cash provided by (used in) investment activities changed from $2,657 million to $2,639 million. For the Guarantor Subsidiaries, cash flow from (used in) operations changed from $847 million to $833 million and cash provided by (used in) investment activities changed from $938 million to $952 million. For the Non-Guarantor Subsidiaries, cash flow from (used in) operations changed from $278 million to $274 million and cash provided by (used in) investment activities changed from $(363) million to $(359) million. These revisions had no impact on the consolidated financial statements of the Company, the Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Balance Sheet, or the Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Schedule of Comprehensive Income.
(c) Cash flows from (used in) operations for the Parent Company and Guarantor Subsidiaries do not include any amounts related to their stand-alone income tax liabilities as the Company has not historically cash settled the intercompany balances associated with the push down of such liabilities to the Guarantor Subsidiaries. During the year ended December 31, 2012, the Parent Company allocated approximately $191 million of tax liabilities to its Guarantor Subsidiaries.
(d) Includes cash of discontinued operations.

 

115


Table of Contents
     Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Schedule of Cash Flows

Year Ended December 31, 2013

 

(in millions)

   Parent
Company
    Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Non-
Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Eliminations     Consolidated  

Cash flow from operations:

          

Net income (loss)

   $ 63      $ 376      $ 149      $ (525   $ 63   

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

     (49     17        49        —          17   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  112      359      100      (525   46   

Non cash adjustments

  (304   39      84      525      344   

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

  (104   121      15      —        32   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from (used in) continuing operations

  (296   519      199      —        422   

Cash flow from (used in) discontinued operations

  (97   289      132      —        324   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from (used in) operations (b)

  (393   808      331      —        746   

Investment activities:

Intercompany transactions (a)

  667      (262   (53   (352   —     

Cash paid for acquired businesses, net of cash acquired

  —        (2   —        —        (2

Cash paid for property and equipment and software

  —        (73   (38   —        (111

Other investing activities

  —        —        1      —        1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) continuing operations

  667      (337   (90   (352   (112

Cash provided by (used in) discontinued operations

  183      (289   (40   —        (146
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) investment activities

  850      (626   (130   (352   (258

Financing activities:

Intercompany dividends

  —        (120   (120   240      —     

Net repayments of long-term debt

  (253   —        (51   —        (304

Dividends paid

  (3   —        —        —        (3

Other financing activities

  (18   —        —        —        (18
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) continuing operations

  (274   (120   (171   240      (325

Cash provided by (used in) discontinued operations

  —        (57   (57   112      (2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) financing activities

  (274   (177   (228   352      (327

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash

  —        —        (1   —        (1
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

  183      5      (28   —        160   

Beginning cash and cash equivalents (c)

  220      (3   329      —        546   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending cash and cash equivalents (c)

$ 403    $ 2    $ 301    $ —      $ 706   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) The intercompany cash transactions reflected above within investment activities largely reflect cash dividends or the return of capital.
(b) Cash flows from (used in) operations for the Parent Company and Guarantor Subsidiaries do not include any amounts related to their stand-alone income tax liabilities as the Company has not historically cash settled the intercompany balances associated with the push down of such liabilities to the Guarantor Subsidiaries. During the year ended December 31, 2013, the Parent Company allocated approximately $164 million of tax liabilities to its Guarantor Subsidiaries
(c) Includes cash of discontinued operations.

 

116


Table of Contents
    Supplemental Condensed Consolidating Schedule of Cash Flows

Year Ended December 31, 2014

 

(in millions)

  Parent
Company
    Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Non-
Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Eliminations     Consolidated  

Cash flow from operations:

         

Net income (loss)

  $ (224   $ 96      $ 100      $ (196   $ (224

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

    (28     7        4        —          (17
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  (196   89      96      (196   (207

Non cash adjustments

  19      302      81      196      598   

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

  (124   85      (20   —        (59
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from (used in) continuing operations

  (301   476      157      —        332   

Cash flow from (used in) discontinued operations

  (44   52      25      —        33   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from (used in) operations (a)

  (345   528      182      —        365   

Investment activities:

Intercompany transactions (c)

  396      (249   5      (152   —     

Cash paid for acquired businesses, net of cash acquired

  —        (4   —        —        (4

Cash paid for property and equipment and software

  (2   (89   (52   —        (143

Other investing activities

  —        —        —        —        —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) continuing operations

  394      (342   (47   (152   (147

Cash provided by (used in) discontinued operations

  1,041      (41   (993   —        7   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) investment activities

  1,435      (383   (1,040   (152   (140

Financing activities:

Intercompany dividends

  —        (66   (66   132      —     

Intercompany debt borrowings (repayments)

  —        —        (20   20      —     

Net repayments of long-term debt

  (1,269   —        (64   —        (1,333

Other financing activities

  (22   —        —        —        (22
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) continuing operations

  (1,291   (66   (150   152      (1,355

Cash provided by (used in) discontinued operations

  —        (80   967      —        887   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) financing activities

  (1,291   (146   817      152      (468

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash

  —        —        (16   —        (16
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

  (201   (1   (57   —        (259

Beginning cash and cash equivalents (b)

  403      2      301      —        706   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending cash and cash equivalents

$ 202    $ 1    $ 244    $ —      $ 447   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Cash flows from (used in) operations for the Parent Company and Guarantor Subsidiaries do not include any amounts related to their respective stand-alone income tax liabilities as the Company has not historically cash settled the intercompany balances associated with the push down of such liabilities to the Guarantor Subsidiaries.

 

     During 2014, the Parent Company allocated approximately $145 million of tax liabilities to its Guarantor Subsidiaries. During the first quarter of 2014, the Parent Company and the Guarantor Subsidiaries decided to effect a non-cash settlement of the accumulated income tax receivable and payable balances in the amount of approximately $1.5 billion. Therefore, these transactions are not reflected in the Condensed Consolidating Statement of Cash Flows presented above.

 

(b) Includes cash of discontinued operations.

 

(c) In the fourth quarter of 2014, the Company went through a process to dissolve or merge eight legal entities. As a result, approximately $179 million of intercompany balances between the Parent and Non-Guarantor were settled through non-cash transactions.

 

117


Table of Contents
ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

None.

 

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

 

(a) Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

Our management, with the participation of our chief executive officer and chief financial officer, evaluated the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures, as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Exchange Act as of the end of the period covered by this Report. Based on that evaluation, the chief executive officer and chief financial officer concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures as of the end of the period covered by this Report were effective.

 

(b) Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Exchange Act. Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of SunGard Capital Corp., SunGard Capital Corp. II and SunGard Data Systems Inc. (the “Companies”) financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with policies and procedures may deteriorate.

Management conducted an assessment of the Companies’ internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014 based on the criteria established by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013). Based on the assessment, management concluded that, as of December 31, 2014, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting is effective.

The effectiveness of the Companies’ internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014 has been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their reports with respect to the Company which appear herein.

 

(c) Change in Internal Control over Financial Reporting

No change in our internal control over financial reporting occurred during our most recent fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

 

ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION

Disclosure of Iranian Activities under Section 13(r) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

Because of the broad definition of “affiliate” in Rule 12b-2 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, certain of our Sponsors and the companies in which their affiliated funds are invested (“portfolio companies”) may be deemed to be affiliates of ours. Accordingly, we note that an affiliate of one of our Sponsors, The Blackstone Group L.P., has included information in its Annual Report on Form 10-K, as required by Section 13(r) of the Exchange Act, regarding activities of its portfolio companies. These disclosures are reproduced on Exhibit 99.1 of this report, which disclosures are hereby incorporated by reference herein. We have no involvement in or control over such activities, and we have not independently verified or participated in the preparation of the disclosures described in that filing. To the extent any of our Sponsors make additional disclosures under Section 13(r), we will provide updates in our subsequent periodic filings.

 

118


Table of Contents

PART III

 

ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Our executive officers and directors are listed below.

 

Name

  Age    

Principal Position with SunGard Data Systems Inc.

Executive Officers

   

Christopher P. Breakiron

    48      Vice President and Chief Accounting Officer

Marianne C. Brown

    56      Chief Operating Officer, Financial Systems

Patricia K. Cassidy

    49      Senior Vice President—Human Resources and Chief Human Resources Officer

Vincent R. Coppola

    58      Senior Vice President, Global Business Services and Technology

Russell P. Fradin

    59      President, Chief Executive Officer and Director

Kevin J. McCurry

    47      Senior Vice President—Corporate Development and Strategy

Charles J. Neral

    56      Senior Vice President—Finance and Chief Financial Officer

Victoria E. Silbey

    51      Senior Vice President—Legal and Chief Legal Officer

Brian A. Traquair

    58      Executive Vice President, Financial Systems

Directors

   

Glenn H. Hutchins

    59      Chairman of the Board of Directors

David L. Johnson

    61      Director

Ian K. Loring

    48      Director

John W. Marren

    52      Director

Sanjeev K. Mehra

    56      Director

R. Davis Noell

    36      Director

John I. Park

    32      Director

Mr. Breakiron has been Vice President and Chief Accounting Officer since February 2014. From 2008 to 2013, Mr. Breakiron was Senior Vice President and Chief Accounting Officer of Lender Processing Services, Inc., a leading provider of mortgage processing services, settlement services, mortgage performance analytics and outsourcing services for financial institutions, mortgage companies and real estate professionals. From 2006 to 2008, Mr. Breakiron served as Senior Vice President of Financial Planning and Analysis for Fidelity National Information Services, a global provider of technology solutions, processing services and information-based services to the financial services industry. Before that, Mr. Breakiron worked as Senior Vice President and Controller of International Card Services for Certegy, Inc., a global payment services provider.

Ms. Brown has been Chief Operating Officer, Financial Systems since February 2014. Prior to joining SunGard, she was president and CEO of Omgeo, a global financial services technology company, from 2006 to February 2014, and before that, from 2005 to 2006, she was the CEO of the Securities Industry Automation Corporation (SIAC), a subsidiary of the NYSE Euronext Group. From 1978 to 2005, Ms. Brown held positions of increasing responsibility in various areas at Automatic Data Processing, Inc. (ADP), a provider of benefits and payroll processing services, culminating in her role as general manager of ADP’s Brokerage Processing Services business, which was subsequently spun off to become Broadridge Financial Solutions. Ms. Brown currently serves on the Board of Directors of Northrop Grumman Corporation.

Ms. Cassidy became Senior Vice President and Chief Human Resources Officer effective February 11, 2015 and was the head of Human Resources for FS North America from 2007 to 2015 and the global head of Human Resources for the Capital Markets organization from 2011 to 2015. From 2005 to 2007, Ms. Cassidy held various human resources positions with us. Prior to joining SunGard, from 1995 to 2005, Ms. Cassidy held human resources roles of increasing responsibility for DecisionOne Corporation (previously Bell Atlantic Business System Services), including vice president of Human Resources from 2003 to 2005.

Mr. Coppola has been Senior Vice President, Global Business Services and Technology since 2011 and Senior Vice President—Operations, Financial Systems from August to December 2011. Prior to joining

 

119


Table of Contents

SunGard, Mr. Coppola held senior positions at Hewitt Associates, a global provider of human resources consulting and outsourcing solutions, including as Global Chief Operating Officer, Consulting during 2010, and as Senior Vice President—Global Business Services & Technology from 2008 to 2010. From 1983 to 2007, he held various senior positions with Automatic Data Processing, Inc., a provider of benefits and payroll processing services.

Mr. Fradin has been Chief Executive Officer, President and a director since 2011. From 2010 to 2011, Mr. Fradin was chairman and chief executive officer of Aon Hewitt, a global provider of human resources consulting and outsourcing solutions and a business unit of Aon Corporation, and from 2006 to 2010, Mr. Fradin was chief executive officer of Hewitt Associates and oversaw its successful merger with Aon Corporation in September 2010. Prior to his time with Hewitt, Mr. Fradin was President and Chief Executive Officer from 2004 to 2006 of The BISYS Group, Inc., a provider of outsourcing solutions for the financial services sector, and from 1997 to 2004 he held various senior executive positions with Automatic Data Processing, Inc., a provider of benefits and payroll processing services. Mr. Fradin currently serves on the Board of Directors of Best Buy Co., Inc. and previously served from 2007 until July 2011 on the Board of Directors of Gartner Inc., a technology research firm.

Mr. McCurry has been Senior Vice President—Corporate Development and Strategy since January 2014. Prior to joining SunGard, from 2012 to January 2014, he was Senior Vice President, Corporate Development at Bertelsmann, a global media company. From 2005 to 2012, Mr. McCurry held various executive strategy roles of increasing responsibility, including head of strategy for the Scientific Business unit and Chief Strategy Officer for the Healthcare & Science business, at Thomson Reuters, a global business and professional information company.

Mr. Neral has been Senior Vice President—Finance and Chief Financial Officer since 2012. Prior to joining SunGard, Mr. Neral served as Senior Vice President & Chief Financial Officer from 2009 to 2012 at SafeNet, Inc., a cyber-security company. From 2004 to 2009 he served as Vice President, Finance of IBM’s worldwide software business and from 1981 to 2004 he served in a variety of financial roles across IBM’s Sales, Server and Global Services organizations, including executive roles in Asia Pacific and at IBM headquarters.

Ms. Silbey has been Senior Vice President—Legal since 2006, Chief Legal Officer since 2011, General Counsel from 2006 to 2011 and Vice President—Legal and General Counsel from 2005 to 2006. From 1997 to 2005, Ms. Silbey held various legal positions with us, including Vice President—Legal and Assistant General Counsel from 2004 to 2005. From 1991 to 1997, she was a lawyer with Morgan, Lewis & Bockius LLP. Ms. Silbey is a director and officer of most of our domestic and foreign subsidiaries.

Mr. Traquair has been Executive Vice President, Financial Systems since January 2014, President, Capital Markets Group from 2012 to January 2014, President, Capital Markets and Investment Banking from 2007 to 2011 and President, Securities Finance from 2001 to 2007. Mr. Traquair was in a management position at Loanet, a company we acquired in 2001, and prior to Loanet, he held various management positions at IP Sharp Associates, Reuters and Instinet.

Mr. Hutchins has been Chairman of the Boards of Directors since 2005. Mr. Hutchins is a co-founder of Silver Lake, a technology investment firm that was established in 1999, was Co-Chief Executive Officer until 2011 and was Managing Director from 1999 to 2012. Mr. Hutchins is also a director of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, Vice Chairman of the Brookings Institution and a Director of the Harvard Management Company, which is responsible for the University’s endowment. Previously, Mr. Hutchins served as a Special Advisor in the White House on economic and health-care policy from 1993 to 1994 and as Senior Advisor on the transition of the Administration from 1992 to 1993. Mr. Hutchins serves on the Board of Directors of AT&T and Nasdaq OMX.

Mr. Johnson has been a director since May 22, 2014. Mr. Johnson is a Senior Managing Director in the Private Equity Group of The Blackstone Group, which he joined in 2013. Before joining Blackstone,

 

120


Table of Contents

Mr. Johnson was Senior Vice President of Strategy at Dell Corporation from 2009 to 2013, where he was responsible for corporate strategy, corporate development and acquisition integration. From 1981 to 2009, Mr. Johnson held a number of positions, including Vice President of Corporate Development, at International Business Machines Corporation. Mr. Johnson currently serves on the Board of Directors of Accuvant, Inc. and Pactera Technology International Ltd.

Mr. Loring has been a director since July 16, 2014. Mr. Loring joined Bain Capital in 1996. He was promoted to Managing Director in 2000. Prior to joining Bain Capital, Mr. Loring was a Vice President at Berkshire Partners, where he worked in the specialty manufacturing, technology, and retail industries. Previously, Mr. Loring worked in the Corporate Finance department at Drexel Burnham Lambert. Mr. Loring currently serves on the Boards of Directors of BMC Software, iHeartMedia, Inc, The Weather Channel, NXP Semiconductors N.V., Denon & Marantz and Viewpoint. Mr. Loring previously served as a member of the Boards of Directors of Warner Music Group Corp. and SMTC Corporation.

Mr. Marren has been a Director since 2005. Mr. Marren joined TPG Capital, a private equity firm, in 2000 as a partner and leads the firm’s technology team. From 1996 to 2000, he was a Managing Director at Morgan Stanley. From 1992 to 1996, he was a Managing Director and Senior Semiconductor Research Analyst at Alex Brown & Sons. Mr. Marren currently serves on the Boards of Directors of Avaya Inc. and Freescale Semiconductor Inc. and previously served on the Boards of Directors of Alltel Corporation, Conexant Systems Inc., MEMC Electronic Materials, Inc. and ON Semiconductor Corporation.

Mr. Mehra has been a Director since 2005. Mr. Mehra serves as vice chairman of the global private equity business and has been a partner of Goldman, Sachs & Co. since 1998 and a Managing Director of Goldman, Sachs & Co.’s Principal Investment Area of its Merchant Banking Division since 1996. He currently serves on the Boards of Directors of ARAMARK Corporation, Interline Brands Inc., Max India Limited, Neovia Logistics Holding, Ltd., Sigma Electric and TVS Logistics Services Limited, and previously served on the Board of Directors of Burger King Holdings, Inc., First Aviation Services, Inc., Hawker Beechcraft, Inc, and KAR Auction Services, Inc.

Mr. Noell has been a Director since 2012. Mr. Noell is a Managing Director of Providence Equity L.L.C., an affiliate of the Providence Equity Funds. Prior to joining Providence in 2003, Mr. Noell was an analyst in Deutsche Bank’s media investment banking group. Mr. Noell currently serves on the Boards of Directors of Altegrity Inc., The Chernin Group, LLC, and World Triathlon Corporation, and previously served on the Board of Directors of eTelecare Global Solutions, Inc., GLM LLC and Stream Global Services, Inc.

Mr. Park has been a director since March 31, 2014. Mr. Park joined KKR in 2013 and is a member of the Technology Industry team. Prior to joining KKR, Mr. Park was with Apax Partners, a private equity investment group, from 2006 to 2013, where he focused on investments in technology, and before then he was a member of the mergers & acquisitions practice at Morgan Stanley from 2004 to 2006. Mr. Park currently serves on the Board of Directors of GoDaddy Inc.

The Second Amended and Restated Stockholders Agreement dated March 31, 2014, by and among the four parent companies, SunGard, the Sponsors and other stockholders, provides each Sponsor the right to nominate one director and to require each Sponsor to vote its shares to elect each Sponsor-designated nominee.

In accordance with the charter of the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee, to the extent consistent with applicable agreements, the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee will identify, recommend and recruit qualified candidates to fill new positions on the Boards and will conduct the appropriate and necessary inquiries into the backgrounds and qualifications of possible candidates.

As a group, the Sponsor directors possess experience in owning and managing enterprises like the Company and are familiar with corporate finance, strategic business planning activities and issues involving stakeholders

 

121


Table of Contents

more generally. All of the Company’s directors possess high ethical standards, act with integrity, and exercise careful, experienced judgment. Each is committed to employing their skills and abilities to aid the long-term interests of the stakeholders of the Company.

On May 31, 2011, in connection with becoming the chief executive officer and in accordance with his employment agreement, Russell P. Fradin was elected to serve as a director on the Boards.

On March 31, 2014, James H. Greene, Jr. resigned as a director on the Boards, and John Park was elected to serve on the Boards. Mr. Park was designated by certain funds associated with KKR. Mr. Park will not serve on any committee of the Boards.

On May 22, 2014, Martin Brand resigned as a director on the Boards, and David L. Johnson was elected to serve on the Boards. Mr. Johnson was designated by certain funds associated with The Blackstone Group. Mr. Johnson will serve on the Audit Committee, the Compensation Committee and the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee of the Boards.

On July 16, 2014, Christopher Gordon resigned as a director on the Boards, and Ian K. Loring was elected to serve on the Boards. Mr. Loring was designated by certain funds associated with Bain Capital Partners. Mr. Loring will not serve on any committee of the Boards.

The Boards have determined that Mr. Marren qualifies as an “audit committee financial expert” within the meaning of regulations adopted by the SEC. Mr. Marren may not be considered an independent director because of his affiliation with TPG, the affiliated funds of which hold a 13.52% equity interest in our Parent Companies.

Our Global Business Conduct and Compliance Program is applicable to our directors and employees, including the chief executive officer, chief financial officer and chief accounting officer. The Global Business Conduct and Compliance Program is available on our website at www.sungard.com/aboutsungard/corporateresponsibility/governance. A free copy of our Global Business Conduct and Compliance Program may be requested from: SunGard Data Systems Inc., attention Chief Compliance Officer, 680 East Swedesford Road, Wayne, PA 19087.

If we make any substantive amendments to the Global Business Conduct and Compliance Program which apply to our chief executive officer, chief financial officer or chief accounting officer or grant any waiver, including any implicit waiver, from a provision of the Global Business Conduct and Compliance Program to our directors or executive officers, we will disclose the nature of the amendment or waiver on our website at www.sungard.com/corporateresponsibility or in a report on Form 8-K.

Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance

Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act requires the Company’s officers and directors, and persons who own more than ten percent of a registered class of the Company’s equity securities, to file reports of securities ownership and changes in such ownership with the SEC. Officers, directors and greater than ten percent shareholders also are required by rules promulgated by the SEC to furnish the Company with copies of all Section 16(a) forms they file. Based solely upon a review of the copies of such forms furnished to the Company or written representations that all reportable transaction were reported, the Company believes that all Section 16(a) filing requirements were timely met during 2014.

 

ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

Compensation Discussion and Analysis

Executive Summary

This section discusses the principles underlying our executive compensation policies and decisions. It provides qualitative information regarding the manner in which compensation is earned by our executive officers

 

122


Table of Contents

and places in context the data presented in the tables that follow. In addition, in this section, we address the compensation paid or awarded during fiscal year 2014 to Russell P. Fradin, our President and Chief Executive Officer (our “CEO”), Charles J. Neral, our Senior Vice President-Finance and Chief Financial Officer, and Marianne Brown, Kevin J. McCurry and Brian A. Traquair, our three other most highly compensated executive officers in 2014. Collectively, we refer to these five executive officers as our “named executives” for 2014.

The primary focus of our compensation philosophy is to pay for performance. We believe our programs are effectively designed, align well with the interests of our stockholders and are instrumental to achieving our business strategy.

Highlighted below are some of the key aspects and decisions with respect to our executive compensation programs for fiscal 2014, as approved by the Compensation Committee:

 

    Our executive compensation is tightly linked with performance.

 

    The Compensation Committee approved executive incentive compensation (“EIC”) plans by which the named executives were eligible to earn cash incentive compensation based upon achievement of specific financial objectives for 2014 that were designed to challenge the named executives to perform highly. In 2014, EIC plans for the named executives included Adjusted EBITDA, revenue and sales targets as well as individual objectives in order to bring focus to both growth and planning for the future.

 

    Individual EIC bonuses were capped at 2.0 times the target EIC bonus for our senior executives.

 

    To further align the equity incentives of our executives with the interests of our stockholders, the Compensation Committee approved annual grants of restricted stock unit awards with the performance measure based on growth in the Company’s stock price over a three-year period.

 

    We evaluated risks associated with our compensation programs. As described below under the “Risk Considerations in Our Compensation Programs,” we concluded that our compensation policies and practices for 2014 did not create risks that were reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect on the Company.

Administration of Our Compensation Program

Our executive compensation program is overseen and administered by the Compensation Committee. The Compensation Committee operates under a written charter adopted by our Boards and has responsibility for discharging the responsibilities of the Boards relating to the compensation of the Company’s executive officers and related duties. Management, including our CEO, evaluates a number of factors in developing cash and equity compensation recommendations to the Compensation Committee for its consideration and approval. Following this review and in consultation with management, our CEO makes compensation recommendations for our executive officers, including the CEO, to the Compensation Committee based on his evaluation of each officer’s performance, expectations for the coming year and market compensation data. The Compensation Committee reviews these proposals and makes all final compensation decisions for these officers by exercising its discretion in accepting, modifying or rejecting any management recommendations, including any recommendations from our CEO.

Objectives of Our Compensation Program

Our executive compensation program is intended to meet three principal objectives:

 

    to provide competitive compensation packages to attract and retain superior executive talent;

 

    to reward successful performance by the executive and the Company by linking a significant portion of compensation to future financial and business results; and

 

    to further align the interests of executive officers with those of our ultimate stockholders by providing long-term equity compensation and meaningful equity ownership.

 

123


Table of Contents

To meet these objectives, our compensation program balances short-term and long-term performance goals and mixes fixed and at-risk compensation that is directly related to stockholder value and overall performance.

Our compensation program for senior executives, including the named executives, is designed to reward the executives based on Company and individual performance. The compensation program is intended to reinforce the importance of performance and accountability at various operational levels, and therefore a significant portion of total compensation is in both cash and stock-based compensation incentives that reward performance as measured against established goals, i.e., “pay for performance.” Each element of our compensation program is reviewed individually and considered collectively with the other elements of our compensation program. When making compensation decisions for the named executives, we consider each individual’s contributions to our overall results, our operating and financial performance compared with the targeted goals, and our size and complexity compared with companies in our compensation peer group.

Elements of Our Executive Compensation Program

In 2014, the principal elements of compensation for named executives were:

 

    annual cash compensation consisting of base salary and performance-based EIC bonuses;

 

    long-term equity incentive compensation;

 

    benefits and perquisites; and

 

    severance compensation and change of control protection.

Annual Cash Compensation

Management, including our CEO, develops recommendations for annual executive cash compensation plans with consideration of compensation survey data for a broad set of organizations of comparable business, size and complexity and publicly available compensation data for a group of companies we consider to be our peer group. We believe that the compensation practices of these companies provide us with appropriate benchmarks because they also provide technology products and services to a variety of customers and compete with us for executives and other employees.

The survey data used for 2014 compensation purposes came from two sources: Radford Global Technology Survey, which focuses on technology companies, and Towers Watson Survey Report on Top Management Compensation, which focuses on a broader array of organizations including professional services, high-tech and manufacturing companies. For purposes of establishing compensation recommendations, we used a blend of these surveys to reflect our size, industry and appropriateness of the position matched.

The companies we consider within our peer group are financial services and software companies of similar industry and revenue size as the Company, and some are competitors of the Company for business and for talent. No changes were made to the peer group list from 2013. Peer group compensation data is limited to publicly available information and therefore generally does not provide precise comparisons by position as offered by the more comprehensive survey data from other public surveys used in our broader analysis as described above. As a result, the peer group data provides limited guidance and does not dictate the setting of executive officers’ compensation. The following companies comprised our peer group in 2014:

 

Automatic Data Processing, Inc.

DST Systems, Inc. Symantec Corporation

Amdocs Limited

Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. The Western Union Company

Broadridge Financial Solutions, Inc.

First Data Corporation Thomson Reuters Corporation

CA, Inc.

Fiserv, Inc. VMWare, Inc.

CACI International Inc.

Intuit Inc.

Cognizant Technology Solutions Corporation

Iron Mountain Incorporated

 

124


Table of Contents

The Compensation Committee’s objective in looking at market and peer compensation is to assure relevance to market practices and support our objective of providing competitive compensation packages to attract and retain superior executive talent. The Compensation Committee does not target specific market percentiles of peer pay as an overall objective, but considers this information along with internal equity and other factors when making executive pay decisions.

Our annual cash compensation packages for executive officers include base salary and a target EIC bonus. The compensation of Ms. Brown and Mr. McCurry was based on the terms of the employment agreements entered into with each of them in connection with their commencement of employment in early 2014.

Base Salary. Base salaries provide fixed compensation that is not subject to performance risk and are determined for each named executive based on his or her position while also considering other factors, such as individual and Company performance. We review the base salaries for each named executive annually as well as at the time of any promotion or significant change in job responsibilities. Salary for each named executive for calendar year 2014 is reported in the “Summary Compensation Table” below. In 2014, Mr. Fradin did not receive a base salary compensation increase after review and determining that his existing salary was appropriate. Messrs. Neral and Traquair received base salary increases of 15% and 13%, respectively, to reflect increased responsibilities. The initial base salaries for Ms. Brown and Mr. McCurry were determined at the time of their hire in early 2014.

Performance-Based Incentive Compensation. The annual EIC bonus for executive officers is designed to reward our executives for the achievement of annual financial goals related to the business for which they have responsibility. A minimum incentive may be earned at threshold EIC goals, and no payment is awarded if the threshold goal is not achieved. On-target EIC goals are set at levels that reflect budgeted performance. Consistent with our focus on pay for performance, additional amounts can be earned when actual performance exceeds on-target performance. The Company may revise or cancel an executive’s EIC at any time as a result of a significant change in circumstances or the occurrence of an unusual event that was not anticipated when the EIC plan was approved. As applicable, targets are adjusted to take into account acquisitions and/or dispositions which were not included in the budgeted EIC targets and other one-time adjustments as approved by the Compensation Committee. Individual EIC bonuses are capped at 200% of the target EIC bonus for our executive officers.

The financial measures used for the 2014 EIC bonuses for the named executives were:

 

    Adjusted EBITDA, which represents operating income excluding depreciation, amortization of acquisition-related intangible assets, trade name and goodwill impairment charges, severance and facility closure charges, stock compensation, management fees and certain other costs.

 

    Revenue.

 

    Sales, which represents license, SaaS, cloud and professional services sales, whether new or recurring.

In whole, these metrics were selected as the most appropriate financial measures upon which to base the 2014 EIC bonuses for the named executives because they provide a balance of incentives to drive the long-term growth of the Company and are important metrics that management and the Boards use to evaluate the performance of the Company or a particular business. The targets are intended to be achievable, but challenging. Adjusted EBITDA, revenue and sales goals were weighted equally in 2014 for all of the named executives except Mr. McCurry. Revenue and sales over performance could only be earned by the named executives if threshold performance on Adjusted EBITDA was achieved.

 

125


Table of Contents

The following table provides the percentage of each component of the EIC bonuses.

 

Name and Goals*

   Performance Goal as
% Total Target Bonus
 

Russell P. Fradin and Charles J. Neral

  

SunGard Adjusted EBITDA

     25

SunGard Revenue

     25

Financial Systems Segment Sales

     25
  

 

 

 

Financial Objectives

  75

Individual Objectives

  25

Marianne Brown and Brian A. Traquair

Financial Systems Segment Adjusted EBITDA

  25

Financial Systems Segment Revenue

  25

Financial Systems Segment Sales

  25
  

 

 

 

Financial Objectives

  75

Individual Objectives

  25

Kevin J. McCurry

SunGard Adjusted EBITDA

  25

SunGard Revenue

  20

Financial Systems Segment Sales

  20
  

 

 

 

Financial Objectives

  65

Individual Objectives

  35

 

  * SunGard goals exclude first quarter 2014 results of Availability Services prior to the Split-Off.

For the corporate named executive officers, Messrs. Fradin, Neral and McCurry, the 2014 EIC components allowed for potential payouts of between 0% and 200% of target amounts if we achieved or exceeded the following financial objectives during 2014: (i) SunGard Adjusted EBITDA of $783 million, (ii) revenue of $2,836 million, and (iii) applicable FS sales targets.

For the operating named executive officers, Ms. Brown and Mr. Traquair, the 2014 EIC components allowed for potential payouts of between 0% and 200% of target amounts if we achieved or exceeded the following financial objectives during 2014: (i) FS Adjusted EBITDA of $784 million, (ii) FS revenue of $2,621 million, (iii) applicable FS sales targets.

For each of our named executives, 2014 actual performance was reviewed against both the financial measures and individual objectives, as weighted and as applicable to each named executive. In 2014, Adjusted EBITDA and revenue results fell short of target, while sales exceeded target, resulting in bonus achievement of less than 100% for each of the named executives after taking into account individual objectives. The following table provides the EIC bonuses each named executive earned based on actual 2014 results of performance of both financial and individual objectives.

 

Name

   Target Bonus      Actual Bonus      Actual Bonus as
% of Target
 

Russell P. Fradin

   $ 1,800,000       $ 1,624,087         90.2

Charles J. Neral

   $ 575,000       $ 515,931         89.7

Marianne Brown

   $ 950,000       $ 883,364         93.0

Kevin J. McCurry

   $ 350,000       $ 324,106         92.6

Brian A. Traquair*

   $ 649,921       $ 555,590         85.5

 

  * Mr. Traquair is paid in Canadian Dollars (CAD). The bonus amounts reflected in the table have been converted, as applicable, to U.S. dollars at the currency exchange rate (used for purposes of the Company’s 2014 operating budget) of CAD 1 = USD 0.9686.

 

126


Table of Contents

Long-Term Equity Compensation

We intend for our equity program to be the primary vehicle for offering long-term incentives and rewarding our executive officers, managers and key employees because of the direct relationship between the value of these equity awards and the value of our stock. By compensating our executives with equity incentive awards, our executives hold a stake in the Company’s financial future. The gains realized in the long term depend on our executives’ ability to drive the financial performance of the Company. Equity awards are also a necessary vehicle for attracting and retaining executive talent in our competitive talent market.

Our 2005 Management Incentive Plan, as amended, provides for the grant of various forms of equity awards. We seek to provide equity grants that are competitive with companies in our peer group and other technology companies with which we compete for executive talent. When making annual equity awards to named executives, we consider past-year results, the role, responsibility and performance of the individual named executive, a competitive market assessment, prior equity awards, and the level of vested and unvested equity awards then held by each named executive. Awards granted in 2014 were for “Units” in the Parent Companies. Each “Unit” consists of 1.3 shares of Class A common stock and 0.1444 shares of Class L common stock of SCC and 0.3807 shares of preferred stock of SCCII. The shares comprising a Unit are in the same proportion as the shares issued to all stockholders of the Parent Companies.

To align the equity incentives of our executives with the interests of our stockholders, our equity program for the named executive are comprised of annual grants of restricted stock units (“RSUs”) and one-time grants of appreciation units (“AUs”).

 

    As part of the annual broad-based equity grant program, each of the named executives was granted the following awards in June 2014: (1) time-based RSUs that vest over three years with one-third vesting on each of the first three anniversaries of date of grant and (ii) performance-based RSUs that vest upon specified growth in the stock price over three years and can vest up to 200% for overachievement of target, with achievement and vesting determined on June 1, 2017. The Compensation Committee approved the 2014 annual grants with the performance measure based on increases in the Company’s stock price rather than Adjusted EBIDTA as in previous years.

 

    In addition, in 2013, we introduced a long-term equity incentive plan through grants of AUs, which are similar to stock appreciation units, to a limited number of senior executives with the performance objective of increasing the Company’s stock price over a four-year period. The performance-based AUs vest as the stock price increases from $15.96 to $23.24 for the performance period ending June 1, 2017 and will vest only if the average value of our stock on a measurement date occurring twice a year meets specified stock price increases. In 2013, Messrs. Fradin, Neral and Traquair were granted performance-based AUs, and Mr. Fradin was granted time-based AUs that vest annually through 2016. Ms. Brown and Mr. McCurry were granted AUs in February 2014 when they joined the company. The vested intrinsic value of the performance- and time-based AUs will be settled in stock and paid in June 2017.

Pursuant to their respective employment agreements, in February 2014, Ms. Brown and Mr. McCurry received the following initial RSU grants in addition to the AUs described above:

 

    Time-based RSUs vesting over four years.

 

    Performance-based RSUs tied to Adjusted EBITDA results for the period ending December 31, 2014. For earned amounts, Ms. Brown’s performance-based RSU vests 25% on December 31, 2014 and the remaining balance vests 25% on each of the second, third and fourth anniversaries of the date of grant, and Mr. McCurry’s performance-based RSU vests 50% on December 31, 2014 and the remaining balance vests 25% on each of the third and fourth anniversaries of the date of grant.

Based upon actual year-end 2014 results, (i) 11% of the 2014 target for each performance-based equity award granted in 2010 and 2012 and (ii) 37% of each performance-based equity award with a 12-month

 

127


Table of Contents

performance period ending December 31, 2014 was earned, with 25% vesting at the end of the performance period and the remaining balance vesting 25% on each of the second, third and fourth grant date anniversaries.

Benefits and Perquisites

We offer a variety of health and welfare programs to all eligible employees, including the named executives. The named executives are eligible generally for the same benefit programs on the same basis as the rest of the Company’s employees in the particular country in which the named executive resides, including medical and dental care coverage, life insurance coverage, short-and long-term disability and a 401(k) or other savings plan or defined contribution pension plan.

The Company limits the use of perquisites as a method of compensation and provides executive officers with only those perquisites that we believe are reasonable and consistent with our overall compensation program to better enable the Company to attract and retain superior employees for key positions. The perquisites provided to the named executives are described in the “Summary Compensation Table” below.

Employment Agreements, Severance Compensation & Change of Control Protection

Employment Agreement with Russell P. Fradin: In 2011, we entered into a definitive employment agreement with Mr. Fradin, pursuant to which he was appointed President and Chief Executive Officer of SunGard and a member of the Boards. The terms include the following:

 

    A term through May 31, 2016, with one-year renewals automatically effective 30 days before expiration, unless terminated on 30 days’ advance notice.

 

    An annual base salary of $900,000, subject to review periodically for appropriate increases by the Compensation Committee pursuant to the Company’s normal performance review policies for senior level executives, and a target annual bonus of 200% of his annual base salary.

 

    Employee benefits consistent with those made available to the Company’s senior level executives, and relocation benefits consistent with the Company’s relocation policy.

 

    An aggregate $5,000,000 equity investment to be made by Mr. Fradin in the Company at fair market value, which was made in 2011.

 

    Certain restrictive covenants (noncompetition, confidentiality and nonsolicitation) that continue for two years following the termination date.

 

    Mr. Fradin will be subject to any Company recoupment/clawback policy applicable to senior executives of the Company. If no such policy exists and the Company is required to restate its financials, then the Boards may seek to recover or require reimbursement of any related annual bonus paid to Mr. Fradin for the applicable period. If Mr. Fradin violates the restrictive covenants set forth in his employment agreement within the two years following termination of employment, then the Boards may recover severance benefits paid to Mr. Fradin. The right to receive certain severance payments and benefits upon certain terminations. See “Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change of Control” below.

 

    If an excise tax under sections 280G and 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Internal Revenue Code”) will be triggered by any payments upon a change in control prior to an initial public offering, the Company will in good faith seek to obtain stockholder approval of such payments so that they are exempt from the excise tax under sections 280G and 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code. After an initial public offering, the Company will either (i) pay Mr. Fradin any amounts subject to sections 280G and 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code (and Mr. Fradin will be responsible for the excise tax) or (ii) reduce such payments so that no amounts are subject to sections 280G and 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code, whichever results in a better after-tax amount for Mr. Fradin.

 

128


Table of Contents

Other Executive Employment Agreements: The Company entered into employment agreements with Messrs. Neral and McCurry and Ms. Brown when each joined the Company. The agreements were designed to retain executives and provide continuity of management in the event of an actual or threatened change of control. Mr. Traquair and the Company have not have entered into an employment agreement.

Compensation for Ms. Brown and Mr. McCurry was based on the terms of the employment agreements each entered into in connection with the commencement of employment on February 24, 2014 and January 20, 2014, respectively. In addition to the components of compensation discussed above, Ms. Brown and Mr. McCurry received equity awards, further discussed above and below under “Grants of Plan-Based Awards in Fiscal Year 2014.”

The agreements for Messrs. Neral and McCurry and Ms. Brown include the following terms:

 

    An initial term followed by one-year automatic renewals unless terminated with advance notice.

 

    Base salary subject to review periodically for appropriate increases by the CEO or the Compensation Committee pursuant to the Company’s normal performance review policies for senior level executives.

 

    The opportunity to participate in all short-term and long-term incentive programs, including an annual cash bonus, established by the Company for senior level executives.

 

    Employee benefits consistent with those made available to the Company’s senior level executives.

 

    The right to receive certain severance payments and benefits upon certain terminations. See “Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change of Control” below.

 

    Certain restrictive covenants (noncompetition, confidentiality and nonsolicitation) that continue for applicable post-termination periods.

Under the terms of our employment agreements and equity awards, the named executives are entitled to various payments and benefits upon the occurrence of specified events including termination of employment (with and without cause and in some instances for good reason) and upon a change in control of the Company. In the case of the employment agreements with Messrs. Neral and McCurry and Ms. Brown, the terms of these arrangements were set through the course of arms-length negotiations with each. As part of these negotiations, the Compensation Committee considered the terms to be consistent with the compensation packages provided to executives in comparable positions. The termination of employment provisions of the employment agreements were entered into in order to address competitive concerns when the named executives were recruited. At the time of entering into these arrangements, the aggregate potential obligations of the Company were considered in the context of the desirability of hiring the individual and the expected compensation upon joining us. Mr. Traquair does not have an employment agreement but is entitled to certain statutory protections under Canadian law.

These arrangements and potential post-employment termination compensation payments, as well as an estimate of the compensation that would have been payable had they been triggered as of fiscal year end, are described in more detail in the section entitled “Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change of Control” below.

Accounting and Tax Implications

The accounting and tax treatment of particular forms of compensation do not materially affect the Compensation Committee’s compensation decisions. However, we evaluate the effect of such accounting and tax treatment on an ongoing basis and will make appropriate modifications to compensation policies where appropriate.

Stock Ownership

The Company does not have a formal policy requiring stock ownership by management. See “Beneficial Ownership” under ITEM 12 below.

 

129


Table of Contents

Compensation Committee Report

We have reviewed and discussed the foregoing Compensation Discussion and Analysis with management. Based on our review and discussion with management, we have recommended to the Boards of Directors that the Compensation Discussion and Analysis be included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

 

Sanjeev K. Mehra, Chairperson
Glenn H. Hutchins
David L. Johnson
John W. Marren
R. Davis Noell

Risk Considerations in Our Compensation Programs

In 2014, we conducted a risk assessment to evaluate risks associated with the Company’s compensation policies and practices and concluded that the Company’s compensation programs and policies, considered as a whole, including applicable risk-mitigation features, were not reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect on the Company. Following are some of the features of our program designed to help us appropriately manage business risk:

 

    Our compensation programs utilize different types of compensation providing a balance of short-term and long-term incentives with fixed and variable components.

 

    Our established performance goals are reasonable given past performance and market conditions. These performance measures balance annual and long-term components with an emphasis on Adjusted EBITDA.

 

    There are caps of no more than 200% on payments from the EIC bonus plan which, in conjunction with threshold performance hurdles, ensure that incentive compensation is not overly emphasized.

 

    Our equity compensation program provides a mix of performance- and time-based equity awards with multiple-year vesting.

 

130


Table of Contents

Summary Compensation Table

The following table contains certain information about compensation earned in 2014, 2013 and 2012 by the named executives.

Summary Compensation Table

 

Name and Principal Position   Year     Salary
($)
    Bonus
($)
    Stock
Awards(1)
($)
    Option
Awards(2)
($)
   

Non-
Equity
Incentive
Plan
Compen-
sation(3)

($)

   

Change in
Pension Value
and
Nonqualified
Deferred
Compensation
Earnings

($)

   

All

Other
Compen
-sation(4)
($)

   

Total

($)

 

Russell P. Fradin

    2014        900,000        —          4,272,312        —          1,624,087        —          51,224        6,847,623   

President, Chief Executive Officer and Director

    2013        900,000        —          1,157,000        9,583,500        1,699,577        —          59,980        13,400,057   
    2012        900,000        —          —          —          1,800,000        —          1,167,142        3,867,142   
                   

Charles J. Neral (5)

    2014        575,000        125,000        705,379        —          515,931        —          46,440        1,967,750   

Senior Vice President–Finance and Chief Financial Officer

    2013        500,000        —          500,002        1,631,097        509,672        —          161,033        3,301,804   
    2012        250,000        100,000        5,500,196        —          250,000        —          983,941        7,084,137   
                   

Marianne Brown (6)

Chief Operating Officer, Financial Systems

    2014        596,795        —          2,178,801        2,030,487        883,364        —          13,991        5,703,438   
                   

Kevin J. McCurry (7)

Senior Vice President–Corporate Development & Strategy

    2014        382,051        —          876,272        406,100        324,106        —          15,106        2,003,635   
                   

Brian A. Traquair (8)

    2014        649,921        —          658,308        —          555,590        —          36,006        1,899,825   

Executive Vice President, Financial Systems

    2013        595,372        —          650,056        1,631,097        520,372        —          35,179        3,432,077   
    2012        600,080        —          1,077,496        —          582,598        —          590,202        2,850,376   

 

(1) Amounts shown reflect the grant date fair value per Unit of RSUs on the date of grant multiplied by the number of RSUs granted. For more details on grants awarded in 2014, see the “2014 Grants of Plan-Based Awards” table below.
(2) Amounts shown are the aggregate grant date fair value of AUs granted and reflect the fair value as computed in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718. For a discussion of the assumptions made in such valuation, see Note 10 to the Consolidated Financial Statements. Amounts represent the fair value of one-time AU awards discussed in further detail above in the “Compensation Discussion and Analysis.”
(3) Amounts shown in this column reflect the cash EIC awards payable under performance-based incentive compensation, which is discussed in further detail above in the “Compensation Discussion and Analysis.”
(4) The table below identifies the amounts shown for 2014 in the “All Other Compensation” column. All of the amounts reflect the actual cost to the company of providing the payment or benefit described below.

 

Name

   Company
Contributions
to Savings
Plan
($)
     Health and
Welfare
Benefits
($)
     Auto Benefits
($)
     Other*
($)
 
         Lease/
Allowance
     Tax
Gross-Up
    

Russell P. Fradin

     10,400         9,966         14,887         15,648         323   

Charles J. Neral

     10,400         5,052         17,598         12,479         911   

Marianne Brown

     —           13,991         —           —           —     

Kevin J. McCurry

     —           15,106         —           —           —     

Brian A. Traquair

     15,497         9,757         10,461         —           291   

 

  * For Messrs. Fradin and Neral, represents auto maintenance expenses. For Mr. Traquair, represents reimbursed health club fees, a benefit available to all Canadian employees.

 

131


Table of Contents
(5) In 2014, in connection with the successful completion of the AS Split-Off, Mr. Neral received a one-time discretionary bonus of $125,000. Mr. Neral joined SunGard as of July 2, 2012, and his 2012 annual rate of salary and his EIC were pro-rated for the period of time he was employed by the Company in 2012. In accordance with Mr. Neral’s employment agreement, in 2012, he received a $100,000 sign-on bonus.
(6) Ms. Brown joined SunGard as of February 24, 2014 and therefore was not a named executive in 2013 or 2012. Ms. Brown’s 2014 annual rate of salary was $700,000, which was pro-rated for the period of time she was employed by the Company in 2014.
(7) Mr. McCurry joined SunGard as of January 20, 2014 and therefore was not a named executive in 2013 or 2012. Mr. McCurry’s 2014 annual rate of salary was $400,000, which was pro-rated for the period of time he was employed by the Company in 2014.
(8) Mr. Traquair’s compensation was paid in Canadian Dollars (CAD). All amounts have been converted into U.S. dollars at the currency exchange rates used for purposes of the Company’s annual operating budget and establishing compensation for the applicable year as follows: 0.96858605 in 2014, 1.004 in 2013 and 1.01194 in 2012.

Grants of Plan-Based Awards in Fiscal Year 2014

Our SunGard 2005 Management Incentive Plan, as amended and restated (“Plan”), authorizes the issuance of equity subject to awards made under the Plan for up to 70 million shares of Class A common stock and 7 million shares of Class L common stock of SCC and 2.5 million shares of preferred stock of SCCII. Under the Plan, 2014 awards of time-based and performance-based RSUs and AUs have been granted for Units. All awards under the Plan are granted at fair market value on the date of grant.

As part of the annual grant program, each of the named executives was granted the following awards in June 2014: (1) time-based RSUs that vest over three years with one-third vesting on each of the first three anniversaries of date of grant and (ii) performance-based RSUs that vest upon specified growth in the stock price over three years and can vest up to 200% for overachievement of target, with earned amounts vesting on June 1, 2017. Initial RSU and AU awards granted to Ms. Brown and Mr. McCurry in connection with their employment are described above in the “Compensation Discussion and Analysis.”

 

132


Table of Contents

The following table contains information concerning grants of plan-based awards to the named executives during 2014.

2014 Grants of Plan-Based Awards

 

Name   Grant
Type
    Grant
Date
    Estimated
Possible
Payouts
under Non-
Equity
Incentive
Plan
Awards(1)
($)
    Estimated Future Payouts
Under Equity Incentive Plan
Awards(2)
    All Other
Stock Awards:
Number of
Shares of Stock
or Units(3)
(#)
    All Other
Option Awards:
Number of
Securities
Underlying
Options
(#)
    Exercise
or Base
Price of
Option
Awards
($/Sh)
    Grant Date
Fair Value
of Stock
and Option
Awards(4)
($)
 
                          Threshold
(#)
    Target
(#)
    Maximum
(#)
                             

Russell P. Fradin

    EIC        N/A        1,624,087        —          —          —          —          —          —          —     
      RSUs       06/01/14        —          1        202,912        405,824        50,728        —          —          4,272,312   
                     

Charles J. Neral

    EIC        N/A        515,931        —          —          —          —          —          —          —     
      RSUs       06/01/14        —          1        27,711        55,422        13,649        —          —          705,379   
                     

Marianne Brown

    EIC        N/A        883,364        —          —          —          —          —          —          —     
      RSUs       02/24/14        —          13,398        13,398        13,398        36,240        —          —          1,250,023   
          06/01/14        —          1        44,112        88,224        11,028        —          —          928,778   
      AUs        02/24/14        —          5,924        106,603        106,603        —          —          —          2,030,487   
                     

Kevin J. McCurry

    EIC        N/A        324,106        —          —          —          —          —          —          —     
      RSUs       02/20/14        —          5,360        5,360        5,360        14,497        —          —          500,048   
          06/01/14        —          1        14,780        29,560        7,280        —          —          376,225   
      AUs        02/20/14        —          1,185        21,321        21,321        —          —          —          406,100   
                     

Brian A. Traquair

    EIC        N/A        555,590        —          —          —          —          —          —          —     
      RSUs       06/01/14        —          1        25,862        51,724        12,738        —          —          658,308   

 

(1) Amounts reflect the cash EIC bonuses paid to the named executives under the performance-based incentive compensation, which is described in further detail above in the Compensation Discussion and Analysis and reported in the “Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation” column of the Summary Compensation Table above.
(2) Represents performance-based RSUs and, for Ms. Brown and Mr. McCurry, also represents performance-based AUs. February 2014 performance-based RSUs reflect the full amount earned with respect to the 12-month performance period ended December 31, 2014. June 2014 performance-based RSUs can vest up to 200% for overachievement of target. AUs represent the number of Units paid upon distribution of the award. The potential increase in stock price that can be achieved under the performance-based AUs is not limited and, therefore, the maximum payout for AUs is not determinable.
(3) Represents time-based RSUs.
(4) Represents the aggregate grant date fair value as computed in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718.

 

133


Table of Contents

Outstanding Equity Awards at 2014 Fiscal Year-End

The following table contains certain information with respect to options and RSUs held as of December 31, 2014 by the named executives.

Outstanding Equity Awards at 2014 Fiscal Year-End

 

     Option Awards     Stock Awards  
Name   Grant
Date
    Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options
(#)
Exercisable
    Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options
(#)
Unexercisable
    Equity
Incentive
Plan
Awards:
Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Unearned
Options(1)
(#)
    Option
Exercise
Price
($)
    Option
Expiration
Date
    Number
of Shares
or Units
of Stock
That
Have
Not
Vested
(#)
   

Market
Value of

Shares
or Units
of Stock
That
Have

Not
Vested(2)
($)

    Equity
Incentive
Plan
Awards:
Number
of
Unearned
Shares,
Units or
Other
Rights
That
Have Not
Vested(1)
(#)
    Equity
Incentive
Plan
Awards:
Market or
Payout
Value of
Unearned
Shares,
Units or
Other
Rights
That
Have Not
Vested(2)
($)
 

Russell P. Fradin

    6/17/2013                            27,192 (3)      460,636        —          —     
      6/17/2013                            10,053 (4)      170,297        —          —     
      6/17/2013        456,009 (5)      —          715,347        14.89        6/1/2017                 
      6/17/2013        401,608 (6)      267,739        —          14.89        6/1/2017                 
      6/1/2014                            50,728 (7)      859,332        —          —     
      6/1/2014                                                —          —          202,912        3,437,329   

Charles J. Neral

    9/12/2012                            31,891 (8)      540,235        —          —     
      9/12/2012                            —          —          20,981        355,422   
      6/1/2013                            11,750 (3)      199,051        —          —     
      6/1/2013                            4,344 (4)      73,593        —          —     
      6/17/2013        —          —          340,115        15.96        6/1/2017                 
      6/1/2014                            13,649 (7)      231,214        —          —     
      6/1/2014                                                —          —          27,711        469,424   

Marianne Brown

    2/24/2014                            36,240 (3)      613,898        —          —     
      2/24/2014                            10,048 (4)      170,217        —          —     
      2/24/2014        —          —          340,115        15.96        6/1/2017                 
      6/1/2014                            11,028 (7)      186,814        —          —     
      6/1/2014                                                —          —          44,112        747,257   

Kevin J. McCurry

    2/20/2014                            14,497 (3)      245,578        —          —     
      2/20/2014                            2,680 (4)      45,391        —          —     
      2/24/2014        —          —          68,023        15.96        6/1/2017                 
      6/1/2014                            7,280 (7)      123,323        —          —     
      6/1/2014                                                —          —          14,780        250,373   

Brian A. Traquair

    8/11/2005        24,469 (9)      —          —          4.03        2/25/2014                 
      8/12/2005        34,855 (10)      —          —          12.87        8/12/2015                 
      8/12/2005        41,380 (11)      —          —          12.87        8/11/2015                 
      9/21/2007        17,617 (12)      —          —          2.22        9/21/2017                 
      9/21/2007        31,423 (11)      —          —          2.22        9/21/2017                 
      9/3/2009        12,929 (13)      —          —          0.44        9/3/2019                 
      9/3/2009        18,402 (11)      —          —          0.44        9/3/2019                 
      6/1/2011                            937 (14)      15,874        —          —     
      9/14/2011                            669 (14)      11,339        —          —     
      9/12/2012                            2,015 (15)      34,130        —          —     
      9/12/2012                            3,526 (16)      59,727        —          —     
      11/15/2012                            10,490 (17)      177,697        —          —     
      11/15/2012                            10,490 (18)      177,697        —          —     
      6/1/2013                            5,648 (4)      95,681        —          —     
      6/1/2013                            15,278 (3)      258,807        —          —     
      6/17/2013        —          —          340,115        15.96        6/1/2017                 
      6/1/2014                            12,738 (7)      215,782         
      6/1/2014                                                —          —          25,862        438,102   

 

134


Table of Contents
(1) Represents the quantity of unvested performance-based equity awards that can be earned upon the achievement of anticipated performance goals in future years.
(2) Based upon a fair market value of $16.94 per Unit as of December 31, 2014.
(3) Represents the unvested portion of time-based RSUs which vest over four years with 25% vesting on each of the first four anniversaries of the date of grant.
(4) Represents the unvested portion of performance-based RSUs earned for the 12-month period of January 1, 2014 through December 31, 2014.
(5) Represents the vested portion of performance AUs which vest as the stock price appreciates above $14.889147.
(6) Represents the vested portion of time AUs which vest over 3 years, with 40% vesting on the grant date and 20% vesting on each of June 1, 2014, June 1, 2015 and June 1, 2016.
(7) Represents the unvested portion of time-based RSUs which vest over three years with 1/3 vesting on each of the first three anniversaries of the date of grant.
(8) Represents the unvested portion of time-based RSUs which vest over four years with 28% vesting on July 2, 2013 (hire date anniversary) and 72% of the remaining balance vesting in equal monthly installments thereafter for 36 months.
(9) To the extent that outstanding options were not exercised before the 2005 LBO, such options converted into fully vested options to purchase Units in the Parent Companies.
(10) Represents performance-based options which (i) vested upon the attainment of certain annual earnings goals for the Company during the six-year period beginning January 1, 2005 for calendar years 2005-2009 and (ii) were earned and vested for calendar year 2010 pursuant to the awards amended in 2009.
(11) Represents fully vested time-based Class A options which vested over five years. The current value of Class A common stock is $0.01 per share.
(12) Represents performance-based Class A options which (i) vested upon the attainment of certain annual earnings goals for the Company during the five-year period beginning January 1, 2007 for calendar years 2007-2009, (ii) were earned and vested for calendar year 2010 pursuant to the 2009 amended awards, and (iii) were earned and vested for calendar year 2011. The current value of Class A common stock is $0.01 per share.
(13) Performance-based Class A options are earned upon the attainment of certain annual earnings goals for the Company over a five-year period. Represents performance-based Class A options earned and vested for calendar years 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012 and 2013. The current value of Class A common stock is $0.01 per share.
(14) Represents the unvested portion of time-based RSUs which vest over four years with 28% vesting on June 1, 2012, and 72% of the remaining balance vesting in equal monthly installments thereafter for 36 months.
(15) Represents the unvested portion of performance-based RSUs earned for calendar year 2012.
(16) Represents the unvested portion of time-based RSUs which vest over four years with 28% vesting one year from the date of grant, and 72% of the remaining balance vesting in equal monthly installments thereafter for 36 months.
(17) Represents the unvested portion of performance-based RSUs earned for calendar year 2013.
(18) Represents the unvested portion of time-based RSUs which vest over four years with 25% vesting on each of the first three grant date anniversaries and the remaining 25% vesting on June 1, 2016.

 

135


Table of Contents

Option Exercises and Stock Vested

The following table contains certain information with respect to stock option exercises and the vesting of RSUs and AUs during 2014 for each of the named executives.

2014 Option Exercises and Stock Vesting

 

     Option Awards     Stock Awards  
Name  

Number of Shares

Acquired

on Exercise

(#)

   

Value Realized

on Exercise(1)

($)

   

Number of Shares

Acquired

on Vesting(2)

(#)

   

Value Realized

on Vesting(3)

($)

 

Russell P. Fradin

    —          —          621,648      $ 3,899,075   

Charles J. Neral

    —          —          27,806        484,987   

Marianne Brown

    —          —          3,350        56,741   

Kevin J. McCurry

    —          —          2,680        45,399   

Brian A. Traquair

    16,465        213,063        29,295        508,235   

 

(1) Calculated by multiplying the number of Units acquired on exercise times the difference between the fair market value on the exercise date and exercise price of the option.
(2) Represents RSUs that vested during 2014. RSUs are not distributed until the first to occur of a change of control, separation from service without cause or a date specified in the RSU agreement ranging from three to five years after date of grant. For Mr. Fradin, also represents time-based AUs that vested during 2014 and which are not distributed until the first to occur of a change of control, separation from service for any reason other than for cause or June 1, 2017.
(3) Calculated by multiplying the number of vested RSUs by the fair market value on the vesting date and for Mr. Fradin also includes the number of AUs that vested during 2014 multiplied by the difference between the Unit fair market value on the exercise date and the grant date.

Pension Benefits

None of the named executives receive benefits under any defined benefit or actuarial pension plan.

Employment and Change of Control Agreements

As discussed above, the Company entered into a definitive employment agreement with each of the named executives except for Mr. Traquair. The terms of these agreements are described above under “Compensation Discussion and Analysis.”

Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change of Control

Pursuant to the terms of the executive employment agreements and equity award agreements, set forth below is a description of the potential payments the named executives would receive if their employment was terminated on December 31, 2014. Mr. Traquair does not have an employment agreement; therefore, the amount of compensation Mr. Traquair would receive upon termination or change of control, if any, is based upon our compensation plans and Canadian law.

The terms cause, good reason, change of control and sale of business are defined in the applicable executive employment agreements, which have been included as exhibits to the following SEC filings:

 

Mr. Fradin:

   Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2011

Mr. Neral:

   Current Report on Form 8-K dated June 8, 2012

Ms. Brown:

   Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014

Mr. McCurry:

   Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014

 

136


Table of Contents

Russell P. Fradin

Upon termination without cause or resignation for good reason:

 

    a lump sum cash payment equal to two times the sum of his base salary and target incentive bonus;

 

    a lump sum cash payment of his pro rata incentive bonus based upon the incentive bonus he earned for the year in which his termination occurred multiplied by the number of days in which he was employed during such year divided by 365;

 

    a lump sum cash payment for the cost of premiums under Consolidated Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1985, as amended (“COBRA”) for medical, dental and vision coverage less employee co-pay for such coverage for 18 months, as increased by a tax gross-up payment equal to the estimated income and FICA tax that would be imposed on such payments;

 

    a lump sum cash payment for accrued but unpaid base salary, unreimbursed business expenses, unused vacation time and all other payments, benefits or fringe benefits in accordance with the applicable plan or program; and

 

    upon termination without cause, all earned but unvested performance-based RSUs granted in 2013 become fully vested; and no performance-based RSUs granted in 2014 shall vest if the termination date occurs before June 1, 2017, and all unvested performance-based RSUs are forfeited;

 

    all time-based RSUs immediately stop vesting and all unvested time-based RSUs are forfeited; and

 

    all unvested time-based appreciation units (“AUs”) become immediately vested and shall be paid, and if employment terminates prior to June 1, 2017, his vested performance-based AUs are paid and any unvested performance-based AUs are forfeited.

Upon termination with change of control:

 

    all earned but unvested performance-based RSUs granted in 2013 shall become fully vested; and

 

    for performance-based RSUs granted in 2014, if the change of control occurs on or before June 1, 2017 and employment is terminated without cause within twelve months following a change of control, vesting shall be determined based upon the share price on the change of control date;

 

    all unvested time-based RSUs granted in 2013 and 2014 shall vest if employment is terminated without cause within six months and twelve months, respectively, following a change of control; and

 

    all performance-based and time-based AUs shall become fully vested if a change of control occurs on or before June 1, 2017 and if the Grantee continues employment through the date of the change of control.

Upon retirement or other voluntary termination:

 

    a lump sum cash payment consisting of accrued amounts, if any;

 

    all RSUs shall immediately stop vesting, and no additional performance-based RSUs shall be earned after the termination date; and all unvested RSUs shall be forfeited; and

 

    all vested time-based and performance-based AUs shall be paid, and any unvested time-based and/or performance-based AUs shall be forfeited.

Upon termination for disability or death:

 

    a lump sum cash payment of his pro rata incentive bonus and accrued amounts, if any;

 

    in the event of his death, Mr. Fradin’s beneficiary shall receive payments under a life insurance policy funded by the Company;

 

137


Table of Contents
    for termination due to disability or death, all earned but unvested performance-based RSUs granted in 2013 become vested, and all unearned performance-based RSUs are forfeited;

 

    time-based RSUs granted in 2013 shall vest as to (i) 75% if his death occurs before June 1, 2015, and (ii) 100% if his death occurs on or after June 1, 2015, and time-based and performance-based RSU awards granted in 2014 shall vest as to (i) 66.67% if his death occurs prior to June 1, 2015, and (ii) 100% if his death occurs between June 1, 2015 and June 1, 2017. All unvested time-based RSUs are forfeited;

 

    no performance-based RSU awards granted in 2014 shall vest if employment terminates due to disability before June 1, 2017 and unvested performance-based RSUs shall be forfeited;

 

    if employment terminates due to disability, all time-based RSUs immediately stop vesting and unvested time-based RSUs are forfeited; and

 

    all time-based AUs shall fully vest, and all unvested performance-based AUs are forfeited.

Charles J. Neral

Upon termination without cause or resignation for good reason:

 

    a lump sum cash payment equal to the sum of his base salary and target incentive bonus, and for a change of control Mr. Neral receives two times the sum of his base salary and target incentive bonus;

 

    a lump sum cash payment of his pro rata target incentive bonus and any earned or accrued compensation as of December 31 of the year of termination, but if Mr. Neral is terminated on December 31, he receives his actual earned incentive bonus for the year of termination;

 

    a lump sum cash payment in an amount equal to the Company’s cost of Mr. Neral’s medical, dental and vision coverage in effect on December 31 of the year of termination, as increased by a tax gross-up payment equal to the income and FICA tax imposed on such payment;

 

    upon termination without cause, performance-based RSUs granted in 2012 shall vest on a pro rata basis through the termination date; all earned but unvested performance-based RSUs granted in 2013 shall become fully vested; and no performance-based RSU awards granted in 2014 shall vest if the termination date occurs before June 1, 2017. All unvested performance-based RSUs shall be forfeited;

 

    all time-based RSUs shall immediately stop vesting and unvested time-based RSUs shall be forfeited; and

 

    all unpaid performance-based AUs shall be forfeited.

Upon termination with change of control:

 

    all unvested time-based RSUs granted in 2012, 2013 and 2014 shall vest if employment is terminated without cause within eighteen months, six months and twelve months, respectively, following a change of control;

 

    all performance-based RSUs granted in 2012 shall vest if employment is terminated without cause within eighteen months following a change of control, any earned but unvested performance-based RSUs granted in 2013 shall become fully vested;

 

    for performance-based RSUs granted in 2014, if the change of control occurs on or before June 1, 2017 and employment is terminated without cause within twelve months following a change of control, vesting shall be determined based upon the share price on the change of control date; and

 

    all performance-based AUs shall become fully vested if a change of control occurs before June 1, 2017 and if the grantee continues employment through the date of the change of control.

 

138


Table of Contents

Upon retirement or other voluntary termination:

 

    a lump sum cash payment of all accrued compensation, including any incentive compensation for which the performance period has been completed; and

 

    all RSUs shall immediately stop vesting, and no additional performance-based RSUs shall be earned after the termination date; and all unvested RSUs shall be forfeited; and

 

    all unpaid performance-based AUs shall be forfeited.

Upon disability or death:

 

    a lump sum cash payment of all accrued compensation and a pro rata payment of his target incentive bonus for the year in which his disability or death occurs, and if termination of employment is on December 31, Mr. Neral receives his actual earned incentive bonus for the year of termination;

 

    in the event of death, Mr. Neral’s beneficiary shall receive payments under an insurance policy funded by the Company;

 

    for termination due to disability or death, performance-based RSUs granted in 2012 vest on a pro rata basis through the termination date; and all earned but unvested performance-based RSUs granted in 2013 shall become vested and all unearned performance-based RSUs are forfeited;

 

    time-based RSUs granted in 2012 immediately stop vesting and time-based RSUs granted in 2013 shall vest as to (i) 75% if his death occurs before June 1, 2015, and (ii) 100% if his death occurs on or after June 1, 2015; and time-based and performance-based RSU awards granted in 2014 shall vest as to (i) 66.67% if death occurs prior to June 1, 2015, and (ii) 100% if death occurs between June 1, 2015 and June 1, 2017.

 

    no performance-based RSU awards granted in 2014 shall vest if employment terminates due to disability before June 1, 2017 and unvested performance-based RSUs are forfeited;

 

    if employment terminates due to disability, all time-based RSU awards immediately stop vesting and unvested time-based RSUs are forfeited; and

 

    all performance-based AUs for which the stock price thresholds have been met shall vest and all vested performance-based AUs shall be paid.

Marianne Brown

Upon termination without cause or resignation for good reason:

 

    a lump sum cash payment equal to the sum of her base salary and target incentive bonus;

 

    a lump sum cash payment of her pro rata target incentive bonus and any earned or accrued compensation as of December 31 of the year of termination, but if Ms. Brown is terminated on December 31, she receives her actual earned incentive bonus for the year of termination;

 

    a lump sum cash payment in an amount equal to the Company’s cost of Ms. Brown’s medical, dental and vision coverage in effect on December 31 of the year of termination, as increased by a tax gross-up payment equal to the income and FICA tax imposed on such payment;

 

    all performance-based RSUs granted in 2014 shall become fully vested;

 

    all time-based RSUs granted in 2014 shall become fully vested; and

 

    all unpaid performance-based AUs are forfeited.

 

139


Table of Contents

Upon termination with change of control:

 

    any earned but unvested performance-based RSUs granted in February 2014 shall become fully vested; and for performance-based RSUs granted in June 2014, if the change of control occurs on or before June 1, 2017 and employment is terminated without cause within twelve months following a change of control, vesting shall be determined based upon the share price on the change of control date;

 

    time-based RSUs granted in February and June 2014 shall vest if employment is terminated without cause within six and twelve months, respectively, following a change of control; and

 

    all performance-based AUs shall become fully vested if a change of control occurs before June 1, 2017 and if the grantee continues in employment through the date of the change of control.

Upon retirement or other voluntary termination:

 

    a lump sum cash payment of all accrued compensation;

 

    all RSUs shall immediately stop vesting, and no additional performance-based RSUs shall be earned after the termination date; and all unvested RSUs shall be forfeited; and

 

    all unpaid performance-based AUs shall be forfeited.

Upon disability or death:

 

    a lump sum cash payment of all accrued compensation;

 

    in the event of death, beneficiaries shall receive payments under an insurance policy funded by the Company;

 

    if employment terminates due to disability or death then any earned but unvested performance-based RSUs granted February 2014 shall become fully vested;

 

    time-based RSUs granted in February 2014 shall vest as to (i) 50% if death occurs prior to February 24, 2015, (ii) 75% if death occurs between February 24, 2015 and February 24, 2016, and (iii) 100% if death occurs on or after February 24, 2016; and time-based and performance-based RSU awards granted in June 2014 shall vest as to (i) 66.67% if death occurs prior to June 1, 2015, and (ii) 100% if death occurs between June 1, 2015 and June 1, 2017;

 

    no performance-based RSU awards granted in June 2014 shall vest if employment terminates due to disability before June 1, 2017 and unvested performance-based RSUs shall be forfeited;

 

    if employment terminates due to disability time-based RSU awards immediately stop vesting and unvested time-based RSUs are forfeited; and

 

    all performance-based AUs for which the stock price thresholds have been met shall vest and all vested performance-based AUs shall be paid.

Kevin J. McCurry

Upon termination without cause or resignation for good reason:

 

    a lump sum cash payment equal to the sum of his base salary and target incentive bonus;

 

    a lump sum cash payment in an amount equal to six months of the Company’s cost of Mr. McCurry’s medical, dental and vision coverage in effect on December 31 of the year of termination, as increased by a tax gross-up payment equal to the income and FICA tax imposed on such payment;

 

    all earned performance-based RSUs granted February 2014 shall stop vesting on the termination date; and no performance-based RSU awards granted in June 2014 shall vest if the termination date occurs before June 1, 2017. All unvested RSUs shall be forfeited;

 

140


Table of Contents
    all time-based RSU awards immediately stop vesting and unvested time-based RSU awards are forfeited; and

 

    all unpaid performance-based AUs are forfeited.

Upon termination with change of control:

 

    all earned but unvested performance-based RSUs granted in February 2014 shall become fully vested;

 

    for performance-based RSUs granted in June 2014, if the change of control occurs on or before June 1, 2017 and employment is terminated without cause within twelve months following a change of control, vesting shall be determined based upon the share price on the change of control date;

 

    time-based RSUs granted in February 2014 and June 2014 shall become fully vested if employment is terminated without cause within six months and twelve months, respectively, following a change of control; and

 

    all performance-based AUs shall become fully vested if a change of control occurs before June 1, 2017 if the grantee continues employment through the date of the change of control.

Upon retirement or other voluntary termination:

 

    a lump sum cash payment equal to the amount of any earned or accrued compensation owing but not yet paid at the date of termination; and

 

    all RSUs shall immediately stop vesting, and no additional performance-based RSUs shall be earned after the termination date; and all unvested RSUs shall be forfeited;

 

    all unpaid performance-based AUs shall be forfeited.

Upon disability or death:

 

    a lump sum cash payment equal to the amount of any earned or accrued compensation owing but not yet paid at the date of termination;

 

    in the event of death, beneficiaries shall receive payments under an insurance policy funded by the Company;

 

    if employment terminates due to disability or death, all earned but unvested performance-based RSUs granted February 2014 shall become fully vested;

 

    if employment terminates due to death, time-based RSUs granted February 2014 shall vest as to (i) 50% if the death occurs before February 20, 2015, (ii) 75% if death occurs between February 20, 2015 and February 20, 2016, and (iii) 100% if death occurs after February 20, 2016; and performance and time-based RSUs granted in June 2014 shall vest as to (i) 66.67% if death occurs prior to June 1, 2015, and (ii) 100% if death occurs between June 1, 2015 and June 1, 2016;

 

    no performance-based RSU awards granted in June 2014 shall vest if employment terminates due to disability before June 1, 2017 and unvested performance-based RSUs shall be forfeited;

 

    if employment terminates due to disability all time-based RSUs immediately stop vesting and unvested time-based RSUs are forfeited; and

 

    all performance-based AUs for which the stock price thresholds have been met shall vest and all vested performance-based AUs shall be paid.

 

141


Table of Contents

Brian A. Traquair

Upon termination without cause:

 

    Mr. Traquair is entitled to notice, or pay in lieu of notice, based on his 20 year tenure with the Company and other factors. Subject to his obligation to mitigate his damages, his pay in lieu of notice would be approximately 20 months of total compensation based on his annual base salary and target incentive bonus;

 

    a lump sum cash payment equal to 20 months of the Company’s cost of Mr. Traquair’s medical, dental, long term disability and life insurance coverage, as well as 20 months of contributions made by the Company to a retirement savings program for Mr. Traquair’s benefit;

 

    all earned but unvested performance-based RSUs granted in 2012 and 2013 become fully vested; and no performance-based RSUs granted in 2014 shall vest if the termination date occurs before June 1, 2017. All unvested RSUs shall be forfeited;

 

    all time-based RSU awards immediately stop vesting and all unvested time-based RSUs are forfeited;

 

    all unpaid performance-based AUs are forfeited; and

 

    if a sale of our FS business segment occurs and employment is terminated, then performance-based RSUs are treated as described above and all unvested time-based equity awards granted before May 2010 become fully vested.

Upon termination with change of control:

 

    if a change of control occurs and employment is terminated without cause, Mr. Traquair is entitled to notice, or pay in lieu of notice, based on his 20 year tenure with the Company and other factors. Subject to his obligation to mitigate his damages, his pay in lieu of notice would be approximately 20 months of total compensation based on his annual base salary and target incentive bonus;

 

    a lump sum cash payment equal to 20 months of the Company’s cost of Mr. Traquair’s medical, dental, long term disability and life insurance coverage, as well as 20 months of contributions made by the Company to a retirement savings program for Mr. Traquair’s benefit;

 

    all earned but unvested performance-based RSUs granted in 2012 and 2013 shall become fully vested;

 

    for performance-based RSUs granted in 2014, if the change of control occurs on or before June 1, 2017 and employment is terminated without cause within twelve months following the change of control, vesting shall be determined based upon the share price on the change of control date;

 

    all unvested time-based RSUs granted in 2011-2013 and 2014 become fully vested if employment is terminated without cause within six months and twelve months, respectively, following a change of control; and

 

    all performance-based AUs shall become fully vested if a change of control occurs before June 1, 2017 and if the Grantee continues in employment through the date of the change of control.

Upon retirement or other voluntary termination:

 

    a lump sum cash payment of accrued compensation. Mr. Traquair is not entitled to receive a pro rata incentive bonus for the year of termination.

 

    all RSUs shall immediately stop vesting, and no additional performance-based RSUs shall be earned after the termination date; and all unvested RSUs shall be forfeited; and

 

    all unpaid performance-based AUs shall be forfeited.

 

142


Table of Contents

Upon disability or death:

 

    upon termination in the event of disability, Mr. Traquair is entitled to eight weeks of base salary, as well as a 20 week severance payment, for a total of 28 weeks of base salary;

 

    upon termination in the event of disability, a lump sum cash payment equal to eight weeks of the Company’s cost of Mr. Traquair’s medical, dental, long term disability and life insurance coverage, as well as eight weeks of contributions made by the Company to a retirement savings program for Mr. Traquair’s benefit;

 

    Mr. Traquair is entitled to accrued compensation. Mr. Traquair is not entitled to receive a pro rata incentive bonus for the year of termination;

 

    in the event of death, Mr. Traquair’s beneficiary shall receive payment under an insurance policy funded by the Company;

 

    upon disability or death, any earned but unvested performance-based RSUs granted in 2012 and 2013 shall become fully vested;

 

    upon termination due to death, time-based RSU awards granted November 2012 shall become fully vested, time-based RSUs granted in 2013 shall vest as to (i) 75% if his death occurs before June 1, 2015 and (ii) 100% if his death occurs on or after June 1, 2015; performance and time-based RSUs granted in 2014 shall vest as to (i) 66.67% if death occurs prior to June 1, 2015, and (ii) 100% if death occurs between June 1, 2015 and June 1, 2016;

 

    no performance-based RSU awards granted in 2014 shall vest if employment terminates due to disability before June 1, 2017 and unvested performance-based RSUs are forfeited;

 

    if employment terminates due to disability all time-based RSUs immediately stop vesting and unvested time-based RSUs are forfeited; and

 

    all performance-based AUs for which the stock price thresholds have been met shall vest and all vested performance-based AUs shall be paid.

In order to receive any of the above described severance benefits, the named executive, other than Mr. Traquair, is required to execute a release of all claims against the Company. In order to exercise stock options or receive distribution of RSU shares, the named executive must execute a certificate of compliance with respect to the restrictive covenants contained in his employment agreement, if applicable, and all other agreements with the Company.

 

143


Table of Contents

The tables below reflect the amount of compensation payable to each of the named executives in the event of termination of such executive’s employment. The amounts shown assume that such termination was effective as of December 31, 2014, and thus includes amounts earned through such time and are estimates of the amounts which would be paid out to the named executives upon their termination. The actual amounts to be paid, if any, can only be determined at the time of such named executive’s separation from the Company.

Russell P. Fradin—Potential Termination Payments and Benefits

 

Executive Benefits and

Payment Upon

Termination

 

Termination

Without

Cause or

Resignation

For

Good Reason

Without Change of

Control

   

Retirement

or Other

Voluntary

Termination

   

Termination

Without

Cause or

Resignation

For

Good Reason

With Change of

Control

   

Termination

Due to

Disability

   

Termination

Due to

Death

 

Compensation:

                                       

Base Salary & Target Bonus (1)

  $ 5,400,000        —        $ 5,400,000        —          —     

Bonus in Year of Termination (2)

  $ 1,624,087      $ 1,624,087      $ 1,624,087      $ 1,624,087      $ 1,624,087   

Time-Based Equity Awards (3)

  $ 549,093        —        $ 1,869,061       —        $ 880,008   

Performance-Based Equity Awards (4)

  $ 170,298       —        $ 5,074,700      $ 170,298     $ 2,461,965  

Benefits & Perquisites:

                                       

Health Benefits (5)

  $ 23,713        —        $ 23,713        —          —     

Life Insurance Proceeds

    —          —          —          —        $ 1,000,000   

Excise Tax & Gross-Up

    —          —          —   (6)      —          —     

Total:

  $ 7,767,191      $ 1,624,087      $ 13,991,561      $ 1,794,385      $ 5,966,060   

 

(1) Consists of two times the sum of (a) 2014 base salary of $900,000 and (b) 2014 target incentive bonus of $1,800,000.
(2) Because Mr. Fradin’s termination is deemed to have occurred on December 31, he is entitled to receive his actual, earned incentive bonus for 2014.
(3) Represents the value of the applicable accelerated portion of time-based equity based upon a fair market price of $16.94 per Unit as of December 31, 2014.
(4) Represents the value of the applicable accelerated portion of performance-based equity based upon a fair market price of $16.94 per Unit as of December 31, 2014.
(5) Represents the cost of premiums under COBRA for medical, dental and vision coverage less employee co-pay for such coverage for 18 months, as increased by a tax gross-up payment equal to the estimated taxes that would be imposed on such payments.
(6) The Company and Mr. Fradin have agreed to cooperate to obtain shareholder approval of any change of control payments that would otherwise be subject to excise tax under section 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code, so the estimates assume that no excise will apply.

 

144


Table of Contents

Charles J. Neral—Potential Termination Payments and Benefits

 

Executive Benefits and

Payment Upon

Termination

 

Termination

Without

Cause or

Resignation

For

Good Reason

Without Change of

Control

   

Termination

Due to

Retirement

or Other

Voluntary

Termination

   

Termination

Without

Cause or

Resignation

For

Good Reason

With Change of

Control

   

Termination

Due to

Disability

   

Termination

Due to

Death

 

Compensation:

                                       

Base Salary & Target Bonus (1)

  $ 1,150,000        —        $ 2,300,000        —          —     

Bonus in Year of Termination (2)

  $ 515,931      $ 515,931      $ 515,931      $ 515,931      $ 515,931   

Time-Based Equity Awards (3)

    —          —        $ 970,501        —        $ 286,847   

Performance-Based Equity Awards (4)

  $ 73,600       —        $ 1,488,240      $ 73,600     $ 386,565  

Benefits & Perquisites:

                                       

Health Benefits (5)

  $ 7,992        —        $ 7,992        —          —     

Life Insurance Proceeds

    —          —          —          —        $ 1,000,000   

Total:

  $ 1,747,523      $ 515,931      $ 5,282,664      $ 589,531      $ 2,189,343   

 

(1) With regard to (i) a termination without cause, consists of the sum of (a) 2014 base salary of $575,000 and (b) 2014 target incentive bonus of $575,000, and (ii) a termination due to a change of control, consists of two times the sum of (a) 2014 base salary of $575,000 and (b) 2014 target incentive bonus of $575,000.
(2) Because Mr. Neral’s termination is deemed to have occurred on December 31, he is entitled to receive his actual, earned incentive bonus for 2014.
(3) Represents the value of the applicable accelerated portion of time-based equity based upon a fair market price of $16.94 per Unit as of December 31, 2014.
(4) Represents the value of the applicable accelerated portion of performance-based equity based upon a fair market price of $16.94 per Unit as of December 31, 2014.
(5) Consists of the sum of the Company’s cost for Mr. Neral’s medical, dental and vision coverage for one year. The health benefits have been increased by a tax gross-up equal to the estimated income and FICA tax that would be imposed on such payments.

 

145


Table of Contents

Marianne Brown—Potential Termination Payments and Benefits

 

Executive Benefits and

Payment Upon

Termination

 

Termination

Without

Cause or

Resignation

For

Good Reason

Without Change of

Control

   

Termination

Due to

Retirement

or Other

Voluntary

Termination

   

Termination

Without

Cause or

Resignation

For
Good Reason

With Change of

Control

   

Termination

Due to

Disability

   

Termination

Due to

Death

 

Compensation:

                                       

Base Salary & Target Bonus (1)

  $ 1,650,000        —        $ 1,650,000        —          —     

Bonus in Year of Termination (2)

  $ 883,364      $ 883,364      $ 883,364      $ 883,364      $ 883,364   

Time-Based Equity Awards (3)

  $ 800,712        —        $ 800,712        —        $ 431,498   

Performance-Based Equity Awards (4)

  $ 1,304,415        —        $ 1,151,850      $ 170,221      $ 668,417   

Benefits & Perquisites:

                                       

Health and Welfare Benefits (5)

  $ 19,407        —        $ 19,407        —          —     

Life Insurance Proceeds

    —          —          —          —        $ 1,000,000   

Total:

  $ 4,657,898      $ 883,364      $ 4,505,333      $ 1,053,585      $ 2,983,279   

 

(1) Consists of the sum of (a) 2014 base salary of $700,000, and (b) 2014 target incentive bonus of $950,000.
(2) Because Ms. Brown’s termination is deemed to have occurred on December 31, she is entitled to receive her actual, earned incentive bonus for 2014.
(3) Represents the value of the applicable accelerated portion of time-based equity based upon a fair market price of $16.94 per Unit as of December 31, 2014.
(4) Represents the value of the accelerated portion of performance-based equity based upon a fair market price of $16.94 per Unit as of December 31, 2014.
(5) Consists of the sum of the Company’s cost for Ms. Brown’s medical, dental and vision coverage for one year. The health benefits have been increased by a tax gross-up equal to the estimated income and FICA tax that would be imposed on such payments.

 

146


Table of Contents

Kevin J. McCurry—Potential Termination Payments and Benefits

 

Executive Benefits and

Payment Upon

Termination

 

Termination

Without

Cause or

Resignation

For

Good Reason

Without Change of

Control

   

Termination

Due to

Retirement

or Other

Voluntary

Termination

   

Termination

Without

Cause or

Resignation

For

Good Reason

With Change of

Control

   

Termination

Due to

Disability

   

Termination

Due to

Death

 

Compensation:

                                       

Base Salary & Target Bonus (1)

  $ 750,000        —        $ 750,000        —          —     

Bonus in Year of Termination (2)

  $ 324,106      $ 324,106      $ 324,106      $ 324,106      $ 324,106   

Time-Based Equity Awards (3)

    —          —        $ 368,901        —        $ 205,009   

Performance-Based Equity Awards (4)

    —          —        $ 297,248        —        $ 166,924   

Benefits & Perquisites:

                                       

Health and Welfare Benefits (5)

  $ 10,797        —        $ 10,797        —          —     

Life Insurance Proceeds

    —          —          —          —        $ 800,000   

Total:

  $ 1,084,903      $ 324,106      $ 1,751,052      $ 324,106      $ 1,496,039   

 

(1) Consists of the sum of (a) 2014 base salary of $400,000, and (b) 2014 target incentive bonus of $350,000.
(2) Because Mr. McCurry’s termination is deemed to have occurred on December 31, he is entitled to receive his actual earned bonus for 2014.
(3) Represents the value of the applicable accelerated portion of time-based equity based upon a fair market price of $16.94 per Unit as of December 31, 2014.
(4) Represents the value of the applicable accelerated portion of performance-based equity based upon a fair market price of $16.94 per Unit as of December 31, 2014.
(5) Consists of the sum of the Company’s cost for Mr. McCurry’s medical, dental and vision coverage for six months. The health benefits have been increased by a tax gross-up equal to the estimated income and FICA tax that would be imposed on such payments.

 

147


Table of Contents

Brian A. Traquair—Potential Termination Payments and Benefits

 

Executive Benefits and

Payment Upon

Termination

 

Termination

Without

Cause

Without Change of

Control

   

Termination

Resignation

   

Termination

Due to

Sale of

Business

Employment

Not Offered

   

Termination

Without

Cause

With Change of

Control

   

Termination

Due to

Disability

   

Termination

Due to

Death

 

Compensation

                                               

Base Salary & Target Bonus (1)

  $ 1,929,655        —        $ 1,929,655      $ 1,929,655        —          —     

Bonus in Year of Termination (2)

  $ 494,874      $ 494,874      $ 494,874      $ 494,874      $ 494,874      $ 494,874   

Time-Based Equity Awards (3)

    —          —          —        $ 739,225        —        $ 316,399   

Performance-Based Equity Awards (4)

  $ 307,507        —          —        $ 979,981      $ 307,507      $ 599,590   

Benefits & Perquisites:

                                               

Health and Welfare Benefits

  $ 36,938 (5)      —        $ 36,938 (5)    $ 36,938 (5)    $ 3,694 (6)      —     

Disability Benefits

    —          —          —          —        $ 311,714 (7)      —     

Death Benefits

    —          —          —          —          —        $ 1,000,000   

Total:

  $ 2,768,974      $ 494,874      $ 2,461,467      $ 4,180,673      $ 1,117,789      $ 2,410,863   

 

(1) Consists of 20 months of the sum of (a) 2014 base salary of $578,897 and (b) 2014 target incentive bonus of $578,897. Mr. Traquair’s payments would be in Canadian Dollars. The amounts reported in the table for salary, bonus, health & welfare and disability have been converted from Canadian Dollars into U.S. dollars at the December 31, 2014 currency exchange rate of 0.86274.
(2) Because Mr. Traquair’s termination is deemed to have occurred on December 31, he is entitled to receive his actual, earned incentive bonus for 2014.
(3) Represents the value of the applicable accelerated portion of time-based equity based upon a fair market price of $16.94 per Unit as of December 31, 2014.
(4) Represents the value of the applicable accelerated portion of performance-based equity based upon a fair market price of $16.94 per Unit as of December 31, 2014.
(5) Consists of 20 months of the sum of the Company’s cost for Mr. Traquair’s (i) medical, dental, long term disability, basic life & accidental death coverages, and (ii) pension contributions.
(6) Consists of 2 months of the sum of the Company’s cost for Mr. Traquair’s (i) medical, dental, long term disability, basic life & accidental death coverages, and (ii) pension contributions.
(7) Represents 28 weeks of 2014 base salary.

 

148


Table of Contents
ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

Equity Compensation Plan Information

There are no compensation plans under which our common stock is authorized for issuance. The following table contains certain information as of December 31, 2014 with respect to the SunGard 2005 Management Incentive Plan, as amended, under which equity in the Parent Companies is authorized for issuance.

 

Plan Category  

Number of Securities to be Issued

Upon Exercise of Outstanding
Options, Warrants and Rights (a)

    Weighted-
Average
Exercise Price
of Outstanding
Options,
Warrants and
Rights (b)
    Number of Securities Remaining Available
for Issuance Under Equity Compensation
Plans (excluding Securities Reflected in
Column (a)) (c)
 
  Shares of
Class A
Common Stock
    Shares of
Class L
Common Stock
    Shares of
Preferred
Stock
      Shares of
Class A
Common Stock
    Shares of
Class L
Common Stock
    Shares of
Preferred
Stock
 

Equity compensation plans approved by security holders

                                                       

Options for Units

    15,677,710        1,741,432        459,151      $ 13.08                          

Restricted Stock Units

    11,682,271        1,297,631        342,137      $ 18.67       27,872,530        2,734,169        779,250   

Appreciation Units

    6,682,809        742,306        195,718      $ 16.58                          

Options for Class A Common Stock

    3,731,657                      $ 1.86                          

Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders

    —          —          —          —          —         —         —    

Total

    37,774,446        3,781,368        997,006                27,872,530        2,734,169        779,250   

 

* Value of RSUs as of date of grant.

 

149


Table of Contents

Beneficial Ownership

All of our outstanding stock is beneficially owned by SCC and SCCII through its wholly owned subsidiaries. The following table presents information regarding beneficial ownership of the equity securities of SCC and SCCII as of March 1, 2015 by each person who is known by us to beneficially own more than 5% of the equity securities of SCC and SCCII, by each of our directors, by each of the named executives, and by all of our directors and executive officers as a group.

 

Name of Beneficial Owner   Number of Shares Beneficially Owned(1)     Percent of
Classes(2)
 
     Class A Common     Class L Common     Preferred         

Bain Funds (3)

    34,849,657        3,872,184        1,020,636        13.52

Blackstone Funds (4)

    34,849,657        3,872,184        1,020,636        13.52

GS Limited Partnerships (5)

    28,393,651        3,154,850        831,560        11.02

KKR Funds (6)

    34,849,657        3,872,184        1,020,636        13.52

Providence Equity Funds (7)

    21,295,238        2,366,138        623,670        8.26

Silver Lake Funds (8)

    34,488,546        3,832,061        1,010,061        13.38

TPG Funds (9)

    34,849,657        3,872,184        1,020,636        13.52

Marianne Brown (10) (named executive)

    16,132        1,792        472        —    

Russell P. Fradin (director & named executive) (10)

    1,670,512        185,612        48,924        —    

Glenn H. Hutchins (8)(11) (director)

    34,488,546        3,832,061        1,010,061        13.38

David L. Johnson (12) (director)

    —         —         —         —    

Ian K. Loring (13) (director)

    —         —         —         —    

John W. Marren (14) (director)

    —         —         —         —    

Kevin J. McCurry (10) (named executive)

    12,908        1,434        378        —    

Sanjeev K. Mehra (5)(15) (director)

    28,393,651        3,154,850        831,560        11.02

Kevin J. McCurry (10) (named executive)

    12,908        1,434        378        —    

Charles J. Neral (10) (named executive)

    226,180        25,131        6,624        —    

R. Davis Noell (7)(16) (director)

    21,295,238        2,366,138        623,670        8.26

John I. Park (17) (director)

    —         —         —         —    

Brian A. Traquair (10) (named executive)

    242,916        26,991        7,114        —    

All 16 directors and current executive officers as a group (10)(11)(12)(13)(14)(15)(16)(17)(18)

    86,861,977        9,651,331        2,543,913        33.70

 

(1) Includes shares held in the beneficial owner’s name or jointly with others, or in the name of a bank, nominee or trustee for the beneficial owner’s account. Unless otherwise indicated in the footnotes to this table and subject to community property laws where applicable, we believe that each stockholder named in this table has sole voting and investment power with respect to the shares indicated as beneficially owned. Class A shares of common stock of SCC, Class L shares of common stock of SCC and preferred shares of SCCII are referred to in the notes to this table as, respectively, Class A shares, Class L shares and preferred shares.

 

(2) Unless otherwise indicated, the beneficial ownership of any named person does not exceed, in the aggregate, one percent of the outstanding equity securities of SCC and SCCII on March 1, 2015, as adjusted as required by applicable rules.

 

(3)

Includes (i) 34,693,273 Class A shares, 3,801,832 Class L shares and 999,852 preferred shares held by Bain Capital Integral Investors, LLC (“Bain Integral”), whose administrative member is Bain Capital

 

150


Table of Contents
  Investors, LLC (“BCI”); and (ii) 156,384 Class A shares, 70,352 Class L shares and 20,784 preferred shares held by BCIP TCV, LLC (“BCIP TCV” and, together with Bain Integral, the “Bain Funds”), whose administrative member is BCI. The address of each of the entities listed in this footnote is c/o Bain Capital, LLC, John Hancock Tower, 200 Clarendon Street, Boston, Massachusetts 02116.

 

(4) Includes (i) 18,317,228 Class A shares, 2,035,248 Class L shares and 536,454 preferred shares held by Blackstone Capital Partners IV L.P. (“BCP IV”), whose general partner is Blackstone Management Associates IV L.L.C. (“BMA IV”); (ii) 289,253 Class A shares, 32,139 Class L shares and 8,471 preferred shares held by Blackstone Capital Partners IV-A L.P. (“BCP IV-A”), whose general partner is BMA IV; (iii) 810,541 Class A shares, 90,060 Class L shares and 23,738 preferred shares held by Blackstone Family Investment Partnership IV-A L.P. (“BFIP IV-A”), whose general partner is BCP IV Side-by-Side GP L.L.C.; (iv) 66,204 Class A shares, 7,356 Class L shares and 1,939 preferred shares held by Blackstone Participation Partnership IV L.P. (“BPP IV”), whose general partner is BCP IV Side-by-Side GP L.L.C.; (v) 14,444,444 Class A shares, 1,604,938 Class L shares and 423,032 preferred shares held by Blackstone GT Communications Partners L.P. (“BGTCP”), whose general partner is Blackstone Communications Management Associates I L.L.C. (“BCMA IV”); and (vi) 921,986 Class A shares, 102,443 Class L shares and 27,002 preferred shares held by Blackstone Family Communications Partnership I L.P. (“BFCP” and, collectively with BCP IV, BCP IV-A, BFIP IV-A, BPP IV and BGTCP, the “Blackstone Funds”), whose general partner is BCOM IV Side-by-side GP L.L.C.. Blackstone Holdings III L.P. is the majority member of BMA IV, the general partner of BCMA IV and the sole member of each of BCP IV Side-by-Side GP L.L.C. and BCOM Side-by-Side GP L.L.C. The general partner of Blackstone Holdings III L.P. is Blackstone Holdings III GP L.P. The general partner of Blackstone Holdings III GP L.P. is Blackstone Holdings III GP Management L.L.C. The sole member of Blackstone Holdings III GP Management L.L.C. is The Blackstone Group L.P. The general partner of The Blackstone Group L.P. is Blackstone Group Management L.L.C. Blackstone Group Management L.L.C. is wholly-owned by Blackstone’s senior managing directors and controlled by its founder, Stephen A. Schwarzman. Each of such entities (other than the Blackstone Funds to the extent of their direct holdings) and Mr. Schwarzman may be deemed to beneficially own the shares beneficially owned by the Blackstone Funds directly or indirectly controlled by it or him, but each disclaims beneficial ownership of such shares. The address of each of Mr. Schwarzman and each of the other entities listed in this footnote is c/o The Blackstone Group L.P., 345 Park Avenue, New York, New York 10154.

 

(5)

The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., which we refer to as GS Group, Goldman, Sachs & Co., which we refer to as Goldman Sachs, and certain of their affiliates may be deemed to own beneficially and indirectly Class A shares, Class L shares and preferred shares which are owned directly or indirectly by investment partnerships of which affiliates of Goldman Sachs and GS Group are the general partner, managing limited partner or managing partner. We refer to these investment partnerships as the GS Limited Partnerships. Goldman Sachs is an affiliate of each of, and investment manager for certain of, the GS Limited Partnerships. GS Group, Goldman, Sachs and the GS Limited Partnerships share voting power and investment power with certain of their respective affiliates. The GS Limited Partnerships and their respective beneficial ownership of shares of SCC and SCC II include: (i) 8,034,125 Class A shares, 892,681 Class L shares and 235,294 preferred shares held by GS Capital Partners 2000, L.P.; (ii) 2,552,674 Class A shares, 283,630 Class L shares and 74,760 preferred shares held by GS Capital Partners 2000 Employee Fund, L.P.; (iii) 2,919,293 Class A shares, 324,366 Class L shares and 85,497 preferred shares held by GS Capital Partners 2000 Offshore, L.P.; (iv) 354,921 Class A shares, 39,436 Class L shares and 10,395 preferred shares held by Goldman Sachs Direct Investment Fund 2000, L.P.; (v) 335,812 Class A shares, 37,312 Class L shares and 9,835 preferred shares held by GS Capital Partners 2000 GmbH & Co. Beteiligungs KG; (vi) 7,475,480 Class A shares, 830,609 Class L shares and 218,933 preferred shares held by GS Capital Partners V Fund, L.P.; (vii) 3,861,537 Class A shares, 429,060 Class L shares and 113,092 preferred shares held by GS Capital Partners V Offshore Fund, L.P.; (viii) 296,373 Class A shares, 32,930 Class L shares and 8,680 preferred shares held by GS Capital Partners V GmbH & Co. KG; and (ix) 2,563,436 Class A shares, 284,826 Class L shares and 75,075 preferred shares held by GS Capital Partners V Institutional, L.P. Each of Goldman Sachs and GS Group disclaims beneficial ownership of the

 

151


Table of Contents
  shares owned directly and indirectly by the GS Limited Partnerships, except to the extent of their pecuniary interest therein, if any. The address for GS Group, Goldman Sachs and the GS Limited Partnerships is 200 West Street, New York, New York 10282.

 

(6) Includes (i) 33,937,852 Class A shares, 3,770,872 Class L shares and 993,933 preferred shares held by KKR Millennium Fund L.P. (“KKR Millennium Fund”), whose general partner is KKR Associates Millennium L.P., whose general partner is KKR Millennium GP LLC; and (ii) 911,806 Class A shares, 101,312 Class L shares and 26,704 preferred shares held by KKR Partners III, L.P. (“KKR III” and, together with KKR Millennium Fund, the “KKR Funds”), whose general partner is KKR III GP LLC. As the designated members of KKR Management LLC, which indirectly controls or manages KKR Millennium GP LLC, and as the managing members of KKR III GP LLC, Messrs. Henry R. Kravis and George R. Roberts may be deemed to share beneficial ownership of the shares held or controlled by the KKR Funds. Each of KKR Associates Millennium L.P., KKR Millennium GP LLC, KKR III GP LLC and Messrs. Kravis and Roberts disclaims beneficial ownership of such shares. The address of each of the entities listed in this footnote is c/o Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co. L.P., 9 West 57th Street, New York, New York 10019.

 

(7) Includes (i) 18,390,397 Class A shares, 2,043,377 Class L shares and 538,597 preferred shares held by Providence Equity Partners V LP (“PEP V”), whose general partner is Providence Equity GP V LP, whose general partner is Providence Equity Partners V L.L.C. (“PEP V LLC”); and (ii) 2,904,841 Class A shares, 322,760 Class L shares and 85,074 preferred shares held by Providence Equity Partners V-A LP (“PEP V-A” and, together with PEP V, the “Providence Equity Funds”), whose general partner is Providence Equity GP V LP, whose general partner is PEP V LLC. PEP V LLC may be deemed to share beneficial ownership of the shares owned by PEP V and PEP V-A. PEP V LLC disclaims this beneficial ownership. Messrs. Angelakis, Creamer, Masiello, Mathieu, Nelson, Pelson and Salem are members of PEP V LLC and may also be deemed to possess indirect beneficial ownership of the securities owned by the Providence Equity Funds, but disclaim such beneficial ownership. The address of each of the entities listed in this footnote is c/o Providence Equity Partners Inc., 50 Kennedy Plaza, 18th Floor, Providence, Rhode Island 02903.

 

(8) Includes (i) 34,440,889 Class A shares, 3,826,766 Class L shares and 1,008,665 preferred shares held by Silver Lake Partners II, L.P. (“SLP II”), whose general partner is Silver Lake Technology Associates II, L.L.C. (“SLTA II”); and (ii) 47,657 Class A shares, 5,295 Class L shares and 1,396 preferred shares held by Silver Lake Technology Investors II, L.P. (“SLTI II” and, together with SLP II, the “Silver Lake Funds”), whose general partner is SLTA II. The address of each of the entities listed in this footnote is c/o Silver Lake, 2775 Sand Hill Road, Suite 100, Menlo Park, California 94025.

 

(9)

Includes (i) 20,745,833 Class A shares, 2,305,093 Class L shares and 607,580 preferred shares held by TPG Partners IV, L.P. (“Partners IV”), whose general partner is TPG GenPar IV, L.P. (“GenPar IV”), whose general partner is TPG GenPar IV Advisors, LLC (“Advisors IV”), whose managing member is TPG Holdings I, L.P., whose general partner is TPG Holdings I-A, LLC, whose sole member is TPG Group Holdings (SBS), L.P., whose sole general partner is TPG Group Holdings (SBS) Advisors, Inc., a Delaware corporation (“Group Advisors”); (ii) 2,349,389 Class A shares, 261,043 Class L shares and 68,806 preferred shares held by T3 Partners II, L.P. (“T3 Partners II”), whose general partner is T3 GenPar II, L.P. (“T3 GenPar II”), whose general partner is T3 Advisors II, Inc. (“T3 Advisors II”); (iii) 377,000 Class A shares, 41,889 Class L shares and 11,041 preferred shares held by T3 Parallel II, L.P. (“T3 Parallel II”), whose general partner is T3 GenPar II; (iv) 5,416,667 Class A shares, 601,852 Class L shares and 158,637 preferred shares held by TPG Solar III LLC (“Solar III”), whose managing member is TPG Partners III, L.P., whose general partner is TPG GenPar III, L.P., whose general partner is TPG Advisors III, Inc. (“Advisors III”); and (v) 5,960,768 Class A shares, 662,308 Class L shares and 174,572 preferred shares held by TPG Solar Co-Invest LLC (“Solar Co-Invest” and, collectively with Partners IV, T3 Partners II, T3 Parallel II and Solar III, the “TPG Funds”), whose managing member is TPG Advisors IV, Inc., a Delaware corporation (“Advisors IV”). David Bonderman and James G. Coulter are officers and sole shareholders of Group Advisors, T3 Advisors II, Advisors III and Advisors IV and may therefore be deemed to beneficially own the shares held by the TPG Funds. Messrs. Bonderman and Coulter disclaim

 

152


Table of Contents
  beneficial ownership of the shares held by the TPG Funds except to the extent of their pecuniary interest therein. The address of TPG Funds and Messrs. Bonderman and Coulter is c/o TPG Global, LLC, 301 Commerce Street, Suite 3300, Fort Worth, Texas 76102.

 

(10) Includes the following shares which the beneficial owner has the right to acquire within 60 days after March 1, 2015 by stock option exercise or RSU distribution:

 

Beneficial Owner

   Shares of Class A
Common Stock
     Shares of Class L
Common Stock
     Shares of
Preferred Stock
 

Marianne Brown

     16,132         1,792         472   

Russell P. Fradin

     1,131,042         125,671         33,125   

Kevin J. McCurry

     12,908         1,434         378   

Charles J. Neral

     140,886         15,654         4,126   

Brian A. Traquair

     192,850         21,428         5,648   

All 16 directors and current executive officers as a group

     1,916,984         212,998         56,142   

 

(11) Mr. Hutchins, a director of the Parent Companies and SunGard, is a co-founder of Silver Lake. Amounts disclosed for Mr. Hutchins are also included above in the amounts disclosed in the table next to “Silver Lake Funds.” Mr. Hutchins disclaims beneficial ownership of any shares owned directly or indirectly by the Silver Lake Funds, except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein.

 

(12) Mr. Johnson, a director of the Parent Companies and SunGard, is an employee of an affiliate of The Blackstone Group, L.P. Mr. Johnson disclaims beneficial ownership of any shares owned directly or indirectly by the Blackstone Funds, except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein.

 

(13) Does not include shares held by the Bain Funds. The governance, investment strategy and decision-making process with respect to investments held by the Bain Funds is directed by BCI’s Global Private Equity Board (“GPEB”), which is comprised of the following individuals: Steve Barnes, Joshua Bekenstein, John Connaughton, Stephen Pagliuca, Michel Plantevin, Dwight Poler and Jonathan Zhu. Because of the relationships described in this footnote, GPEB may be deemed to exercise voting and dispositive power with respect to the shares held by the Bain Funds. Each of the members of GPEB disclaims beneficial ownership of such shares to the extent attributed to such member solely by virtue of serving on GPEB. Mr. Loring, a director of the Parent Companies and SunGard, is a Managing Director of Bain Capital Investors, LLC and may therefore be deemed to beneficially own the amounts disclosed in the table next to “Bain Funds.” Mr. Loring expressly disclaims beneficial ownership of any such securities except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein.

 

(14) Mr. Marren, a director of the Parent Companies and SunGard, is a senior partner of TPG Capital, L.P., an affiliate of the TPG Funds. Mr. Marren does not have voting or investment power over, and disclaims beneficial ownership of, the shares held by the TPG Funds.

 

(15) Mr. Mehra, a director of the Parent Companies and SunGard, is a Managing Director of Goldman Sachs. Amounts disclosed for Mr. Mehra are also included above in the amounts disclosed in the table next to “GS Limited Partnerships.” Mr. Mehra disclaims beneficial ownership of any shares owned directly or indirectly by the GS Limited Partnerships, except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein.

 

(16) Mr. Noell, a director of the Parent Companies and SunGard, is a Managing Director of Providence Equity L.L.C., an affiliate of the Providence Equity Funds. Amounts disclosed for Mr. Noell are also included above in the amounts disclosed in the table next to “Providence Equity Funds.” Mr. Noell disclaims beneficial ownership of any shares owned directly or indirectly by the Providence Equity Funds, except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein.

 

(17) Mr. Park, a director of the Parent Companies and SunGard, is an executive of Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co. L.P. and/or one or more of its affiliates. Mr. Park disclaims beneficial ownership of any shares owned directly or indirectly by the KKR Funds, except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein.

 

153


Table of Contents
(18) Excluding shares beneficially owned by Messrs. Hutchins, Mehra and Noell, the number of shares beneficially owned by all directors and executive officers as a group is as follows: Class A shares—2,684,542; Class L shares—298,282; preferred shares—78,622; percent of classes—1.04%.

 

ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS

Pursuant to our Global Business Conduct and Compliance Program, all employees and directors (including our named executives) who have, or whose immediate family members have, any financial interests in other entities where such involvement is or may appear to cause a conflict of interest situation are required to report to us the conflict. If the conflict involves a director or executive officer or is considered material, the situation will be reviewed by the Compliance Committee. The Compliance Committee will then consult with the Audit Committee and determine whether a conflict exists or will exist, and if so, what action should be taken to resolve the conflict or potential conflict. In other cases, conflicts are reviewed and resolved by the Compliance Committee. Additionally, in connection with the LBO, the Company’s four parent companies and the Sponsors entered into a principal investor agreement which requires affiliated party transactions involving the Sponsors to be approved by the majority of Sponsors not involved in the affiliated party transaction.

Other than as described under this heading, the Company has not adopted any formal policies or procedures for the review, approval or ratification of certain related-party transactions that may be required to be reported under the SEC disclosure rules. Such transactions, if and when they are proposed or have occurred, have traditionally been (and will continue to be) reviewed by the Audit Committee (other than the committee members involved, if any) on a case-by-case basis.

In connection with the LBO, the Company and its four parent companies entered into a management agreement with affiliates of each of the Sponsors pursuant to which such entities or their affiliates will provide management consulting services, including financial, managerial and operational advice and implementation of strategies for improving the operating, marketing and financial performance of the Company and its subsidiaries. In March 2014, the Company and the Sponsors amended the management agreement to increase the management fee from 1% to 1.1% of quarterly “EBITDA” (as defined in the Indenture dated August 11, 2005 governing the senior notes due 2013 (but assuming the management fee had not been paid for purposes of such calculation)) for five of seven Sponsors and fixed payments of $50,000 per quarter for each of the two remaining Sponsors, Bain and KKR. The sponsors also receive reimbursement for out-of-pocket expenses incurred by them or their affiliates in connection with the provision of services pursuant to the agreement. For the years ended December 31, 2012, 2013 and 2014, the Company recorded $9 million, $8 million and $9 million, respectively, relating to management fees in continuing operations. In addition, for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2013, SunGard recorded $23 million and $4 million, respectively, relating to management fees in discontinued operations.

In the event that the management agreement is terminated, the Sponsors will receive a lump sum payment equal to the present value of the annual management fees that would have been payable for the remainder of the term of the management agreement. The initial term of the management agreement is ten years, and it extends annually for one year unless the Sponsors or the Company and its parent companies provide notice to the other. Finally, the management agreement provides that affiliates of the Sponsors will be entitled to receive a fee equal to 1% of the gross transaction value in connection with certain subsequent financing, acquisition, disposition and change of control transactions in excess of a threshold amount.

Our Sponsors and/or their respective affiliates have from time to time entered into, and may continue to enter into, arrangements with us to use our products and services, or for us to use the Sponsors affiliates’ products and services, in the ordinary course of business, which often result in revenues or costs to SunGard in excess of $120,000 annually.

 

154


Table of Contents

On March 31, 2014, in connection with the AS Split-Off, we entered into the following agreements:

(i) a Trademark License Agreement that sets forth the terms under which SpinCo and its affiliates are permitted to use the mark “SUNGARD AVAILABILITY SERVICES.” During the first two years following the AS Split-Off, the use of the licensed mark is royalty free. In years 3 through 5, AS will pay a royalty payment of 0.30% of their worldwide revenue, subject to certain exceptions. In years 6 and 7, the royalty will be reduced to 0.15% and 0.075%, respectively. Following year 7, AS will have a perpetual, royalty-free license to use the mark going forward assuming they maintain compliance with the Trademark License Agreement;

(ii) a Transition Services Agreement whereby we agreed to provide certain transitional and administrative support services, including employee benefits services, to AS and AS agreed to provide transitional and administrative support services to us for up to twelve months. At December 31, 2014, we recorded approximately $2 million of accounts receivable from AS under the Transition Services Agreement;

(iii) a Global Master Services Agreement (“GMSA”) replaced the existing agreements under which AS provides certain availability services, managed services, and recovery services to us. We agreed to spend a minimum of approximately $66,400,000 under the GMSA for the period from the AS Split-Off through March 31, 2016. For the nine months ended December 31, 2014, we incurred expenses of $25 million for services provided under the GMSA and at December 31, 2014, we recorded approximately $1 million of accounts receivable, $4 million of accounts payable, and a $1 million prepaid maintenance contract related to AS under the GMSA; and

(iv) a Tax Sharing and Disaffiliation Agreement whereby responsibility was allocated between us and AS for U.S. federal, state and local, and foreign income and other taxes relating to taxable periods before and after the AS Split-Off, and provided for computation and apportionment of tax liabilities and tax benefits between the parties. AS is generally responsible for all taxes attributable to the AS business for periods subsequent to the AS Split-Off and non-income related taxes attributable to the AS business for any taxable period before and after the date of the AS Split-Off. We retain responsibility for U.S. federal, state and local, and foreign income taxes for periods ending on or before the date of the AS Split-Off.

In addition, since the AS Split-Off, we have entered into agreements with AS in the ordinary course of business in which AS has purchased our treasury products and certain data center outsourcing services that resulted in revenue to us for the nine-months ended December 31, 2014 of $363,600 and $1,347,000, respectively.

Effective February 16, 2007, we entered into a three-year participation agreement with one-year renewal terms (“participation agreement”) with Core Trust Purchasing Group, a division of HealthTrust Purchasing Corporation (“CPG”), designating CPG as our exclusive “group purchasing organization” for the purchase of certain products and services from third party vendors. CPG secures from vendors pricing terms for goods and services that are believed to be more favorable than participants in the group purchasing organization could obtain for themselves on an individual basis. Under the participation agreement, we must purchase 80% of the requirements of our participating locations for core categories of specified products and services, from vendors participating in the group purchasing arrangement with CPG, which for 2014 was $6,844,000, or CPG may terminate the contract. In connection with purchases by its participants (including us), CPG receives a commission from the vendors in respect of such purchases. Although CPG is not affiliated with Blackstone, in consideration for Blackstone’s facilitating our participation in CPG and monitoring the services CPG provides to us, CPG remits a portion of the commissions received from vendors in respect of our purchases under the participation agreement to an affiliate of Blackstone, with whom David Johnson, a member of our Boards of Directors, is affiliated and in which he may have an indirect pecuniary interest.

 

155


Table of Contents

DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

SCC, SCCII and SunGard are privately-held corporations and therefore are not required to have independent directors. Our Sponsor Directors may not be considered independent because of their affiliations with funds which hold more than 5% equity interests in the Parent Companies. Mr. Fradin is not an independent director because he is currently employed by the Company.

 

ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

Auditors’ Fees

The following table shows the fees for professional audit services rendered by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP for the audit of our annual financial statements and review of our interim financial statements for 2013 and 2014, and fees for other services rendered by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP for 2013 and 2014.

 

Fees

   2013      2014  

Audit fees (1)

   $ 7,123,000       $ 8,074,000   

Audit-related fees (2)

     5,954,000         3,910,000   

Tax fees (3)

     710,000         1,410,000   

All other fees (4)

     21,000         14,000   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Fees

$ 13,808,000    $ 13,398,000   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) In 2013, consists of services rendered in connection with the audit of our annual financial statements ($3,900,000), other SEC filings ($72,000) and certain broker/dealer audits and statutory audits ($3,151,000). In 2014, consists of services rendered in connection with the audit of our annual financial statements ($3,224,000), incremental audit costs associated with the AS Split-Off ($2,195,000), other SEC filings ($60,000) and certain broker/dealer audits and statutory audits ($2,595,000).
(2) Consists of Statement on Standards for Attestation Engagements (SSAE) No. 16 data center audit fees, transaction due diligence fees, savings plan audits and special audits.
(3) Consists of worldwide tax services primarily related to income tax return preparation and related matters.
(4) Consists of other IT-related services and accounting research software fees.

Audit Committee Pre-Approval of Audit and Permissible Non-Audit Services of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

The Audit Committee pre-approves all audit and permissible non-audit services provided by our independent registered public accounting firm. These services may include audit services, audit-related services, tax services and other services. The Audit Committee has adopted policies and procedures for the pre-approval of services provided by our independent registered public accounting firm. The policies and procedures provide that management and our independent registered public accounting firm jointly submit to the Audit Committee a schedule of audit and non-audit services for approval as part of the annual plan for each year. In addition, the policies and procedures provide that the Audit Committee may also pre-approve particular services not in the annual plan on a case-by-case basis. For each proposed service, management must provide a detailed description of the service and the projected fees and costs (or a range of such fees and costs) for the service. The policies and procedures require management and our independent registered public accounting firm to provide quarterly updates to the Audit Committee regarding services rendered to date and services yet to be performed.

The Audit Committee may delegate pre-approval authority for audit and non-audit services to one or more of its members, who can pre-approve services up to a maximum fee of $50,000. Any such pre-approved service must be reported to the Audit Committee at the next scheduled quarterly meeting.

 

156


Table of Contents

PART IV

 

ITEM 15. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

(a)(1) Financial Statements

See ITEM 8—FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA.

(a)(2) Financial Statement Schedules

None.

(a)(3) Exhibits

The Exhibits that are incorporated by reference in this Report or are filed with this Report are listed in the LIST OF EXHIBITS following the signature page of this Report.

 

157


Table of Contents

Signatures

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, each of the registrants has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

 

   

SUNGARD CAPITAL CORP.

SUNGARD CAPITAL CORP. II

SUNGARD DATA SYSTEMS INC.

Date: March 25, 2015

    By:   /s/    RUSSELL P. FRADIN
      Russell P. Fradin,
      President and Chief Executive Officer

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this Report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrants and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

 

Signature

  

Capacity

 

Date

/S/    RUSSELL P. FRADIN        

Russell P. Fradin

  

President, Chief Executive Officer and Director (principal executive officer)

  March 25, 2015

/S/    CHARLES J. NERAL        

Charles J. Neral

  

Senior Vice President-Finance and Chief Financial Officer (principal financial officer)

  March 25, 2015

/S/    CHRISTOPHER P. BREAKIRON

      Christopher P. Breakiron

  

Vice President and Chief Accounting Officer (principal accounting officer)

  March 25, 2015

/S/    GLENN H. HUTCHINS        

Glenn H. Hutchins

  

Chairman of the Board of Directors

  March 25, 2015

/S/    DAVID L. JOHNSON        

David L. Johnson

  

Director

  March 25, 2015

/S/    IAN K. LORING        

Ian K. Loring

  

Director

  March 25, 2015

/S/    JOHN W. MARREN        

John W. Marren

  

Director

  March 25, 2015

/S/    SANJEEV K. MEHRA        

Sanjeev K. Mehra

  

Director

  March 25, 2015

/S/    R. DAVIS NOELL        

R. Davis Noell

  

Director

  March 25, 2015

/S/    JOHN I. PARK        

John I. Park

  

Director

  March 25, 2015

 

158


Table of Contents

List of Exhibits

 

No.   Exhibit   Incorporated By Reference to the
Exhibits Filed With:
  Commission File No.   Filed
with this
Report
     

SCC

000-
53653

 

SCCII

000-
53654

 

SDS

001-

12989

 
3.1   Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of SDS   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2005           X    
3.2   Amended and Restated Bylaws of SDS   Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007           X    
3.3   Second Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of SCC   Form 8-K filed November 13, 2012   X   X   X    
3.4   Amended and Restated Bylaws of SCC   SCC’s Registration Statement on Form 10-12G filed April 30, 2009   X            
3.5   Second Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of SCC II   Form 8-K filed December 20, 2012   X   X   X    
3.6   Amended and Restated Bylaws of SCC II   SCCII’s Registration Statement on Form 10-12G filed April 30, 2009       X        
4.1   Indenture dated January 15, 2004 between SunGard and The Bank of New York, as trustee   Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003           X    
4.2   Indenture, dated as of November 16, 2010, among SDS, Guarantors named therein and The Bank of New York Mellon, as Trustee, governing the 7.375% Senior Notes   Form 8-K filed November 16, 2010   X   X   X    
4.3   Indenture, dated as of November 16, 2010, among SDS, Guarantors named therein and The Bank of New York Mellon, as Trustee, governing the 7.625% Senior Notes   Form 8-K filed November 16, 2010   X   X   X    
4.4   Indenture, dated as of November 1, 2012, among SDS, Guarantors named therein and the Bank of New York Mellon, as Trustee, governing the 6.625% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2019   Form 8-K filed November 7, 2012   X   X   X    
4.5   Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of November 1, 2012, among SDS, Guarantors named therein and CitiGroup Global Markets Inc. as Representative for the Initial Purchasers and Goldman, Sachs & Co. relating to the 6.625% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2019   Form 8-K filed November 7, 2012   X   X   X    

 

159


Table of Contents
No.   Exhibit   Incorporated By Reference to the
Exhibits Filed With:
  Commission File No.   Filed
with this
Report
     

SCC

000-
53653

 

SCCII

000-
53654

 

SDS

001-

12989

 
10.1   Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of August 11, 2005, as amended by the Seventh Amendment and Restatement Agreement dated as of February 7, 2014, among SDS, SunGard Holdco LLC, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent, and the lenders party thereto   Form 8-K filed February 13, 2014   X   X   X    
10.2   Guarantee Agreement, dated as of August 11, 2005, among SunGard Holdco LLC, SDS, Solar Capital Corp., the Subsidiaries of SDS identified therein and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2005           X    
10.3   Security Agreement, dated as of August 11, 2005, among SunGard Holdco LLC, SDS, Solar Capital Corp., the Subsidiaries of SDS identified therein and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Collateral Agent   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2005           X    
10.4   Intellectual Property Security Agreement, dated as of August 11, 2005, among SunGard Holdco LLC, SDS, Solar Capital Corp., the Subsidiaries of SDS identified therein and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Collateral Agent   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2005           X    
10.5   Third Amended and Restated Credit and Security Agreement, dated as of May 14, 2014, by and among SunGard AR Financing LLC, as borrower, the financial institutions party thereto from time to time as lenders and General Electric Capital Corporation as a lender, swing line lender and administrative agent   Form 8-K filed May 19, 2014 (Exhibit A to Exhibit 10.1 thereto)   X   X   X    
10.6   Amendment and Restatement Agreement, dated as of May 14, 2014, by and among SDS, as parent, SunGard AR Financing LLC, as borrower, certain subsidiaries of SunGard Data Systems Inc., as sellers, the financial institutions party thereto from time to time as lenders and General Electric Capital Corporation as a lender, swing line lender and administrative agent   Form 8-K filed May 19, 2014   X   X   X    

 

160


Table of Contents
No.   Exhibit   Incorporated By Reference to the
Exhibits Filed With:
  Commission File No.   Filed
with this
Report
     

SCC

000-
53653

 

SCCII

000-
53654

 

SDS

001-

12989

 
10.7   Amended and Restated Receivables Sales Agreement, dated as of May 14, 2014, by and among each of the persons signatory thereto from time to time as Sellers, SunGard AR Financing LLC as Buyer, and SDS, as Seller Agent   Form 8-K filed May 19, 2014 (Exhibit B to Exhibit 10.1 thereto)   X   X   X    
10.8   Seller Support Agreement, dated as of March 27, 2009, by SunGard Data Systems Inc., in favor of SunGard AR Financing LLC   Form 8-K filed April 2, 2009                
10.9*†   Employment Agreement by and among Russell Fradin, SDS, SCC and SCC II, dated May 13, 2011 and effective as of May 31, 2011   Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2011   X   X   X    
10.10*   Employment Agreement by and between SDS and Charles Neral effective as of July 2, 2012   Form 8-K filed June 14, 2012   X   X   X    
10.11*   Employment Agreement by and among Marianne Brown, SDS, SCC and SCC II, effective as of February 24, 2014                   X
10.12*   Employment Agreement by and among Kevin McCurry, SDS, SCC and SCC II, effective as of January 20, 2014                   X
10.13*   SunGard 2005 Management Incentive Plan as Amended and Restated February 13, 2013   Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2012   X   X   X    
10.14*   SunGard Dividend Rights Plan as Amended September 6, 2007   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2007           X    
10.15*   Forms of Rollover Stock Option Award Agreements   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2005           X    
10.16*   Forms of 2005 Time-Based Stock Option Award Agreements   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2005           X    
10.17*   Forms of 2005 Performance-Based Stock Option Award Agreements   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2005           X    
10.18*   Forms of 2007 Performance-Based Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreements   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2007           X    
10.19*   Forms of 2007 Time-Based Class A Stock Option Award Agreements   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2007           X    
10.20*   Forms of 2007 Performance-Based Class A Stock Option Award Agreements   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2007           X    
10.21*   Form of Amendment to the Performance-Based Stock Option Award Agreements   Schedule TO of SCC and SCCII, each filed August 13, 2009   005-
84880
  005-
84881
       

 

161


Table of Contents
No.   Exhibit   Incorporated By Reference to the
Exhibits Filed With:
  Commission File No.   Filed
with this
Report
     

SCC

000-
53653

 

SCCII

000-
53654

 

SDS

001-

12989

 
10.22*   Form of Amendment to the Performance-Based Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreements   Schedule TO of SCC and SCCII, each filed August 13, 2009   005-
84880
  005-
84881
       
10.23*   Form of Amendment to the Performance-Based Class A Stock Option Award Agreements   Schedule TO of SCC and SCC II, each filed August 13, 2009                
10.24*   Forms of May 2010 Performance-Based Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreements   Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2010   X   X   X    
10.25*   Forms of May 2010 Performance-Based Class A Stock Option Award Agreements   Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2010   X   X   X    
10.26*   Forms of May 2010 Time-Based Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreements   Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2010   X   X   X    
10.27*   Forms of May 2010 Time-Based Class A Stock Option Award Agreements   Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2010   X   X   X    
10.28*   Forms of June 25, 2010 Amendment to the Performance-Based Equity Award Agreements   Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2010   X   X   X    
10.29*   Form of June 2011 Time-Based Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreements   Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2011                
10.30*   Form of June 2011 Performance-Based Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreements   Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2011   X   X   X    
10.31*   Time-Based Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement dated September 12, 2012 granted to Charles Neral   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2012   X   X   X    
10.32*   Performance-Based Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement dated September 12, 2012 granted to Charles Neral   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2012   X   X   X    
10.33*   Form of November 2012 Time-Based Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement   Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2012   X   X   X    
10.34*   Form of November 2012 Performance-Based Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement   Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2012   X   X   X    
10.35*   Form of June 2013 Performance-Based Appreciation Unit Award Agreement   Form 8-K filed June 14, 2013   X   X   X    
10.36*   Form of June 2013 Time-Based Appreciation Unit Award Agreement   Form 8-K filed June 14, 2013   X   X   X    
10.37*   Form of June 2014 Performance-Based Appreciation Unit Award Agreement                   X
10.38*   Form of June 2014 Time-Based Appreciation Unit Award Agreement                   X
10.39*   SunGard Annual Incentive Compensation Plan, As Amended and Restated on November 15, 2012   Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2012   X   X   X    

 

162


Table of Contents
No.   Exhibit   Incorporated By Reference to the
Exhibits Filed With:
  Commission File No.   Filed
with this
Report
     

SCC

000-
53653

 

SCCII

000-
53654

 

SDS

001-

12989

 
10.40   Form of Indemnification Agreement between SCC, SCC II, SunGard Holding Corp., SunGard HoldCo LLC, SDS and directors and certain officers of SDS   Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2005   X   X   X    
10.41   Second Amended and Restated Stockholders Agreement, dated March 31, 2014, by and among SDS, SCC, SCC II, SunGard Holding Corp., SunGard Holdco LLC, and the stockholder parties provided therein   Form 8-K filed April 4, 2014   X   X   X    
10.42   Second Amended and Restated Participation, Registration Rights and Coordination Agreement, dated March 31, 2014, by and among SDS, SCC, SCC II, SunGard Holding Corp., SunGard Holdco LLC, and certain stockholder parties provided therein   Form 8-K filed April 4, 2014   X   X   X    
10.43   Second Amended and Restated Principal Investor Agreement, dated March 31, 2014, by and among SDS, SCC, SCC II, SunGard Holding Corp., SunGard Holdco LLC, and certain principal investor parties provided therein   Form 8-K filed April 4, 2014   X   X   X    
10.44   Amended & Restated Management Agreement, dated March 31, 2014, by and among SDS, SCC, SCC II, SunGard Holding Corp., SunGard Holdco LLC, Bain Capital Partners, LLC, Blackstone Communications Advisors I L.L.C., Blackstone Management Partners IV L.L.C., Goldman, Sachs & Co., Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co. L.P., Providence Equity Partners L.L.C., Silver Lake Management Company, L.L.C. and TPG GenPar IV, L.P.   Form 8-K filed April 4, 2014   X   X   X    
10.45   Separation and Distribution Agreement, dated March 31, 2014, by and among SCC, SCC II, SunGard Holding Corp., SunGard Holdco LLC, SDS, Sungard Availability Services Capital, Inc., and Sungard Availability Services Holdings, LLC   Form 8-K filed April 4, 2014   X   X   X    

 

163


Table of Contents
No.   Exhibit   Incorporated By Reference to the
Exhibits Filed With:
  Commission File No.   Filed
with this
Report
     

SCC

000-
53653

 

SCCII

000-
53654

 

SDS

001-

12989

 
10.46   Tax Sharing and Disaffiliation Agreement, dated March 31, 2014, by and among SCC, SDS, Sungard Availability Services Capital, Inc., and Sungard Availability Services Holdings, LLC   Form 8-K filed April 4, 2014   X   X   X    
10.47   Trademark License Agreement, dated March 31, 2014, between SunGard Development LLC and Sungard Availability Services Capital, Inc.   Form 8-K filed April 4, 2014   X   X   X    
10.48   Exchange Agreement, dated as of March 17, 2014, among SDS, Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Deutsche Bank Securities Inc. and Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and, with respect to certain sections thereof, Sungard Availability Services Capital, Inc.   Form 8-K filed March 21, 2014   X   X   X    
12.1   Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges                   X
21.1   Subsidiaries of the Registrants                   X
23.1   Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm regarding SunGard’s consolidated financial statements                   X
31.1   Certification of Russell P. Fradin, Chief Executive Officer, required by Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) and Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002                   X
31.2   Certification of Charles J. Neral, Chief Financial Officer, required by Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) and Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002                   X
32.1   Certification of Russell P. Fradin, Chief Executive Officer, required by Rule 13a-14(b) or Rule 15d-14(b) and Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002                   X
32.2   Certification of Charles J. Neral, Chief Financial Officer, required by Rule 13a-14(b) or Rule 15d-14(b) and Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002                   X
99.1   Section 13(r) Disclosure of Certain Sponsors                   X

 

164


Table of Contents
No.   Exhibit   Incorporated By Reference to the
Exhibits Filed With:
  Commission File No.   Filed
with this
Report
     

SCC

000-
53653

 

SCCII

000-
53654

 

SDS

001-

12989

 
101   Interactive Data Files for SCC, SCC II and SDS, pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T: (i) Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2013 and 2014, (ii) Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2012, 2013 and 2014, (iii) Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2012, 2013 and 2014, (iv) Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2012, 2013 and 2014 and (v) Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.                   X

 

Portions of this exhibit have been omitted in accordance with an order granting confidential treatment.

 

* Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.

 

165